Std10 Maths EM WWW - Tntextbooks.in PDF
Std10 Maths EM WWW - Tntextbooks.in PDF
Std10 Maths EM WWW - Tntextbooks.in PDF
in
GOVERNMENT OF TAMILNADU
STANDARD TEN
MATHEMATICS
Content Creation
The wise
possess all
(ii)
SYMBOLS
1
Y not a proper subset of absolute value
mes
Learning Outco Note
on
class- Addi�onal inputs
To transform the to the content w hi ch
es se s in
room proc require student
to think
with a
learning centric and compr eh en d the
ks
set of bench mar concepts are gi ve n
r
Thinking Crone
�veness
To kindle the inquisi ng Progress Check
arni
of students in le ake Self evalua�on of
the
m
mathema�cs. To ve a learner’s progre
ss
ts to ha
the studen
diverse thinking
Activity Exercise
To encourage stud es
ents To evaluate the
to involve in ac � vi � learners’ in
e
to learn mathem
a�cs understanding th
content
ber
Points to Remem ICT Corner
ner’s
To recall the poin
ts To encourage lear
th e to pi c understand in g of
learnt in
content through logy
no
applica�on of tech
CONTENTS
1 Relations and Functions 1-36
1.1 Introduction 1
1.2 Ordered Pair 2
1.3 Cartesian Product 2
1.4 Relations 6
1.5 Functions 10
1.6 Representation of Functions 15
1.7 Types of functions 17
1.8 Special cases of Functions 23
1.9 Composition of Functions 26
1.10 Identifying the graphs of Linear, Quadratic,
29
Cubic and Reciprocal functions
2 Numbers and Sequences 37-85
2.1 Introduction 38
2.2 Euclid’s Division Lemma 38
2.3 Euclid’s Division Algorithm 40
2.4 Fundamental Theorem of Arithmetic 44
2.5 Modular Arithmetic 47
2.6 Sequences 53
2.7 Arithmetic Progression 56
2.8 Series 63
2.9 Geometric Progression 68
2.10 Sum to n terms of a Geometric Progression 74
2.11 Special Series 77
3 Algebra 86-156
3.1 Introduction 86
3.2 Simultaneous Linear Equations in three variables 88
3.3 GCD and LCM of Polynomials 94
3.4 Rational expressions 99
3.5 Square Root of Polynomials 104
3.6 Quadratic Equations 107
3.7 Quadratic Graphs 124
3.8 Matrices 133
(v)
4 Geometry 157-199
4.1 Introduction 157
4.2 Similarity 158
4.3 Thales Theorem and Angle Bisector Theorem 167
4.4 Pythagoras Theorem 179
4.5 Circles and Tangents 184
4.6 Concurrency Theorems 191
5 Coordinate Geometry 200-236
5.1 Introduction 200
5.2 Area of a Triangle 202
5.3 Area of a Quadrilateral 204
5.4 Inclination of a Line 209
5.5 Straight Line 218
5.6 General Form of a Straight Line 228
6 Trigonometry 237-266
6.1 Introduction 237
6.2 Trigonometric Identities 240
6.3 Heights and Distances 248
7 Mensuration 267-299
7.1 Introduction 267
7.2 Surface Area 268
7.3 Volume 280
7.4 Volume and Surface Area of Combined Solids 289
7.5 Conversion of Solids from one shape to another
293
with no change in Volume
8 Statistics and Probability 300-334
8.1 Introduction 300
8.2 Measures of Dispersion 302
8.3 Coefficient of Variation 313
8.4 Probability 316
8.5 Algebra of Events 324
8.6 Addition Theorem of Probability 325
Answers 335-343
(vi)
RELATIONS AND
1 FUNCTIONS
“Mathematicians do not study objects, but relations between objects . . . Content to
them is irrelevant: they are interested in form only” – Henri Poincare
Learning Outcomes
� To define and determine cartesian product of sets.
� To define a relation as a subset of cartesian product of sets.
� To understand function as a special relation.
� To represent a function through an arrow diagram, a set of ordered pairs, a
table, a rule or a graph.
� To classify functions as one-one, many-one, onto, into and bijection.
� To study combination of functions through composition operation.
� To understand the graphs of linear, quadratic, cubic and reciprocal functions.
1.1 Introduction
The notion of sets provides the stimulus for learning higher concepts in mathematics.
A set is a collection of well-defined distinguishable objects. This means that a set is merely
a collection of something which we may recognize. In this chapter, we try to extend the
concept of sets in two forms called Relations and Functions. For doing this, we need to
first know about cartesian products that can be defined between two non-empty sets.
It is quite interesting to note that most of the day-to-day situations can be represented
mathematically either through a relation or a function. For example, the distance travelled
by a vehicle in given time can be represented as a function. The price of a commodity
can be expressed as a function in terms of its demand. The area of polygons and volume
Relations and Functions 1
of common objects like circle, right circular cone, right circular cylinder, sphere can be
expressed as a function with one or more variables.
In class IX, we had studied the concept of sets. We have also seen how to form new
sets from the given sets by taking union, intersection and complementation.
Now we are about to study a new set called “cartesian product” for the given sets
A and B.
1.2 Ordered Pair
Observe the seating plan in an auditorium (Fig.1.1).
To help orderly occupation of seats, tokens with numbers
such as (1,5), (7,16), (3,4), (10,12) etc. are issued. The
person who gets (4,10) will go to row 4 and occupy the
10th seat. Thus the first number denotes the row and the
second number, the seat. Which seat will the visitor with
token (5,9) occupy? Can he go to 9th row and take the 5th
seat? Do (9,5) and (5,9) refer to the same location? No, Fig. 1.1
certainly! What can you say about the tokens (2,3), (6,3) and (10,3)?
This is one example where a pair of numbers, written in a particular order, precisely
indicates a location. Such a number pair is called an ordered pair of numbers. This notion
is skillfully used to mathematize the concept of a “Relation”.
1.3 Cartesian Product
Illustration 1
Let us consider the following two sets.
A is the set of 3 vegetables and B is the set of 4 fruits. That is,
A = {carrot, brinjal, ladies finger} and B = {apple, orange, grapes, strawberry}
What are the possible ways of choosing a vegetable with a fruit? (Fig.1.2)
Vegetables (A) Fruits (B) Vegetables Fruits
Carrot (c) Apple (a)
Brinjal (b) Orange (o)
Ladies finger (l) Grapes (g)
Strawberry (s)
Fig. 1.2
We can select them in 12 distinct pairs as given below.
(c, a), (c, o), (c, g), (c, s), (b, a), (b, o), (b, g), (b, s), (l, a), (l, o), (l,g), (l, s)
This collection represents the cartesian product of the set of vegetables and set of
fruits.
Definition
If A and B are two non-empty sets, then the set of all ordered pairs (a, b) such that
a Î A, b Î B is called the Cartesian Product of A and B, and is denoted by A ´ B .
Thus, A ´ B = {(a, b) |a ∈ A, b ∈ B} .
Note
¾ A × B is the set of all possible ordered pairs between the elements of A and B such that
the first coordinate is an element of A and the second coordinate is an element of B.
¾ B × A is the set of all possible ordered pairs between the elements of A and B such that
the first coordinate is an element of B and the second coordinate is an element of A.
¾ If a = b, then (a, b) = (b, a).
¾ The “cartesian product” is also referred as “cross product”.
Illustration 2
Let A = {1, 2, 3} and B = {a, b}. Write A ´ B and B ´ A ?
A ´ B = {1,2,3}×{a,b} = {(1, a ),(1, b),(2, a ),(2, b),(3, a ),(3, b)} (as shown in Fig.1.3)
B ´ A = {a,b} × {1,2,3} = {(a,1), (a,2), (a,3),(b,1), (b,2), (b,3)} (as shown in Fig.1.3)
Note
¾¾ The set of all points in the cartesian plane can be viewed as the set of all ordered pairs
(x, y) where x, y are real numbers. In fact, ℝ×ℝ is the set of all points which we call as
the cartesian plane.
Activity 1
Let A = {x | x ∈ , x ≤ 4} , B = {y | y ∈ , y < 3}
Represent A ´ B and B ´ A in a graph sheet. Can you see the difference between
A ´ B and B ´ A ?
Example 1.1 If A = {1,3,5} and B = {2,3} then (i) find A ´ B and B ´ A.
(ii) Is A × B = B × A ? If not why? (iii) Show that n(A×B) = n(B×A) = n(A)× n(B)
Solution Given that A = {1,3,5} and B = {2,3}
(i)
A×B = {1,3,5} × {2,3} = {(1,2), (1,3), (3,2), (3,3), (5,2), (5,3)} ...(1)
B ´ A = {2,3} × {1,3,5} = {(2,1), (2,3), (2,5), (3,1), (3,3), (3,5)} ...(2)
(ii) From (1) and (2) we conclude that A × B ≠ B × A as (1, 2) ¹ (2, 1) and (1, 3) ¹)(3, 1) , etc.
(iii) n(A)=3; n (B) = 2.
From (1) and (2) we observe that, n (A×B) = n (B×A) = 6;
we see that, n (A) ×n (B) = 3 × 2 = 6 and n (B) × n (A) = 2×3 = 6
Hence, n (A×B) =n (B×A) = n(A) × n (B) = 6.
Thus, n (A×B) =n (B×A) = n(A) × n (B).
Example 1.2 If A×B = {(3,2), (3,4), (5,2), (5,4)} then find A and B.
Solution A×B ={(3,2), (3,4), (5,2), (5,4)}
We have A = {set of all first coordinates of elements of A ´ B }. Therefore, A = {3,5}
B = {set of all second coordinates of elements of A ´ B }. Therefore, B = {2,4}
Thus A = {3,5} and B = {2,4}.
Example 1.3 Let A = {x ∈ | 1 < x < 4} , B = {x ∈ W | 0 ≤ x < 2} and C = {x ∈ | x < 3} .
Then verify that
(i) A # (B , C) = (A # B) , (A # C) (ii) A # (B + C) = (A # B) + (A # C)
(A × B ) ∪ (A ×C ) = {(2, 0),(2, 1),(3, 0),(3, 1)} , {(2, 1),(2, 2),(3, 1),(3, 2)}
= {(2, 0),(2, 1),(2, 2),(3, 0),(3, 1),(3, 2)} ...(2)
From (1) and (2), A × (B ∪ C ) = (A × B ) ∪ (A ×C ) is verified.
(ii) A × (B ∩ C ) = (A × B ) ∩ (A ×C )
B ÇC = {0, 1} ∩ {1, 2} = {1}
A × (B ∩ C ) = {2, 3} × {1} = {(2, 1),(3, 1)} ... (3)
A ´ B = {2, 3} × {0, 1} = {(2, 0),(2, 1),(3, 0),(3, 1)}
A ´C = {2, 3} × {1, 2} = {(2, 1),(2, 2),(3, 1),(3, 2)}
(A × B ) ∩ (A ×C ) = {(2, 0),(2, 1),(3, 0),(3, 1)} ∩ {(2, 1),(2, 2),(3, 1),(3, 2)}
= {(2, 1),(3, 1)} ... (4)
From (3) and (4), A × (B ∩ C ) = (A × B ) ∩ (A ×C ) is verified.
Note
¾ The above two verified properties are called distributive property of cartesian product
over union and intersection respectively. In fact, for any three sets A, B, C we have
(i) A × (B ∪ C ) = (A × B ) ∪ (A ×C ) (ii) A × (B ∩ C ) = (A× B) ∩ (A×C ) .
1.3.1 Cartesian Product of three Sets
If A, B, C are three non-empty sets then the cartesian product of three sets is the set
of all possible ordered triplets given by
A × B ×C = {(a, b, c) for all a Î A, b Î B, c Î C }
Illustration for Geometrical understanding of cartesian product of two and three sets
Y
Let A = {0, 1}, B = {0, 1}, C = {0, 1}
(0,1) (1,1)
� B = {0, 1} ´ {0, 1} = {(0, 0),(0, 1),(1, 0),(1, 1)}
A´
Representing A´
� B in the xy - plane we get a picture shown in Fig. 1.5.
(0,0) (1,0)
(A ´ B ) ´C = {(0, 0),(0, 1),(1, 0),(1, 1)} ×{0,1} X
Fig. 1.5
= {(0, 0, 0),(0, 0, 1),(0, 1, 0),(0, 1, 1),(1, 0, 0),(1, 0, 1)(1, 1, 0),(1, 1, 1)}
Exercise 1.1
1. Find A ´ B , A ´ A and B ´ A
(i) A= {2, −2, 3} and B = {1, −4} (ii) A = B ={p , q } (iii) A ={m , n} ; B =f
2. Let A = {1,2,3} and B = { x | x is a prime number less than 10}. Find A ´ B and B ´ A .
3. If B ×A = {(−2, 3),(−2, 4),(0, 3),(0, 4),(3, 3),(3, 4)} find A and B.
1.4 Relations
Many day-to-day occurrences involve two objects that are connected with each other
by some rule of correspondence. We say that the two objects are related under the specified
rule. How shall we represent it? Here are some examples,
How are New Delhi and India related? We may expect the response, “New Delhi
is the capital of India”. But there are several ways in which ‘New Delhi’ and ‘India’ are
related. Here are some possible answers.
� New Delhi is the capital of India. � New Delhi is in the northern part of India.
So, when we wish to specify a particular relation, providing only one ordered pair
6 10th Standard Mathematics
(New Delhi, India) it may not be practically helpful. If we ask the relation in the following
set of ordered pairs,
{(New Delhi, India), (Washington, USA), (Beijing, China), (London, U.K.), (Kathmandu, Nepal)}
then specifying the relation is easy.
Progress Check
Illustration 4
Students in a class S1 S2 S3 S4 S5 S6 S7 S8 S9 S10
Heights (in feet) 4.5 5.2 5 4.5 5 5.1 5.2 5 4.7 4.9 Students
Heights S1
Let us define a relation between heights of corresponding 4.5 S2
S3
students. (Fig.1.7) 4.7
S4
4.9 S5
R = {(heights, students)} S6
5
R = {(4.5, S1 ), (4.5, S 4 ), (4.7, S 9 ), (4.9, S10 ), (5, S 3 ), (5, S 5 ), (5, S 8 ), 5.1
S7
S8
(5.1, S 6 ), (5.2, S 2 ), (5.2, S 7 )} 5.2 S9
Fig. 1.7 S10
Definition
Let A and B be any two non-empty sets. A ‘relation’ R from A to B is a subset
of A ´ B satisfying some specified conditions. If x Î A is related to y Î B through
R , then we write it as x Ry. x Ry if and only if (x , y ) Î R .
The domain of the relation R = {x Î A | x R y, for some y Î B}
The co-domain of the relation R is B
The range of the relation R = {y Î B | x Ry, for some x Î A}
From these definitions, we note that domain of R Í A , co-domain
of R = B and range of R Í B .
Illustration 5 A R B
Let A = {1,2,3,4,5} and B = {Mathi, Arul, John} 1
2 Mathi
A relation R between the above sets A and B can be
represented by an arrow diagram (Fig. 1.8). 3 Arul
Then, domain of R = {1,2,3,4} 4 John
range of R = {Mathi, Arul, John} = co-domain of R . 5
Fig. 1.8
Note that domain of R is a proper subset of A.
Relations and Functions 7
Activity 2
Let A and B be the set of lines in xy-plane such that A consists of lines parallel to
X-axis. For x Î A , y Î B , let R be a relation from A to B defined by x Ry if x is
perpendicular to y. Find the elements of B using a graph sheet.
Illustration 6
Let A = {1,3,5,7} and B = {4,8}. If R is a relation defined by “is less than” from
A to B, then 1R4 (since 1 is less than 4). Similarly, it is observed that 1R8, 3R4, 3R8,
5R8, 7R8
Equivalently R= {(1,4), (1,8), (3,4), (3,8), (5,8), (7,8)}
Note
¾¾ In the above illustration A×B = {(1,4), (1,8), (3,4), (3,8), (5,4), (5,8), (7,4),(7,8)}
R = {(1,4), (1,8), (3,4), (3,8), (5,8), (7,8)} We see that R is a subset of A ´ B .
Arrow
Illustration 7 diagram
A
B
In a particular area of a town, let us consider ten families
C
A, B, C, D, E, F, G, H, I and J with two children. Among 0 D
these, families B, F, I have two girls; D, G, J have one boy and
1 E
one girl; the remaining have two boys. Let us define a relation F
2
R by xRy, where x denote the number of boys and y denote G
the family with x number of boys. Represent this situation as Number H
of boys
a relation through ordered pairs and arrow diagram. I
Since the domain of the relation R is concerned about J
Fig. 1.9
the number of boys, and we are considering families with two Families
children, the domain of R will consist of three elements given by {0,1,2}, where 0, 1, 2
represent the number of boys say no, one, two boys respectively. We note that families
with two girls are the ones with no boys. Hence the relation R is given by
R = {(0, B ),(0, F ),(0, I ),(1, D ),(1,G ),(1, J ),(2, A),(2,C ),(2, E ),(2, H )}
This relation is shown in an arrow diagram (Fig.1.9).
Example 1.4 Let A = {3,4,7,8} and B = {1,7,10}. Which of the following sets are relations
from A to B?
(i) R 1 ={(3,7), (4,7), (7,10), (8,1)} (ii) R2= {(3,1), (4,12)}
(iii) R3= {(3,7), (4,10), (7,7), (7,8), (8,11), (8,7), (8,10)}
Solution A ´ B = {(3,1), (3,7), (3,10), (4,1), (4,7), (4,10), (7,1), (7,7), (7,10), (8,1), (8,7), (8,10)}
Note
¾¾ A relation may be represented algebraically either by the roster method or by the set
builder method.
¾¾ An arrow diagram is a visual representation of a relation.
Example 1.5 The arrow diagram shows (Fig.1.10) a relationship between the sets P and
Q. Write the relation in (i) Set builder form (ii) Roster form (iii) What is the domain and
range of R.
Solution P Q
(i) Set builder form of R = {(x , y ) | y = x − 2, x ∈ P, y ∈ Q} 5 > 3
6 >
(ii) Roster form R = {(5, 3),(6, 4),(7, 5)} 4
7 >
(iii) Domain of R = {5,6,7} and range of R = {3, 4, 5} 8 5
Fig. 1.10
‘Null relation’
Let us consider the following examples. Suppose
A = {–3,–2,–1} and B = {1,2,3,4}. A relation from A to If n(A) = p , n(B ) = q ,
B is defined as a − b = 8 i.e., there is no pair(a,b) such then the total number of
that a − b = 8 . Thus R contain no element and so relations that exist between
R =f. A and B is 2pq .
A relation which contains no element is called a
“Null relation”.
Exercise 1.2
1. Let A = {1,2,3,7} and B = {3,0,–1,7}, which of the following are relation from A to B ?
(i) R1 = {(2,1), (7,1)} (ii) R2= {(–1,1)}
(iii) R3 = {(2,–1), (7,7), (1,3)} (iv) R4= {(7,–1), (0,3), (3,3), (0,7)}
2. Let A={1,2,3,4,...,45} and R be the relation defined as “is square of ” on A. Write R as a
subset of A ´ A . Also, find the domain and range of R.
3. A Relation R is given by the set {(x , y ) / y = x + 3, x ∈ {0, 1, 2, 3, 4, 5}} . Determine its
domain and range.
4. Represent each of the given relations by (a) an arrow diagram, (b) a graph and
(c) a set in roster form, wherever possible.
(i) {(x,y)|x = 2y, x ∈{2,3,4,5}, y ∈{1,2,3,4}
(ii)
{(x,y)|y = x+3, x, y are natural numbers < 10}
5. A company has four categories of employees given by Assistants (A), Clerks (C),
Managers (M) and an Executive Officer (E). The company provide ₹10,000,
₹25,000, ₹50,000 and ₹1,00,000 as salaries to the people who work in the categories
Definition Relation
Fig. 1.12(b)
10 10th Standard Mathematics
Note
If f : X ® Y is a function then
¾¾ The set X is called the domain of the function f and the set Y is called its
co-domain.
¾¾ If f (a) = b, then b is called ‘image’ of a under f and a is called a ‘pre-image’ of b.
¾¾ The set of all images of the elements of X under f is called the ‘range’ of f.
¾¾ f : X ® Y is a function only if
(i) every element in the domain of f has an image.
(ii) the image is unique.
¾¾ If A and B are finite sets such that n(A) = p , n(B ) = q then the total number of
functions that exist between A and B is q p .
¾¾ In this chapter we always consider f to be a real valued function.
¾¾ Describing domain of a function
1
(i) Let f (x ) = . If x = –1 then f (–1) is not defined. Hence f is defined for
x +1
all real numbers except at x = −1. So domain of f is - {-1} .
1
(ii) Let f (x ) = 2
; If x = 2, 3 then f (2) and f (3) are not defined. Hence f is
x − 5x + 6
defined for all real numbers except at x = 2 and 3. So domain of f = − {2, 3}.
Progress Check
a p 1 m a x
b q 2 p y
c r 3 n b z
This represents a function. This represents a This is not a function.
Each input corresponds function. One of the input b is
to a single output. Each input corresponds associated with two outputs.
to a single output.
Fig. 1.13(a) Fig. 1.13(b) Fig. 1.13(c)
Note
Functions play very important role in the understanding
of higher ideas in mathematics. They are basic tools to convert ¾¾ The range of a
function is a subset of
from one form to another form. In this sense, functions are
its co-domain.
widely applied in Engineering Sciences.
Example 1.6 Let X = {1, 2, 3, 4} and Y = {2, 4, 6, 8, 10} and R = {(1,2),(2,4),(3,6),(4,8)}.
Show that R is a function and find its domain, co-domain and range? X R Y
1 2
Solution Pictorial representation of R is given in Fig.1.14. From the 4
2
diagram, we see that for each x Î X , there exists only one y Î Y . Thus 6
3 8
all elements in X have only one image in Y. Therefore R is a function.
4 10
Fig. 1.14
Domain X = {1,2,3,4}; Co-domain Y = {2,3,6,8,10}; Range of f = {2,4,6,8}.
(ii) We note that each element in the domain of f has a unique image.
Therefore f is a function.
Thinking Corner
Is the relation representing the association between planets and their respective moons
a function?
Example 1.8 If X = {–5,1,3,4} and Y = {a,b,c}, then which of the following relations are
functions from X to Y ?
Exercise 1.3
y=
7
f(x
6
(i) Find the following values of the function
)
5
4
(a) f (0) (b) f (7) (c) f (2) (d) f (10) 3
2
1
(ii) For what value of x is f (x) = 1? o
1 2 3 4 5 6 7 8 9 10
(iii) Describe the following (i) Domain (ii) Range. Fig. 1.16
(iv) What is the image of 6 under f ?
f (x + 2) − f (2)
5. Let f (x) = 2x+5. If x ¹ 0 then find .
x
6. A function f is defined by f (x ) = 2x – 3
f (0) + f (1)
(i) find .
2 x 24–2x x
(ii) find x such that f (x) = 0.
x
(iii) find x such that f (x ) = x .
24–2x
(iv) find x such that f (x ) = f (1 − x ) .
Fig. 1.17
9. A plane is flying at a speed of 500 km per hour. Express the distance d travelled by
the plane as function of time t in hours.
10. The data in the adjacent table depicts the length Length ‘x’ of Height ‘y’
of a woman’s forehand and her corresponding forehand (in cm) (in inches)
height. Based on this data, a student finds a 45.5 65.5
relationship between the height (y) and the 35 56
forehand length(x) as y = ax + b , where a, b 45 65
50 69.5
are constants.
55 74
(i) Check if this relation is a function.
(ii) Find a and b.
14 10th Standard Mathematics
The following test will help us in determining whether a given curve is a function or not.
Example 1.10 Using vertical line test, determine which of the following curves (Fig.1.18(a),
1.18(b), 1.18(c), 1.18(d)) represent a function?
Y Y Y
4 4 4
3 3 3
2 2 2
P
1 P 1 1
0 0 0
X′ -3 -2 -1-1 1 3 X
Q2 3X X′ -3 -2 -1
-1
1 2 X′-4 -3 -2 -1-1 1X
-2 -2 Q -2
P
-3 -3 -3
-4 -4 -4
Y¢ Y¢ Y¢
Fig. 1.18(a) Fig. 1.18(b) Fig. 1.18(c)
Relations and Functions 15
P and Q. 1
0
The curves in Fig.1.18(b) and Fig.1.18(d) X′ -6 -5 -4 -3 -2 -1
-1
1 2 3 4P 5 6 X
Example 1.11 Let A = {1, 2, 3, 4} and B = {2, 5, 8, 11, 14} be two sets. Let f : A ® B be a
function given by f (x ) = 3x − 1 . Represent this function
(i) by arrow diagram (ii) in a table form
(iii) as a set of ordered pairs (iv) in a graphical form
Solution
A = {1, 2, 3, 4} ; B = {2, 5, 8, 11, 14} ; f (x ) = 3x − 1
x 1 2 3 4
Y
f(x) 2 5 8 11 11 (4, 11)
10
(iii) Set of ordered pairs 9
8 (3, 8)
The function f can be represented as a set of ordered 7
pairs as 6
5 (2, 5)
f = {(1,2),(2,5),(3,8),(4,11)} 4
3
(iv) Graphical form (1, 2)
2
(i) one – one (ii) many – one (iii) onto (iv) into
Equivalently,
If for all a1, a2 Î A , f (a1 ) = f (a2 ) implies a1 = a2 , then f is called one – one function.
Illustration 10
A f B
A = {1,2,3,4} and B = {a,b,c,d,e} a
1
b
(i) Let f = {(1,a), (2,b), (3,d), (4,c)} 2 c
In Fig. 1.22, for different elements in A, there are different 3 d
e
images in B. 4
Fig. 1.22 f
Hence f is a one – one function. g B
A
(ii) Let g = {(1,a), (2,b), (3,c), (4,e)} a
1
b
g is a function from A to B such that g(1) = g(2) = b , 2 c
but 1 ¹ 2. 3 d
e
Thus two distinct elements 1 and 2 in the first set A have same 4 f
image b the second set in B (Fig.1.23). Hence, g is not a one–one Fig. 1.23
function. Persons Films
1.7.2 Many – one function P1
P2
In a theatre complex three films F1, F2, F3 are shown. Seven F1
P3
persons (P1 to P7) arrive at the theatre and buy tickets as shown F2
P4
(Fig.1.24).
P5 F3
If the selection of films is considered as a relation, then this P6
is a function which is many–one, since more than one person may P7
choose to watch the same film. Fig. 1.24
Illustration 11
In other words, every element in the co-domain B has a pre-image in the domain A.
Illustration 12
A f B
Let A = {x , y, z }, B = {l, m, n} ; x l
Range of f = {l, m, n} = B (Fig.1.26) y m
z n
Hence f is an onto function.
Fig. 1.26
1.7.4 Into function
Customers Products
In a home appliance showroom, the products television, air
conditioner, washing machine and water heater were provided C1 television
with 20% discount as new year sale offer. If the selection of the washing machine
C2
above products by the three customers C1, C2, C3 is considered air conditioner
C3 water heater
as a function then the following diagram (Fig.1.27) will represent
an into function. Fig. 1.27
During winter season customers usually do not prefer buying air conditioner. Here
air conditioner is not chosen by any customer. This is an example of into function.
Illustration 13
Fig. 1.28
1.7.5 Bijection
from one form to an other form and receiving back the required information is called
bijection. This process is widely used in the study of secret codes called ‘cryptography’.
Illustration 14
Illustration 15
Note
One to One Many to One
A f B A f B ¾¾ A one – one and onto
1 a 1 function is also called a
b a
2 2 one – one correspondence.
c b
3 d 3
e c
4 f 4
Thinking Corner
Fig. 1.31 Fig. 1.32
Can there be a one to
Distinct elements of A Two or more elements of
many function?
have distinct images in B. A have same image in B.
Onto Into
A f B A f B
1 1 a
a b
2 b 2 c
3 3 d
c e
4 4 f
Fig. 1.33 Fig. 1.34
To determine whether the given function is one–one or not the following test may help us.
1.7.6 Horizontal Line Test
Previously we have seen the vertical line test. Now let us see the horizontal line test.
“A function represented in a graph is one–one, if every horizontal line intersects the curve
in at most one point”.
Example 1.12 Using horizontal line test (Fig.1.35(a), 1.35(b), 1.35(c)), determine which
of the following functions are one – one.
Y Y
Y
P P
X′ O X X′ O X
X′ O X P Q
Y¢ Y¢
Y¢
Fig. 1.35(b) Fig. 1.35(c)
Fig. 1.35(a)
Solution The curves in Fig.1.35(a) and Fig.1.35(c) represent a one–one function as the
horizontal lines meet the curves in only one point P.
The curve in Fig.1.35(b) does not represent a one–one function, since, the horizontal
line meet the curve in two points P and Q.
Example 1.13 Let A = {1, 2, 3} , B = {4, 5, 6, 7} and f = {(1, 4),(2, 5),(3, 6)} be a function
from A to B. Show that f is one – one but not onto function.
A f B
Solution A = {1, 2, 3} , B = {4, 5, 6, 7} ; f = {(1, 4),(2, 5),(3, 6)}
4
Then f is a function from A to B and for different elements in 1 5
A, there are different images in B. Hence f is one–one function. Note 2 6
that the element 7 in the co-domain does not have any pre-image in 3 7
the domain. Hence f is not onto (Fig.1.36). Fig. 1.36
Therefore f is one–one but not an onto function.
Example 1.14 If A = {−2, −1, 0, 1, 2} and f : A ® B is an onto function defined by
f (x ) = x 2 + x + 1 then find B.
Solution Given A = {−2, −1, 0, 1, 2} and f (x ) = x 2 + x + 1 .
f (-2) = (−2)2 + (−2) + 1 =3; f (-1) = (−1)2 + (−1) + 1 =1
f (0) = 02 + 0 + 1 =1; f (1) = 12 + 1 + 1 = 3
f (2) = 22 + 2 + 1 = 7
Since, f is an onto function, range of f = B = co-domain of f.
Therefore, B = {1, 3, 7} .
Example 1.15 Let f be a function f : ® be defined by f (x ) = 3x + 2, x ∈
(i) Find the images of 1, 2, 3 (ii) Find the pre-images of 29, 53
(ii) Identify the type of function
Solution The function f : ® is defined by f (x ) = 3x + 2
(i) If x = 1, f (1) = 3(1) + 2 = 5
If x = 2, f (2) = 3(2) + 2 = 8
If x = 3 , f (3) = 3(3) + 2 = 11
The images of 1, 2, 3 are 5, 8, 11 respectively.
(ii) If x is the pre-image of 29, then f (x ) = 29 . Hence 3x + 2 = 29
3x = 27 ⇒ x = 9 .
Similarly, if x is the pre-image of 53, then f (x ) = 53 . Hence 3x + 2 = 53
3x = 51 ⇒ x = 17 .
Thus the pre-images of 29 and 53 are 9 and 17 respectively.
(iii) Since different elements of have different images in the co-domain, the
function f is one – one function.
The co-domain of f is .
But the range of f = {5, 8, 11, 14, 17, ...} is a proper subset of .
Therefore f is not an onto function. That is, f is an into function.
Thus f is one – one and into function.
Example 1.16 Forensic scientists can determine the height (in cms) of a person based on
the length of their thigh bone. They usually do so using the function h(b) = 2 ⋅ 47b + 54 ⋅ 10
where b is the length of the thigh bone.
(ii) Also find the height of a person if the length of his thigh bone is 50 cms.
(iii) Find the length of the thigh bone if the height of a person is 147 × 96 cms.
2 × 47b1 = 2 ⋅ 47b2 ⇒ b1 = b2
(ii) If the length of the thigh bone b = 50, then the height is
h(50) = (2 ⋅ 47 × 50) + 54 ⋅ 10 = 177 ⋅ 6 cms.
(iii) If the height of a person is 147 × 96 cms, then h(b) = 147 ⋅ 96 and so the length of
the thigh bone is given by 2 ⋅ 47b + 54 ⋅ 10 = 147 ⋅ 96 .
93 ⋅ 86
b = = 38
2 ⋅ 47
Therefore, the length of the thigh bone is 38 cms.
Activity 3
Check whether the following curves represent a function. In the case of a function,
check whether it is one-one? (Hint: Use the vertical and the horizontal line tests)
(i) Y (ii) Y (iii) Y
O X′ O X X′ O X
X′ X
Y¢ Y¢ Y¢
X′ O X′ O X X′ O X
X
Y¢ Y¢ Y¢
(i) Constant function (ii) Identity function (iii) Real – valued function
Progress Check
3(1) – 5 = b ⇒ b = –2
Example 1.18 The distance S (in kms) travelled by a particle in time ‘t’ hours is given by
t2 + t
S (t ) = . Find the distance travelled by the particle after
2
(i) three and half hours.
(ii) eight hours and fifteen minutes.
t2 + t
Solution The distance travelled by the particle in time t hours is given by S (t ) =
2
(3.5)2 + 3.5 15.75
(i)
t = 3.5 hours. Therefore, S(3.5) = = = 7.875
2 2
The distance travelled in 3.5 hours is 7.875 kms.
(8.25)2 + 8.25 76.3125
(ii)
t = 8.25 hours. Therefore, S(8.25) = = = 38.15625
2 2
The distance travelled in 8.25 hours is 38.16 kms, approximately.
2x + 7, x < −2
Example 1.19 If the function ff :: R is defined by f (x ) = x 2 – 2,−2 ≤x < 3 ,
R ®
then find the values of 3x − 2, x ≥ 3
f (1) - 3 f (4)
(i) f (4) (ii) f (-2) (iii) f (4) + 2 f (1) (iv)
f (-3)
Solution I II III
)[ )[
X′
-6 -5 -4 -3 -2 -1 0 1 2 3 4 5 6 X
The function f is defined by three values in
f(x) = 2x+7 f(x) = x2–2 f(x) = 3x–2
intervals I, II, III as shown by the side Fig. 1.39
For a given value of x = a , find out the interval at which the point a is located, there
after find f (a ) using the particular value defined in that interval.
(ii)
x = −2 lies in the second interval.
Therefore, f (x ) = x 2 – 2 ⇒ f (1) = 12 – 2 = −1
Exercise 1.4
1. Determine whether the graph given below represent functions. Give reason for your
answers concerning each graph.
Y
(i) (ii) (iii) (iv)
Y Y Y
X′ O X X′ O X X′ O X X′ O X
Y¢ Y¢ Y¢ Y¢
x
2. Let f : A ® B be a function defined by f (x ) = − 1, where A = {2, 4, 6, 10, 12} ,
2
B = {0, 1, 2, 4, 5, 9} . Represent f by
(i) set of ordered pairs; (ii) a table; (iii) an arrow diagram; (iv) a graph
7. In each of the following cases state whether the function is bijective or not. Justify
your answer.
(i) f : ® defined by f (x ) = 2x + 1 (ii) f : ® defined by f (x ) = 3 – 4x 2
Relations and Functions 25
12. The function ‘t’ which maps temperature in Celsius (C) into temperature in
9
Fahrenheit (F) is defined by t(C ) = F where F = C + 32 . Find,
5
(i) t(0) (ii) t(28) (iii) t(-10)
(iv) the value of C when t(C ) = 212
(v) the temperature when the Celsius value is equal to the Farenheit value.
Illustration
A B C
Consider the set A of all students, who appeared in
g
class X of Board Examination. Each student appearing f
c = g (b)
f (a) = b
in the Board Examination is assigned a roll number. Student Roll
g (f (a))
Code
In order to have confidentiality, the Board arranges to Numbers
Numbers
deface the roll number of each student and assigns a
code number to each roll number.
gf
Let A be the set of all students appearing for the Fig. 1.41
board exam. B Í be the set all roll numbers and
C Í be the set of all code numbers (Fig.1.41). This gives rise to two functions f : A ® B
and g : B ® C given by b = f (a ) be the roll number assigned to student a, c = g(b) be the
code number assigned to roll number b, where a Î A , b Î B and c Î C .
We can write c = g(b) = g(f (a )) .
Thus, by the combination of these two functions, each student is eventually attached
a code number. This idea leads to the following definition. A B C
f g
Definition
Let f : A ® B and g : B ® C be two functions x f(x) g(f(x))
(Fig.1.42). Then the composition of f and g denoted
by g f is defined as the function g f (x ) = g( f (x )) >
for all x Î A . gf
Fig. 1.42
Example 1.20 Find f g and g f when f (x ) = 2x + 1
and g(x ) = x 2 − 2 Thinking Corner
Solution f (x ) = 2x + 1 , g(x) = x2 –2
If f (x ) = x m and
2 2 2
f g(x ) = f (g(x )) = f (x − 2) = 2(x − 2) + 1 = 2x − 3 g(x ) = x n does
g f (x ) = g( f (x )) = g(2x + 1) = (2x + 1)2 − 2 = 4x 2 + 4x − 1 f g =g f ?
Thus f g = 2x 2 − 3, g f = 4x 2 + 4x − 1 . From the above, we see that f g ¹ g f .
Note
¾¾ Generally, f g ¹ g f for any two functions f and g. So, composition of functions is
not commutative.
Then, f (x ) = 2x 2 − 5x + 3 = f2 (x )
= f1 f2 (x ) = f1 f2 (x )
Thus, f g(x ) = 6x + 3k − 2 .
g f (x ) = g(3x − 2) = 2(3x − 2) + k
The Composition
Thus, g f (x ) = 6x − 4 + k . g f (x ) exists only
Given that f g = g f when range of f is a
subset of domain of g.
Therefore, 6x + 3k − 2 = 6x − 4 + k
6x − 6x + 3k − k = −4 + 2 ⇒ k = −1
Thus, f f (k ) = 4k − 3
Therefore 4k - 3 = 5 ⇒ k = 2 .
(hg)f=h(gf)
1.9.1 Composition of three functions gf
Then,
( f g ) h(x ) = ( f g )(h(x )) = ( f g )(3x ) = 5 − 4(3x ) = 5 − 12x ....(1)
g (9x + 4) = [ (9x + 4) + 3] = 9x + 7
= f [ g (x + 3)] = f [ (x + 3) + 3] = f (x + 6)
f (x + 6) = [ 3(x + 6) + 1 ] = 3x + 19
These two quantities being equal, we get 9x + 7 = 3x + 19. Solving this equation we
obtain x = 2.
Progress Check
State your answer for the following questions by selecting the correct option.
1. Composition of functions is commutative
(a) Always true (b) Never true (c) Sometimes true
2. Composition of functions is associative
(a) Always true (b) Never true (c) Sometimes true
Activity 4
Given that h(x ) = f g(x ) , fill in the table for h(x )
How to find h(1) ?
x f(x) x g(x) x h(x)
h(x ) = f g(x )
1 2 1 2 1 3
2 3 2 4 2 -
h(1) = f g(1)
3 1 3 3 3 -
= f (2) = 3
4 4 4 1 4 -
Therefore, h(1) = 3
1.10 Identifying the graphs of Linear, Quadratic, Cubic and Reciprocal functions
Graphs provide visualization of curves and functions. Hence, graphs help a lot in
understanding the concepts in a much efficient way.
In this section, we will be discussing about the identification of some of the functions
through their graphs. In particular, we discuss graphs of Linear, Quadratic, Cubic and
Reciprocal functions.
Some Specific Linear Functions and their graphs are given below.
Function f (x ) = x 3
2
1
X′ -4 -3 -2 -1 0 1 2 3 4 X
-1
-2 f (x ) = x
-3
-4
Y¢
Fig. 1.44
2 Additive inverse f : ® defined by 4
Y
function f (x ) = −x 3
2
1
X′ -4 -3 -2 -1 0
1 2 3 4 X
-1
-2
-3
-4 f (x ) = −x
Y¢
Fig. 1.45
Note
¾ Modulus function is not a linear function but it is composed of two linear functions x
and –x.
¾ Linear functions are always one-one functions and has applications in Cryptography as
well as in several branches of Science and Technology.
X′ O X
Y′
Fig. 1.47(a)
Y
f :® defined by f (x ) = −x 2 , x ∈ . O
X′ X
f (x ) ∈ (−∞, 0]
Y′
Fig. 1.47(b)
Fig. 1.50
Progress Check
Exercise 1.5
1. Using the functions f and g given below, find f g and g f . Check whether
f g =g f .
2
(i) f (x ) = x − 6, g(x ) = x 2 (ii) f (x ) = , g(x ) = 2x 2 − 1
x
x +6
(iii) f (x ) = , g(x ) = 3 − x (iv) f (x ) = 3 + x , g(x ) = x − 4
3
(v) f (x ) = 4x 2 − 1, g(x ) = 1 + x
9. Let f = {(−1, 3), (0, −1), (2, −9)} be a linear function from into . Find f (x).
10. In electrical circuit theory, a circuit C(t) is called a linear circuit if it satisfies the
superposition principle given by C (at1 + bt2 ) = aC (t1 ) + bC (t2 ) , where a, b are
constants. Show that the circuit C (t ) = 3t is linear.
Exercise 1.6
14. If g = {(1, 1),(2, 3),(3, 5),(4, 7)} is a function given by g(x ) = αx + β then the values of
a and b are
(1) (–1,2) (2)(2, –1) (3) (–1, –2) (4) (1,2)
Unit Exercise - 1
1. If the ordered pairs (x 2 − 3x , y 2 + 4y ) and (-2, 5) are equal, then find x and y.
2. The cartesian product A×A has 9 elements among which (–1, 0) and (0, 1) are found.
Find the set A and the remaining elements of A×A.
x − 1 x ≥ 1
3. Given that f (x ) = . Find
4 x < 1
(i) f (0) (ii) f (3) (iii) f (a + 1) in terms of a.(Given that a ³ 0 )
4. Let A = {9, 10, 11, 12, 13, 14, 15, 16, 17} and let f : A ® N be defined by f (n ) = the highest
prime factor of n Î A . Write f as a set of ordered pairs and find the range of f.
34 10th Standard Mathematics
7. Let A = {1, 2} and B = {1, 2, 3, 4} , C = {5, 6} and D = {5, 6, 7, 8} . Verify whether A×C
is a subset of B×D?
x −1 1
8. If f (x ) = , x ≠ 1 show that f (f (x )) = − , provided x ¹ 0 .
x +1 x
x −2
9. The functions f and g are defined by f (x ) = 6x + 8; g(x ) =
3
1
(i) Calculate the value of gg
2
Points to Remember
zz The Cartesian Product of A with B is defined as A × B = {(a, b) | for all a Î A,
b Î B}
zz A relation R from A to B is always a subset of A ´ B . That is R ⊆ A × B
zz A relation R from X to Y is a function if for every x Î X there exists only one y Î Y .
zz A function can be represented by
zz Constant function f (x ) = c
zz Linear function f (x ) = ax + b , a ¹ 0
zz Quadratic function f (x ) = ax 2 + bx + c , a ¹ 0
zz Cubic function f (x ) = ax 3 + bx 2 + cx + d , a ¹ 0
ICT CORNER
ICT 1.1
Step 1: Open the Browser type the URL Link given below (or) Scan the QR Code. GeoGebra work
book named “Relations and Functions–X” will open. In the left side of the work book there are many
activity related to Relations and Functions chapter. Select the work sheet “Functions Identification”
Step 2: In the given worksheet click on the check boxes corresponding to each function on left hand
side. You can see the graph of respective function on Right hand side. Analyse each graph and then
click “New Functions” and continue till you understand.
Step 1 Step 2 Expected results
ICT 1.2
Step 1: Open the Browser type the URL Link given below (or) Scan the QR Code. GeoGebra work
book named “Relations and Functions–X” will open. In the left side of the work book there are many
activity related to Relations and Functions chapter. Select the work sheet “Composition of Functions”
Step 2: In the given worksheet click on the check boxes corresponding to each function on left hand
side. You can see the graph of respective function on Right hand side. Analyse each graph and then
click “New Functions” and continue till you understand.
Step 1 Step 2 Expected results
https://www.geogebra.org/m/jfr2zzgy#chapter/356191
or Scan the QR Code.
2
NUMBERS AND SEQUENCES
“I know numbers are beautiful, if they aren’t beautiful, nothing is”
- Paul Erdos
Learning Outcomes
z To study the concept of Euclid’s Division Lemma.
z To understand Euclid’s Division Algorithm.
z To find the LCM and HCF using Euclid’s Division Algorithm.
z To understand the Fundamental Theorem of Arithmetic.
z To understand the congruence modulo ‘n’, addition modulo ‘n’ and
multiplication modulo ‘n’.
z To define sequence and to understand sequence as a function.
z To define an Arithmetic Progression (A.P.) and Geometric Progression (G.P.).
z To find the n th term of an A.P. and its sum to n terms.
z To find the n th term of a G.P. and its sum to n terms.
z To determine the sum of some finite series such as å n , å n 2 , å n 3 .
2.1 Introduction
The study of numbers has fascinated humans
since several thousands of years. The discovery of
Lebombo and Ishango bones which existed around
25000 years ago has confirmed the fact that humans
made counting process for meeting various day to
day needs. By making notches in the bones they
carried out counting efficiently. Most consider
that these bones were used as lunar calendar for
knowing the phases of moon thereby understanding Number carvings in Ishango Bone
the seasons. Thus the bones were considered to be Fig.2.1
the ancient tools for counting. We have come a long way since this primitive counting
method existed.
It is very true that the patterns exhibited by numbers have fascinated almost all
professional mathematicians’ right from the time of Pythagoras to current time. We will be
discussing significant concepts provided by Euclid and continue our journey of studying
Modular Arithmetic and knowing about Sequences and Finite Series. These ideas are
most fundamental to your progress in mathematics for upcoming classes. It is time for us
to begin our journey to understand the most fascinating part of mathematics, namely, the
study of numbers.
Example 2.1 We have 34 cakes. Each box can hold 5 cakes only. How many boxes we
need to pack and how many cakes are unpacked?
Solution We see that 6 boxes are required to pack 30 cakes with 4 cakes left over. This
distribution of cakes can be understood as follows:
34 = 5 × 6 + 4
Total number = Number of cakes × Number of + Number of cakes
of cakes in each box boxes left over
Note
¾¾ The above lemma is nothing but a restatement of the long division process, the integers
q and r are called quotient and remainder respectively.
¾¾ When a positive integer is divided by 2 the remainder is either 0 or 1. So, any positive
integer will of the form 2k, 2k+1 for some integer k.
Euclid’s Division Lemma can be generalised to any two integers.
Generalised form of Euclid’s division lemma.
If a and b are any two integers then there exist unique integers q and r such that
� +�r , where 0 ≤r <b
a �=bq
Example 2.2 Find the quotient and remainder when a is divided by b in the following
cases (i) a = −12 , b = 5 (ii) a = 17 , b = −3 (iii) a = −19 , b = −4
Solutions
Thinking Corner
(i) a = −12 , b = 5
When a positive integer is divided by 3
By Euclid’s division lemma
1. What are the possible remainders?
a = bq + r , where 0 ≤ r < b
2. In which form can it be written?
−12 = 5 × (−3) + 3 0≤r < 5
Therefore, Quotient q = −3, Remainder r = 3
(ii)
a = 17 b = −3 Progress Check
By Euclid’s division lemma
a = bq + r , where 0 ≤ r < b Find q and r for the following pairs of
integers a and b satisfying a = bq + r .
17 = (−3) × (−5) + 2 0 ≤ r < −3
1. a = 13, b = 3 4. a = –32, b = –12
Therefore Quotient q = −5, 2. a = 18, b = 4 5. a = –31, b = 7
Remainder r = 2 3. a = 21, b = –4
(iii)
a = −19, b = −4
By Euclid’s division lemma
a = bq + r , where 0 ≤ r < b
Numbers and Sequences 39
Note
¾¾ The above algorithm will always produce remainder zero at some stage. Hence the
algorithm should terminate.
¾¾ Euclid’s Division Algorithm is a repeated application of Division Lemma until we get
zero remainder.
¾¾ Highest Common Factor (HCF) of two positive numbers is denoted by (a,b).
¾¾ Highest Common Factor (HCF) is also called as Greatest Common Divisor (GCD).
Progress Check
Illustration 1
Using the above Algorithm, let us find HCF of two given positive integers. Let a = 273
and b = 119 be the two given positive integers such that a > b .
We start dividing 273 by 119 using Euclid’s division lemma, we get
273 = 119 × 2 + 35 …(1)
The remainder is 35 ¹ 0 .
Therefore, applying Euclid’s Division Algorithm to the divisor 119 and remainder 35,
we get
119 = 35 × 3 + 14 …(2)
The remainder is 14 ¹ 0 .
Applying Euclid’s Division Algorithm to the divisor 35 and remainder 14, we get
35 =14 ×2 +7 …(3)
The remainder is 7 ≠ 0.
Applying Euclid’s Division Algorithm to the divisor 14 and remainder 7. we get,
14 =7 × 2 +0 …(4)
The remainder at this stage = 0 .
The divisor at this stage = 7 .
Therefore Highest Common Factor of 273, 119 = 7.
Example 2.4 If the Highest Common Factor of 210 and 55 is expressible in the form
55x - 325 , find x.
Solution Using Euclid’s Division Algorithm, let us find the HCF of given numbers
210 = 55 × 3 + 45
55 = 45 × 1 + 10
45 = 10 × 4 + 5
10 = 5 × 2 + 0
The remainder is zero.
So, the last divisor 5 is the Highest Common Factor (HCF) of 210 and 55.
Since, HCF is expressible in the form 55x − 325 = 5
gives 55x = 330
Hence x = 6
Numbers and Sequences 41
Example 2.5 Find the greatest number that will divide 445 and 572 leaving remainders
4 and 5 respectively.
Solution Since the remainders are 4, 5 respectively the required number is the HCF of the
number 445 − 4 = 441, 572 − 5 = 567 .
Hence, we will determine the HCF of 441 and 567. Using Euclid’s Division Algorithm,
we have
441 = 126 × 3 + 63
126 = 63 × 2 + 0
Activity 1
This activity helps you to find HCF of two positive numbers. We first observe the
following instructions.
(i) Construct a rectangle whose length and breadth are the given numbers.
(ii) Try to fill the rectangle using small squares.
(iii) Try with 1×1 square; Try with 2×2 square; Try with 3 ´ 3 square and so on.
(iv) The side of the largest square that can fill the whole rectangle without any
gap will be HCF of the given numbers.
(v) Find the HCF of (a) 12,20 (b) 16,24 (c) 11,9
Theorem 3
If a, b are two positive integers with a > b then G.C.D of (a,b) = GCD of (a - b, b) .
Activity 2
This is another activity to determine HCF of two given positive integers.
(i) From the given numbers, subtract the smaller from the larger number.
(ii) From the remaining numbers, subtract smaller from the larger.
(iii) Repeat the subtraction process by subtracting smaller from the larger.
(v) The number representing equal numbers obtained in step (iv), will be the
HCF of the given numbers.
Exercise 2.1
...
...
...
...
...
In general, we conclude that
q q q q
given a composite number N, we p1 p2 p3 p4 ...
q
1 2 3 4
pn n
numbers.
First, we try to factorize N into its factors. If all the
Thinking Corner
factors are themselves primes then we can stop. Otherwise,
we try to further split the factors which are not prime. Is 1 a prime number?
Continue the process till we get only prime numbers.
Illustration
Progress Check
For example, if we try to factorize
32760 we get 1. Every natural number except ______
can be expressed as ______.
32760 = 2 × 2 × 2 × 3 × 3 × 5 × 7 × 13
2. In how many ways a composite
= 23 × 32 × 51 × 71 × 131
number can be written as product of
Thus, in whatever way we try to power of primes?
factorize 32760, we should finally get three
3. The number of divisors of any prime
2’s, two 3’s, one 5, one 7 and one 13. number is ______.
The fact that “Every composite number
can be written uniquely as the product of power of primes” is called Fundamental
Theorem of Arithmetic.
Activity 3
Exercise 2.2
1. For what values of natural number n, 4n can end with the digit 6?
2. If m, n are natural numbers, for what values of m, does 2n ´ 5m ends in 5?
3. Find the HCF of 252525 and 363636.
4. If 13824 = 2a × 3b then find a and b.
5. If p1x × p2x × p3x × p4x = 113400 where p1, p2 , p3 , p4 are primes in ascending order and
1 2 3 4
Thus the equation n = mq + r through Euclid’s Division lemma can also be written
as n º r (mod m).
48 10th Standard Mathematics
Note
¾¾ Two integers a and b are congruent modulo Thinking Corner
m, written as a º b (mod m), if they leave How many integers exist which leave
the same remainder when divided by m. a remainder of 2 when divided by 3?
2.5.3 Modulo operations
Similar to basic arithmetic operations like addition, subtraction and multiplication
performed on numbers we can think of performing same operations in modulo arithmetic.
The following theorem provides the information of doing this.
Theorem 5
a, b, c and d are integers and m is a positive integer such that if a º b (mod m) and
c º d (mod m) then
(i) (a + c) ≡ (b + d ) (mod m) (ii) (a − c) ≡ (b − d ) (mod m)
(iii) (a × c) ≡ (b × d ) (mod m)
Illustration 3
If 17 º 4 (mod 13) and 42 º 3 (mod 13) then from theorem 5,
59 º 7 (mod 13)
Progress Check
2. If 59 º3 (mod 7), 46 º4 (mod 7) then 105 º _______ (mod 7),
13 º _______ (mod 7), 413 º _______ (mod 7), 368 ≡ _______ (mod 7).
Example 2.11 Find the remainders when 70004 and 778 is divided by 7.
Solution Since 70000 is divisible by 7
70000 º 0 (mod 7)
70000 + 4 ≡ 0 + 4 (mod 7)
70004 º 4 (mod 7)
Therefore, the remainder when 70004 is divided by 7 is 4.
Since 777 is divisible by 7
777 º 0 (mod 7)
777 + 1 ≡ 0 + 1 (mod 7)
778 º 1 (mod 7)
Therefore, the remainder when 778 is divided by 7 is 1.
Note
¾¾ While solving congruent equations, we get infinitely many solutions compared to
finite number of solutions in solving a polynomial equation in Algebra.
15k + 1
x=
3
1
x = 5k +
3
1
Since 5k is an integer, 5k + cannot be an integer.
3
So there is no integer solution.
Example 2.17 A man starts his journey from Chennai to Delhi by train. He starts at 22.30
hours on Wednesday. If it takes 32 hours of travelling time and assuming that the train is
not late, when will he reach Delhi?
Solution Starting time 22.30, Travelling time 32 hours. Here we use modulo 24.
Example 2.18 Kala and Vani are friends. Kala says, “Today is my birthday” and she
asks Vani, “When will you celebrate your birthday?” Vani replies, “Today is Monday
and I celebrated my birthday 75 days ago”. Find the day when Vani celebrated her
birthday.
Solution Let us associate the numbers 0, 1, 2, 3, 4, 5, 6 to represent the weekdays from
Sunday to Saturday respectively.
Vani says today is Monday. So the number for Monday is 1. Since Vani’s birthday was
75 days ago, we have to subtract 75 from 1 and take the modulo 7, since a week contain 7
days.
–74 (mod 7) º –4 (mod 7) º 7–4 (mod 7) º 3 (mod 7)
(Since, −74 – 3 = −77 is divisible by 7)
Thus, 1 − 75 ≡ 3 (mod 7)
The day for the number 3 is Wednesday.
Therefore, Vani’s birthday must be on Wednesday.
Exercise 2.3
1. Find the least positive value of x such that
(i) 71 º x (mod 8) (ii) 78 + x ≡ 3 (mod 5) (iii) 89 ≡ (x + 3) (mod 4)
x
(iv) 96 º (mod 5) (v) 5x º 4 (mod 6)
7
2. If x is congruent to 13 modulo 17 then 7x - 3 is congruent to which number modulo 17?
3. Solve 5x º 4 (mod 6)
4. Solve 3x − 2 ≡ 0 (mod 11)
5. What is the time 100 hours after 7 a.m.?
6. What is the time 15 hours before 11 p.m.?
7. Today is Tuesday. My uncle will come after 45 days. In which day my uncle will be
coming?
8. Prove that 2n + 6 × 9n is always divisible by 7 for any positive integer n.
9. Find the remainder when 281 is divided by 17.
10. The duration of flight travel from Chennai to London through British Airlines is
approximately 11 hours. The airplane begins its journey on Sunday at 23:30 hours. If
the time at Chennai is four and half hours ahead to that of London’s time, then find
the time at London, when will the flight lands at London Airport.
2.6 Sequences
Definition
A real valued sequence is a function defined on the set of natural numbers and
taking real values.
Each element in the sequence is called a term of the sequence. The element in the
first position is called the first term of the sequence. The element in the second position
is called second term of the sequence and so on.
If the n th term is denoted by an , then a1 is the first term, a2 is the second term, and so on.
A sequence can be written as a1, a2 , a 3 ,..., an ,...
Illustration
1. 1,3,5,7,... is a sequence with general term an = 2n − 1 . When we put n = 1, 2, 3,..., we
get a1 =1, a2 = 3, a 3 = 5, a 4 = 7,...
1 1 1 1 1
2. , , , ,... is a sequence with general term . When we put n = 1,2,3,.... we get
2 3 4 5 n +1
1 1 1 1
a1 = , a2 = , a 3 = , a 4 = ,...
2 3 4 5
If the number of elements in a sequence is finite then it is called a Finite sequence.
If the number of elements in a sequence is infinite then it is called an Infinite sequence.
Sequence as a Function N f R
1 a1
A sequence can be considered as a function defined on the
2 a2
set of natural numbers N. In particular, a sequence is a function 3 a3
f : N ® R , where R is the set of all real numbers. 4 a4
5 a5
If the sequence is of the form a1, a2 , a 3 ,... then we can associate
the function to the sequence a1, a2 , a 3 ,... by f (k ) = ak , k = 1,2,3,...
Fig 2.10
Progress Check
In the above sequence the numerators are same and the denominator is increased by 4.
1 1
So the next three terms are a 5 = =
14 + 4 18 Note
a 6 =
1
=
1 ¾ ¾ Though all the
18 + 4 22 sequences are functions,
1 1 not all the functions are
a 7 = = sequences.
22 + 4 26
Here each term is decreased by 3. So the next three terms are -7, -10, -13 .
Here each term is divided by 10. Hence, the next three terms are
0.01
a4 = = 0.001
10
0.001
a5 = = 0.0001
10
0.0001
a6 = = 0.00001
10
Example 2.20 Find the general term for the following sequences
1 2 3
(i) 3, 6, 9,... (ii) , , ,... (iii) 5, -25, 125,...
2 3 4
Solution (i) 3, 6, 9,...
Here the terms are multiples of 3. So the general term is
an = 3n,
1 2 3
(ii) , , ,...
2 3 4
1 2 3
a1 = ; a 2 = ; a 3 =
2 3 4
We see that the numerator of nth term is n, and the denominator is one
n
more than the numerator. Hence, an = ,n ∈ N
n +1
(iii) 5, -25, 125,...
The terms of the sequence have + and – sign alternatively and also they are
in powers of 5.
So the general term an = (−1)n +1 5n , n ∈ N
Example 2.22 Find the first five terms of the following sequence.
an −1
a1 = 1 , a 2 = 1 , a n = ; n ≥ 3, n ∈ N
an −2 + 3
Solution The first two terms of this sequence are given by a1 = 1 , a2 = 1 . The third term
a3 depends on the first and second terms.
a 3−1 a2 1 1
a3 = = = =
a 3−2 + 3
a1 + 3 1+3 4
Similarly the fourth term a 4 depends upon a2 and a 3 .
1 1
a 4−1 a3 1 1 1
a4 = = = 4 = 4 = × =
a 4−2 + 3 a2 + 3 1 + 3 4 4 4 16
In the same way, the fifth term a 5 can be calculated as
1
a 5−1 a4 16 1 4 1
a5 = = = = × =
a 5−2 + 3 a3 + 3 1 16 13 52
+3
4
1 1 1
Therefore, the first five terms of the sequence are 1, 1, , ,
4 16 25
Exercise 2.4
Illustration 2
A man got a job whose initial monthly salary is fixed at ₹10,000 with an annual
increment of ₹ 2000 . His salary during 1st , 2nd and 3rd years will be ₹ 10000 , ₹ 12000
and ₹ 14000 respectively.
If we now calculate the difference of the salaries for the successive years, we get
12000 – 10000 = 2000; 14000 – 12000 = 2000 . Thus the difference between the successive
numbers (salaries) is always 2000.
Did you observe the common property behind these two illustrations? In these two
examples, the difference between successive terms always remains constant. Moreover,
each term is obtained by adding a fixed number (2 and 2000 in illustrations 1 and 2
presented above) to the preceding term except the first term. This fixed number
which is a constant for the differences between successive terms is called the “common
difference”.
Definition
Let a and d be real numbers. Then the numbers of the form a, a + d , a + 2d ,
a + 3d , a + 4d , ... is said to form Arithmetic Progression denoted by A.P. The
number ‘a’ is called the first term and ‘d’ is called the common difference.
Simply, an Arithmetic Progression is a sequence whose successive terms differ by a
constant number. Thus, for example, the set of even positive integers 2, 4, 6, 8, 10, 12,… is
an A.P. whose first term is a = 2 and common difference is also d = 2 since 4 − 2 = 2,
6 − 4 = 2, 8 − 6 = 2, …
Most of common real−life situations often produce numbers in A.P.
Note
¾¾ The difference between any two consecutive terms of an A.P. is always constant. That
constant value is called the common difference.
¾¾ If there are finite numbers of terms in an A.P. then it is called Finite Arithmetic
Progression. If there are infinitely many terms in an A.P. then it is called Infinite
Arithmetic Progression.
t4 = a + 3d = a + (4 − 1)d , . . .
2. In general to find the common difference of an A.P. we should subtract first term
from the second term, second from the third and so on.
Numbers and Sequences 57
For example, t1 = a, t2 = a + d
Therefore, t2 − t1 = (a + d ) − a = d
Similarly, t2 = a + d, t3 = a + 2d,...
Therefore, t3 − t2 = (a + 2d ) − (a + d ) = d
In general, d = t2 − t1 = t3 − t2 = t4 − t3 = ....
So, d = tn − tn −1 for n = 2, 3, 4,...
Progress Check
Example 2.23 Check whether the following sequences are in A.P. or not?
(i) x + 2, 2x + 3, 3x + 4,... (ii) 2, 4, 8, 16,... (iii) 3 2, 5 2, 7 2, 9 2,...
Solution To check that the given sequence is in A.P., it is enough to check if the differences
between the consecutive terms are equal or not.
(i)
t2 - t1 = (2x + 3) − (x + 2) = x + 1
t3 - t2 = (3x + 4) − (2x + 3) = x + 1
t2 - t1 = t3 − t2
Thus, the differences between consecutive terms are equal.
Hence the sequence x + 2, 2x + 3, 3x + 4,... is in A.P.
(ii) t2 - t1 = 4 − 2 = 2
t3 - t2 = 8 − 4 = 4
t2 - t1 = t3 − t2
Thus, the differences between consecutive terms are not equal. Hence the terms
of the sequence 2, 4, 8, 16, . . . are not in A.P.
(iii) t2 - t1 = 5 2 − 3 2 = 2 2
t 3 - t2 = 7 2 − 5 2 = 2 2
t4 - t3 = 9 2 − 7 2 = 2 2
Thus, the differences between consecutive terms are equal. Hence the terms of the
sequence 3 2, 5 2, 7 2, 9 2,... are in A.P.
Example 2.24 Write an A.P. whose first term is 20 and common difference is 8.
Solution First term = a = 20 ; common difference = d= 8
Arithmetic Progression is a, a + d, a + 2d, a + 3d,...
In this case, we get 20, 20 + 8, 20 + 2(8), 20 + 3(8),...
So, the required A.P. is 20, 28, 36, 44, … Note
¾¾ An Arithmetic progression having a common difference of zero is called a constant
arithmetic progression.
Activity 4
There are five boxes here. You have to pick one number from each box and form five
Arithmetic Progressions.
8 6 14 1 26 3.5 20 11 32 8.5
–8 40 –14 –11 –2
12 85 –5 2 7 55 –3 70 17 100
Example 2.25 Find the 15th , 24th and n th term (general term) of an A.P. given by 3, 15,
27, 39,…
Solution We have, first term = a = 3 and common difference = d = 15 − 3 = 12 .
We know that n th term (general term) of an A.P. with first term a and common
difference d is given by tn = a + (n − 1)d
t15 =a +(15 − 1)d = a + 14d = 3 + 14 (12) = 171
(Here a = 3 and d = 12)
t24 = a + (24 − 1)d =a +23d =3 +23(12) = 279
The n th (general term) term is given by tn = a + (n − 1) d
Thus, tn = 3 + (n − 1)12
tn = 12n − 9
Note
¾¾ In a finite A.P. whose first term is a and last term l, then the number of terms in the A.P.
l − a
is given by l = a + (n − 1)d gives n = + 1
d
Example 2.26 Find the number of terms in the A.P. 3, 6, 9, 12,…, 111.
Solution
Progress Check
First term a = 3 ; common difference
d = 6 − 3 = 3 ; last term l = 111 1. The common difference of a
l − a constant A.P. is _______.
We know that, n = + 1 2. If a and l are first and last terms of
d
an A.P. then the number of terms is
111 − 3
n = + 1 = 37 _______.
3
Thus the A.P. contain 37 terms.
Example 2.27 Determine the general term of an A.P. whose 7th term is −1 and 16th term
is 17.
Solution Let the A.P. be t1, t2 , t3 , t4 ,...
Example 2.28 If l th , m th and nth terms of an A.P. are x, y, z respectively, then show that
(i) x (m − n ) + y (n − l ) + z (l − m ) = 0 (ii) (x − y )n + (y − z )l + (z− x )m = 0
Solution (i) Let a be the first term and d be the common difference. It is given that
tl = x , tm = y, tn = z
We have, x (m − n ) + y(n − l ) + z (l − m )
= a[(m − n ) + (n − l ) + (l − m )] + d [(m − n )(l − 1) + (n − l )(m − 1) + (l − m )(n − 1)]
= a[0] + d[lm − ln − m + n + mn − lm − n + l + ln − mn − l + m ]
= a(0) + d(0) = 0
(ii) On subtracting equation (2) from equation (1), equation (3) from equation (2)
and equation (1) from equation (3), we get
x − y = (l − m )d
y − z = (m − n )d
z − x = (n − l )d
(x − y )n + (y − z )l + (z − x )m = [(l − m )n + (m − n )l + (n − l )m ]d
= ln − mn + lm − nl + nm − lm d = 0
Note
In an Arithmetic Progression
¾¾ If every term is added or subtracted by a constant, then the resulting sequence is also
an A.P.
¾¾ If every term is multiplied or divided by a non-zero number, then the resulting sequence
is also an A.P.
¾¾ If the sum of three consecutive terms of an A.P. is given, then they can be taken as
a - d, a and a + d . Here the common difference is d.
¾¾ If the sum of four consecutive terms of an A.P. is given then, they can be taken as
a - 3d , a - d , a + d and a + 3d . Here common difference is 2d.
Example 2.29 In an A.P., sum of four consecutive terms is 28 and their sum of their
squares is 276. Find the four numbers.
Solution Let us take the four terms in the form (a - 3d ), (a - d ), (a + d ) and (a + 3d ) .
Since sum of the four terms is 28,
a − 3d + a − d + a + d + a + 3d = 28
4a = 28 gives a = 7
Similarly, since sum of their squares is 276,
(a − 3d )2 + (a − d )2 + (a + d )2 + (a + 3d )2 = 276.
a 2 − 6ad + 9d 2 + a 2 − 2ad + d 2 + a 2 + 2ad + d 2 + a 2 + 6ad + 9d 2 = 276
4a 2 +20d 2 =276 ⇒ 4(7)2 + 20d 2 = 276.
d 2 = 4 gives d = ± 2
Progress Check
1. If every term of an A.P. is multiplied by 3, then the common difference of the new
A.P. is _______.
2. Three numbers a, b and c will be in A.P. if and only if _______.
Exercise 2.5
3. Find the first term and common difference of the Arithmetic Progressions whose nth
terms are given below
(i) tn = −3 + 2n (ii) tn = 4 − 7n
7. If nine times ninth term is equal to the fifteen times fifteenth term, show that six
times twenty fourth term is zero.
9. Find x, y and z, given that the numbers x, 10, y, 24, z are in A.P.
10. In a theatre, there are 20 seats in the front row and 30 rows were allotted. Each
successive row contains two additional seats than its front row. How many seats are
there in the last row?
11. The sum of three consecutive terms that are in A.P. is 27 and their product is 288.
Find the three terms.
12. The ratio of 6th and 8th term of an A.P. is 7:9. Find the ratio of 9th term to 13th term.
13. In a winter season let us take the temperature of Ooty from Monday to Friday to be
in A.P. The sum of temperatures from Monday to Wednesday is 0° C and the sum of
the temperatures from Wednesday to Friday is 18° C. Find the temperature on each
of the five days.
14. Priya earned ₹15,000 in the first month. Thereafter her salary increased by ₹1500 per
year. Her expenses are ₹13,000 during the first year and the expenses increases by
₹900 per year. How long will it take for her to save ₹20,000 per month.
2.8 Series
The sum of the terms of a sequence is called series. Let a1, a2, a 3,..., an ,... be the sequence
of real numbers. Then the real number a1 + a2 + a3 + is defined as the series of real
numbers.
If a series has finite number of terms then it is called a Finite series. If a series has
infinite number of terms then it is called an Infinite series. Let us focus our attention only
on studying finite series.
Note
¾¾ If the first term a, and the last term l ( n th term) are given then
n n
Sn = 2a + (n − 1)d = a + a + (n − 1)d since, l = a + (n − 1)d we have
2 2
n
Sn = [a + l ] .
2
Progress Check
1 3 1
Example 2.31 Find the sum of first 15 terms of the A. P. 8, 7 , 6 , 5 ,...
2 4 4
1 3
Solution Here the first term a = 8, common difference d = 7 − 8 = − ,
4 4
n
Sum of first n terms of an A.P. Sn = 2a + (n − 1)d
2
15 3
S15 = 2 × 8 + (15 − 1)(− )
2 4
15 21 165
S15 = 16 − =
2 2 4
Example 2.33 How many terms of the series 1 + 5 + 9 + ... must be taken so that their
sum is 190?
Solution Here we have to find the value of n, such that Sn = 190.
First term a = 1, common difference d = 5 − 1 = 4 .
Sum of first n terms of an A.P.
n Thinking Corner
Sn = [2a + (n − 1)d ] = 190
2 The value of n must be
n
[2 × 1 + (n − 1) × 4 ] = 190 positive. Why?
2
n[4n - 2] = 380
2n 2 - n - 190 = 0
(n − 10)(2n + 19) = 0
19
But n = 10 as n = − is impossible. Therefore, n = 10 .
2
Progress Check
1. The nth term of any A.P. is of the form pn+q where p and q are some constants.
2. The sum to nth term of any A.P. is of the form pn2+qn + r where p, q, r are some
constants.
Example 2.34 The 13th term of an A.P. is 3 and the sum of first 13 terms is 234. Find the
common difference and the sum of first 21 terms.
13
Sum of first 13 terms = 234 gives S13 = [2a + 12d ] = 234
2
2a + 12d = 36 ...(2)
−5
Solving (1) and (2) we get, a = 33, d =
2
-5
Therefore, common difference is .
2
21 5 21
− = [66 − 50] = 168.
Sum of first 21 terms S 21 = 2 × 33 + (21 − 1) × 2
2 2
5n 2 3n
Example 2.35 In an A.P. the sum of first n terms is + . Find the 17th term.
2 2
Solution The 17th term can be obtained by subtracting the sum of first 16 terms from the
sum of first 17 terms
5 × (17)2 3 × 17 1445 51
S17 = + = + = 748
2 2 2 2
5 × (16)2 3 × 16 1280 48
S16 = + = + = 664
2 2 2 2
Now, t17 = S17 − S16 = 748 − 664 = 84
Example 2.36 Find the sum of all natural numbers between 300 and 600 which are
divisible by 7.
Solution The natural numbers between 300 and 600 which are divisible by 7 are 301, 308,
315, …, 595.
The sum of all natural numbers between 300 and 600 is 301 + 308 + 315 + + 595 .
The terms of the above series are in A.P.
First term a = 301 ; common difference d = 7 ; Last term l = 595.
l − a 595 − 301
n = + 1 =
+ 1 = 43
d 7
n 43
Since, Sn = [a + l ] , we have S 57 = [301 + 595]= 19264.
2 2
Example 2.37 A mosaic is designed in the shape of an
equilateral triangle, 12 ft on each side. Each tile in the
mosaic is in the shape of an equilateral triangle of 12 inch
side. The tiles are alternate in colour as shown in the figure.
12
From the figure, it is clear that number of white tiles in each row are 1, 2, 3, 4, …, 12
which clearly forms an Arithmetic Progression.
Similarly the number of blue tiles in each row are 0, 1, 2, 3, …, 11 which is also an
Arithmetic Progression.
12
Number of white tiles = 1 + 2 + 3 + + 12 = [1 + 12] = 78
2
12
Number of blue tiles = 0 + 1 + 2 + 3 + + 11 = [0 + 11] = 66
2
The total number of tiles in the mosaic = 78 + 66 = 144
Example 2.38 The houses of a street are numbered from 1 to 49. Senthil’s house is
numbered such that the sum of numbers of the houses prior to Senthil’s house is equal to
the sum of numbers of the houses following Senthil’s house. Find Senthil’s house number?
Solution Let Senthil’s house number be x.
It is given that 1 + 2 + 3 + + (x − 1) = (x + 1) + (x + 2) + + 49
1 + 2 + 3 + + (x − 1) = 1 + 2 + 3 + + 49 − 1 + 2 + 3 + + x
x −1 49 x
1 + (x − 1) =
1 + 49 − 1 + x
2 2 2
x (x - 1) 49 × 50 x (x + 1)
= −
2 2 2
x - x = 2450 − x − x ⇒ 2x 2 = 2450
2 2
x 2 = 1225 gives x = 35
Therefore, Senthil’s house number is 35.
Example 2.39 The sum of first n, 2n and 3n terms of an A.P. are S1, S 2 and S3 respectively.
Prove that S 3 = 3(S 2 − S1 ) .
Solution If S1, S 2 and S3 are sum of first n, 2n and 3n terms of an A.P. respectively then
n , S = 2n 2a + (2n − 1)d , S = 3n 2a + (3n − 1)d
S1 = 2a + (n − 1)d
2 2
2 3
2
2n n
Consider, S 2 - S1 =
2a + (2n − 1)d − 2a + (n − 1)d
2 2
n
= [4a + 2(2n − 1)d ] − [2a + (n − 1)d ]
2
n Thinking Corner
S 2 - S1 = × 2a + (3n − 1)d
2
1. What is the sum of first
3n
3(S 2 - S1 ) = 2a + (3n − 1)d n odd natural numbers?
2
2. What is the sum of first
3(S 2 - S1 ) = S 3 n even natural numbers?
Numbers and Sequences 67
Exercise 2.6
2. How many consecutive odd integers beginning with 5 will sum to 480?
3. Find the sum of first 28 terms of an A.P. whose nth term is 4n - 3 .
4. The sum of first n terms of a certain series is given as 2n 2 - 3n . Show that the series
is an A.P.
5. The 104th term and 4th term of an A.P. are 125 and 0. Find the sum of first 35 terms.
6. Find the sum of all odd positive integers less than 450.
7. Find the sum of all natural numbers between 602 and 902 which are not divisible by 4.
8. Raghu wish to buy a laptop. He can buy it by paying ₹40,000 cash or by giving it in
10 installments as ₹4800 in the first month, ₹4750 in the second month, ₹4700 in the
third month and so on. If he pays the money in this fashion, find
(i) total amount paid in 10 installments.
(ii) how much extra amount that he has to pay than the cost?
9. A man repays a loan of ₹65,000 by paying ₹400 in the first month and then increasing
the payment by ₹300 every month. How long will it take for him to clear the loan?
10. A brick staircase has a total of 30 steps. The bottom step requires 100 bricks. Each
successive step requires two bricks less than the previous step.
(i) How many bricks are required for the top most step?
(ii) How many bricks are required to build the stair case?
11. If S1, S 2 , S 3 ,..., Sm are the sums of n terms of m A.P.’s whose first terms are 1, 2, 3,...,m
and whose common differences are 1, 3, 5,...,(2m - 1) respectively, then show that
1
S1 + S 2 + S 3 + + S m = mn(mn + 1) .
2
a − b 3a − 2b 5a − 3b
12. Find the sum + + + to 12 terms .
a + b a + b a+b
2.9 Geometric Progression
In the diagram given in Fig.2.13, D DEF is formed by joining the mid points of the
sides AB, BC and CA of D ABC. Then the size of the triangle D DEF is exactly one-fourth
of the size of D ABC. Similarly D GHI is also one-fourth of D FDE and so on. In general,
the successive areas are one-fourth of the previous areas.
Definition
A Geometric Progression is a sequence in which each term is obtained by multiplying a
fixed non-zero number to the preceding term except the first term. The fixed number is
called common ratio. The common ratio is usually denoted by r.
We try to find a formula for n th term or general term of Geometric Progression (G.P.)
whose terms are in the common ratio.
a, ar , ar 2 ,..., ar n -1,... where a is the first term and ‘r’ is the common ratio. Let tn be the
nth term of the G.P.
Progress Check
Since the ratios between successive terms are not equal, the sequence 7, 14, 21,
28, … is not a Geometric Progression.
1
(ii) , 1, 2, 4, ...
2
t2 1 t3 2 t4 4
= = 2; = = 2 ; = =2
t1 1
2
t2 1 t3 2
Here the ratios between successive terms are equal. Therefore the sequence
1
, 1, 2, 4, ... is a Geometric Progression with common ratio r = 2.
2
(iii)
5, 25, 50, 75,... Thinking Corner
t2 25 t3 50 t 75 3 Is the sequence
= = 5; = = 2; 4 = = 2 22
t1 5 t2 25 t3 50 2 2, 22 , 22 , 22 ,... is a G.P. ?
Since the ratios between successive terms are not equal, the sequence
5, 25, 50, 75,... is not a Geometric Progression.
Example 2.41 Find the geometric progression whose first term and common ratios are
given by (i) a = −7 , r = 6 (ii) a = 256 , r = 0.5
Solution (i) The general form of Geometric progression is a, ar, ar 2 ,...
a = −7 , ar = −7 × 6 = −42 , ar 2 = −7 × 62 = −252
Therefore the required Geometric Progression is −7, − 42, − 252,...
(ii) The general form of Geometric progression is a, ar, ar 2 ,...
a = 256 , ar = 256 × 0.5 = 128 , ar 2 = 256 × (0.5)2 = 64
Therefore the required Geometric progression is 256,128, 64,....
Progress Check
1. If first term = a, common ratio = r, then find the value of t9 and t27.
1 1
2. In a G.P. if t1 = and t2 = then the common ratio is ______.
5 25
64
ar 6
Dividing (2) by (1) we get, 3 = 243
ar 8
9
8 2
r3 = gives r =
27 3
3
2 8
Substituting the value of r in (1), we get a × = ⇒ a = 3
3 9
4
Therefore the Geometric Progression is a, ar, ar 2 , … That is, 3, 2, , ...
3
Note
¾¾ When the product of three consecutive terms of a G.P. are given, we can take the three
a
terms as , a, ar.
r
¾¾ When the products of four consecutive terms are given for a G.P. then we can take the
a a
four terms as 3 , , ar, ar 3 .
r r
¾ ¾ When each term of a Geometric Progression is multiplied or divided by a non–
zero constant then the resulting sequence is also a Geometric Progression.
Example 2.44 The product of three consecutive terms of a Geometric Progression is 343
91
and their sum is . Find the three terms.
3
Solution Since the product of 3 consecutive terms is given.
Example 2.45 The present value of a machine is ₹40,000 and its value depreciates each
year by 10%. Find the estimated value of the machine in the 6th year.
Solution The value of the machine at present is ₹40,000. Since it is depreciated at the rate
of 10% after one year the value of the machine is 90% of the initial value.
90
That is the value of the machine at the end of the first year is 40, 000 ´
100
After two years, the value of the machine is 90% of the value in the first year.
2
90
Value of the machine at the end of the 2nd year is 40,000×
100
Continuing this way, the value of the machine depreciates in the following way as
2
90 90
40000, 40000 × , 40000 × ...
100 100
90
This sequence is in the form of G.P. with first term 40,000 and common ratio .
100
For finding the value of the machine at the end of 5th year (i.e. in 6th year), we need to find
the sixth term of this G.P.
90
Thus, n=6, a=40,000, r = .
100 6−1 5
90 90
Using tn = ar n −1
, we have t6 = 40, 000 × = 40000 ×
100 100
9 9 9 9 9
t6 = 40, 000 × × × × × = 23619.6
10 10 10 10 10
Therefore the value of the machine in 6th year = ₹23619.60
Exercise 2.7
6. In a G.P. the 9th term is 32805 and 6th term is 1215. Find the 12th term.
7. Find the 10th term of a G.P. whose 8th term is 768 and the common ratio is 2.
8. If a, b, c are in A.P. then show that 3a , 3b , 3c are in G.P.
9. In a G.P. the product of three consecutive terms is 27 and the sum of the product of
57
two terms taken at a time is . Find the three terms.
2
10. A man joined a company as Assistant Manager. The company gave him a starting
salary of ₹60,000 and agreed to increase his salary 5% annually. What will be his
salary after 5 years?
11. Sivamani is attending an interview for a job and the company gave two offers to him.
Offer A: ₹20,000 to start with followed by a guaranteed annual increase of 6% for the
first 5 years.
Offer B: ₹22,000 to start with followed by a guaranteed annual increase of 3% for the
first 5 years.
What is his salary in the 4th year with respect to the offers A and B?
12. If a, b, c are three consecutive terms of an A.P. and x, y, z are three consecutive terms
of a G.P. then prove that x b−c × y c−a × z a −b = 1 .
Progress Check
Note
1. A series whose terms are in Geometric progression
¾¾ The above formula for sum of is called _______.
first n terms of a G.P. is not
applicable when r = 1 . 2. When r = 1 , the formula for finding sum to n
terms of a G.P. is ______.
If r = 1 , then
Sn = a + a + a + + a = na 3. When r ¹ 1 , the formula for finding sum to n
terms of a G.P. is ______.
74 10th Standard Mathematics
Hence, S 8 =
1 (−3)8 − 1 (
=
6561 − 1 )
= −1640
(−3) − 1 −4
Example 2.47 Find the first term of a G.P. in which S 6 = 4095 and r = 4 .
Solution Common ratio = 4 > 1 , Sum of first 6 terms S 6 = 4095
a(r n − 1)
Hence, S6 =
= 4095
r −1
a(46 − 1) 4095
Since, r = 4 , = 4095 gives a × = 4095
4 −1 3
First term a = 3 .
Example 2.48 How many terms of the series 1 + 4 + 16 + make the sum 1365?
Solution Let n be the number of terms to be added to get the sum 1365
4
a = 1, r = = 4>1
1
a(r n - 1)
Sn = 1365 gives = 1365
r -1
1(4n - 1)
= 1365 so, (4n − 1) = 4095
4 -1
4n = 4096 then 4n = 46 Progress Check
n =6
1 1. Sum to infinite number of terms
Example 2.49 Find the sum 3 + 1 + + ...∞ of a G.P. is ___.
3
t2 1
Solution Here a = 3 , r= = 2. For what values of r, does the
t1 3
a 3 9 formula for infinite G.P. valid?
Sum of infinite terms = = =
1−r 1 2
1−
3
Example 2.50 Find the rational form of the number 0.6666¼
Solution We can express the number 0.6666¼ as follows
0.6666… = 0.6 + 0.06 + 0.006 + 0.0006 +
We now see that numbers 0.6, 0.06, 0.006 ... forms an G.P. whose first term a = 0.6
0.06
and common ration r = = 0.1 . Also −1 < r = 0.1 < 1
0.6
Using the infinite G.P. formula, we have
0.6 0.6 2
0.6666... = 0.6 + 0.06 + 0.006 + 0.0006 + = = =
1 − 0.1 0.9 3
2
Thus the rational number equivalent of 0.6666¼ is
3
Numbers and Sequences 75
Activity 5
The sides of a given square is 10 cm. The mid points of its sides 10 cm
are joined to form a new square. Again, the mid points of the
sides of this new square are joined to form another square.
10 cm
10 cm
This process is continued indefinitely. Find the sum of the
areas and the sum of the perimeters of the squares formed
through this process.
10 cm
Fig.2.15
1
We have r = <1
2 6
1
a 1 −
(
a 1−r )
n
=
2
= 7875
1−r 1
1−
1 2
a 1 −
64 63
= 7875 gives a × = 7875
1 32
2
7875 × 32
a = so, a = 4000
63
The amount saved in the first year is ₹ 4000.
Exercise 2.8
9 27
1. Find the sum of first n terms of the G.P. (i) 5, -3, , - ,... (ii) 256,64,16,…
5 25
2. Find the sum of first six terms of the G.P. 5, 15, 45, …
3. Find the first term of the G.P. whose common ratio 5 and whose sum to first 6 terms
is 46872.
28
4. Find the sum to infinity of (i) 9 + 3 + 1 + (ii) 21 + 14 + +
3
32
5. If the first term of an infinite G.P. is 8 and its sum to infinity is then find the
3
common ratio.
6. Find the sum to n terms of the series
(i) 0.4 + 0.44 + 0.444 + to n terms (ii) 3 + 33 + 333 + to n terms
7. Find the sum of the Geometric series 3 + 6 + 12 + + 1536 .
8. Kumar writes a letter to four of his friends. He asks each one of them to copy the
letter and mail to four different persons with the instruction that they continue the
process similarly. Assuming that the process is unaltered and it costs ₹2 to mail one
letter, find the amount spent on postage when 8th set of letters is mailed.
When x = n , (n + 1)3 − n 3 = 3n 2 + 3n + 1
78 10th Standard Mathematics
Adding all these equations and cancelling the terms on the Left Hand side, we get,
(n + 1)3 − 13 = 3(12 + 22 + 32 + + n 2 ) + 3(1 + 2 + 3 + + n ) + n
3n(n + 1)
n 3 + 3n 2 + 3n = 3(12 + 22 + 32 + + n 2 ) + +n
2
3n(n + 1) 2n 3 + 6n 2 +4n − 3n 2 − 3n
3(12 + 22 + 32 + + n 2 ) = n 3 + 3n 2 +2n − =
2 2
3 2 2
2n + 3n +n n(2n + 3n + 1) n(n + 1)(2n + 1)
3(12 + 22 + 32 + ... + n 2 ) = = =
2 2 2
n(n + 1)(2n + 1)
12 + 22 + 32 + + n 2 =
6
2.11.4 Sum of cubes of first n natural numbers
To find 13 + 23 + 33 + + n 3 , let us consider the identity
(x + 1)4 − x 4 = 4x 3 + 6x 2 + 4x + 1
When x = 1 , 24 − 14 = 4(1)2 + 4(1) + 1
When x =2 , 34 − 24 = 4(2)3 + 4(2) + 1
When x = 3 , 44 − 34 = 4(3)3 + 6(3) + 1
When x = n − 1 , n − (n − 1) = 4(n − 1)3 + 4(n − 1) + 1
4 4
When x = n , (n + 1)4 − n 4 = 4n 3 + 6n 2 + 4n + 1
Adding all these equations and cancelling the terms on the Left Hand side, we get,
(n+1)4–14 = 4(13 + 23 + 33 + + n 3 ) + 6(12 + 22 + 32 + + n 2 ) + 4(1 + 2 + 3 + + n ) + n
n(n + 1)(2n + 1) n(n + 1)
n 4 + 4n 3 + 6n 2 + 4n = 4(13 + 23 + 33 + + n 3 ) + 6 × + 4× +n
6 2
4(13 + 23 + 33 + + n 3 ) = n 4 + 4n 3 + 6n 2 +4n − 2n 3 − n 2 − 2n 2 − n − 2n 2 − 2n − n
4(13 + 23 + 33 + + n 3 ) = n 4 + 2n 3 + n 2 = n 2 (n 2 + 2n + 1) = n 2 (n + 1)2
2
n(n + 1)
1 + 2 + 3 + + n =
3 3 3 3
2
Ideal Friendship
Consider the numbers 220 and 284.
Sum of the divisors of 220 (excluding 220) = 1+2+4+5+10+11+20+22+44+55+110=284
Sum of the divisors of 284 (excluding 284) =1+2+4+71+142=220.
Thus, sum of divisors of one number excluding itself is the other. Such pair of numbers
is called Amicable Numbers or Friendly Numbers.
220 and 284 are least pair of Amicable Numbers. They were discovered by Pythagoras.
We now know more than 12 million amicable pair of Numbers.
Activity 6
Take a triangle like this Make another triangle like this.
Fig.2.16 (1 + 2 + 3 + 4) Fig.2.17 (4 + 3 + 2 + 1)
Join the second triangle Thus, two copies of 1 + 2 + 3 + 4 provide a rectangle
with the first to get of size 4 ´ 5 .
We can write in numbers, what we did with pictures.
Let us write, (4 + 3 + 2 + 1) + (1 + 2 + 3 + 4) = 4 × 5
2(1 + 2 + 3 + 4) = 4 × 5
4×5
Therefore, 1 + 2 + 3 + 4 = = 10
2
In a similar, fashion, try to find the sum of first 5
natural numbers. Can you relate these answers to any of
Fig.2.18
the known formula?
1. The sum of first n natural numbers are also called Triangular Numbers
because they form triangle shapes.
2. The sum of squares of first n natural numbers are also called Square
Pyramidal Numbers because they form pyramid shapes with square base.
Thinking Corner
1. How many squares are there in a standard chess board?
2. How many rectangles are there in a standard chess board?
Here is a summary of list of some useful summation formulas which we discussed.
These formulas are used in solving summation problems with finite terms.
n
n(n + 1)
∑k = 1 + 2 + 3 ++ n =
2
k =1
n
∑ (2k − 1) = 1 + 2 + 3 + + (2n − 1) = n 2
k =1
n
n(n + 1)(2n + 1)
∑k 2
= 12 + 22 + 32 + + n 2 =
6
k =1
2
n n(n + 1)
∑k 3
= 13 + 23 + 33 + + n 3 =
2
k =1
80 10th Standard Mathematics
75(75 + 1) 15(15 + 1)
= −
2 2
= 2850 − 120 = 2730
Progress Check
1. The sum of cubes of first n natural numbers is __________ of the first n natural
numbers.
2. The average of first 100 natural numbers is __________.
Here the number of terms is not given. Now we have to find the number of terms
(l − a ) (55 − 1)
using the formula, n = + 1 gives n = + 1 = 28
d 2
Therefore, 1 + 3 + 5 + + 55 = (28)2 = 784
Example 2.56 Find the sum of (i) 12 + 22 + + 192
(ii) 52 + 102 + 152 + + 1052 (iii) 152 + 162 + 172 + + 282
19 × (19 + 1)(2 × 19 + 1) 19 × 20 × 39
Solution (i) 12 + 22 + + 192 = = = 2470
6 6
(ii)
52 + 102 + 152 + + 1052 = 52 (12 + 22 + 32 + + 212 )
25 × (21 + 1)(2 × 21 + 1)
= 25 ×
6
25 × 21 × 22 × 43
= = 82775
6
(iii)
152 + 162 + 172 + + 282 = (12 + 22 + 32 + + 282 ) − (12 + 22 + 32 + + 142 )
28 × 29 × 57 14 × 15 × 29
= − = 7714 − 1015 = 6699
6 6
Numbers and Sequences 81
Example 2.57 Find the sum of (i) 13 + 23 + 33 + + 163 (ii) 93 + 103 + + 213
2
16 × (16 + 1)
Solution (i) 13 + 23 + 33 + + 163 = = (136)2 = 18496
2
(ii) 9 + 10 + + 21 = (1 + 2 + 3 + + 213 ) − (13 + 23 + 33 + + 83 )
3 3 3 3 3 3
2 2
21 × (21 + 1)
= = 8 × (8 + 1) = (231)2 − (36)2 = 52065
2 2
Example 2.58 If 1 + 2 + 3 + + n = 666 then find n.
n(n + 1) n(n + 1)
Solution Since, 1 + 2 + 3 + ... + n =, we have = 666
2 2
n 2 + n − 1332 = 0 gives (n + 37)(n − 36) = 0
So, n = −37 or n = 36
But n ≠ −37 (Since n is a natural number); Hence n = 36 .
Progress Check
Exercise 2.9
Exercise 2.10
1. Euclid’s division lemma states that for positive integers a and b, there exist unique
integers q and r such that a = bq + r , where r must satisfy.
(1) 1 < r < b (2) 0 < r < b (3) 0 ≤ r < b (4) 0 < r ≤ b
2. Using Euclid’s division lemma, if the cube of any positive integer is divided by 9 then
the possible remainders are
(1) 0, 1, 8 (2) 1, 4, 8 (3) 0, 1, 3 (4) 1, 3, 5
3. If the HCF of 65 and 117 is expressible in the form of 65m - 117 , then the value of m is
(1) 4 (2) 2 (3) 1 (4) 3
4. The sum of the exponents of the prime factors in the prime factorization of 1729 is
(1) 1 (2) 2 (3) 3 (4) 4
5. The least number that is divisible by all the numbers from 1 to 10 (both inclusive) is
(1) 2025 (2) 5220 (3) 5025 (4) 2520
6. 74k º _____ (mod 100)
(1) 1 (2) 2 (3) 3 (4) 4
7. Given F1 = 1 , F2 = 3 and Fn = Fn −1 + Fn −2 then F5 is
(1)3 (2)5 (3)8 (4)11
8. The first term of an arithmetic progression is unity and the common difference is 4.
Which of the following will be a term of this A.P.
(1) 4551 (2) 10091 (3) 7881 (4) 13531
9. If 6 times of 6th term of an A.P. is equal to 7 times the 7th term, then the 13th term of the A.P. is
(1) 0 (2) 6 (3) 7 (4) 13
10. An A.P. consists of 31 terms. If its 16th term is m, then the sum of all the terms of
this A.P. is
31
(1) 16 m (2) 62 m (3) 31 m (4) m
2
11. In an A.P., the first term is 1 and the common difference is 4. How many terms of
the A.P. must be taken for their sum to be equal to 120?
(1) 6 (2) 7 (3) 8 (4) 9
12. If A = 265 and B = 264 + 263 + 262 + + 20 which of the following is true?
(1) B is 264 more than A (2) A and B are equal
(3) B is larger than A by 1 (4) A is larger than B by 1
Numbers and Sequences 83
3 1 1 1
13. The next term of the sequence , , , , is
16 8 12 18
1 1 2 1
(1) (2) (3) (4)
24 27 3 81
14. If the sequence t1, t2 , t3 ,... are in A.P. then the sequence t6 , t12 , t18 ,... is
(1) a Geometric Progression (2) an Arithmetic Progression
(3) neither an Arithmetic Progression nor a Geometric Progression
(4) a constant sequence
15. The value of (13 + 23 + 33 + + 153 ) − (1 + 2 + 3 + + 15) is
(1) 14400 (2) 14200 (3) 14280 (4) 14520
Unit Exercise - 2
Points to Remember
zz Euclid’s division lemma
If a and b are two positive integers then there exist unique integers q and r such
that a = bq + r, 0 ≤ r < b
zz Fundamental theorem of arithmetic
Every composite number can be expressed as a product of primes and this
factorization is unique except for the order in which the prime factors occur.
84 10th Standard Mathematics
zz Arithmetic Progression
(i) Arithmetic Progression is a, a + d, a + 2d, a + 3d,…. n th term is given by
tn = a + (n − 1)d
n
(ii) Sum to first n terms of an A.P. is Sn = [2a + (n − 1)d ]
2
n
(iii) If the last term l ( n term is given, then Sn = [a + 1] )
th
2
zz Geometric Progression
(i) Geometric Progression is a , ar, ar 2 ,…., ar n −1 . n th term is given by tn = ar n −1
a(r n − 1)
(ii) Sum to first n terms of an G.P. is Sn = if r ¹ 1
r −1
(iii) Suppose r =1 then Sn = na
a
(iv) Sum to infinite terms of a G.P. a + ar + ar 2 + is S = , where –1< r < 1
1−r
zz Special Series
n(n + 1)
(i) The sum of first n natural numbers 1 + 2 + 3 + + n =
2
(ii) The sum of squares of first n natural numbers
n(n + 1)(2n + 1)
12 + 22 + 32 + + n 2 =
6 2
n(n + 1)
(iii) The sum of cubes of first n natural numbers 1 + 2 + 3 + + n =
3 3 3 3
2
(iv) The sum of first n odd natural numbers 1 + 3 + 5 + + (2n − 1) = n 2
ICT CORNER
ICT 2.1
Step 1: Open the Browser type the URL Link given below (or) Scan the QR Code. GeoGebra work book named “Numbers
and Sequences” will open. In the left side of the work book there are many activity related to mensuration chapter. Select the
work sheet “Euclid’s Lemma division”
Step 2: In the given worksheet Drag the point mentioned as “Drag Me” to get new set of points. Now compare the Division
algorithm you learned from textbook.
Step 1 Step 2 Expected results
ICT 2.2
Step 1: Open the Browser type the URL Link given below (or) Scan the QR Code. GeoGebra work book named
“Numbers and Sequences” will open. In the left side of the work book there are many activity related to mensuration
chapter. Select the work sheet “Bouncing Ball Problem”.
Step 2: In the given worksheet you can change the height, Number of bounces and debounce ratio by typing new value. Then
click “Get Ball”, and then click “Drop”. The ball bounces as per your value entered. Observe the working given on right
hand side to learn the sum of sequence.
Step 1 Step 2 Expected results
https://www.geogebra.org/m/jfr2zzgy#chapter/356192
or Scan the QR Code.
3
ALGEBRA
“A person who can, within a year, solve x 2 − 92y 2 = 1 is
amathematician” - Brahmagupta
Learning Outcomes
z To solve system of linear equations in three
variables by the method of elimination
z To find GCD and LCM of polynomials
z To simplify algebraic rational expressions
z To understand and compute the square root of polynomials
z To learn about quadratic equations
z To draw quadratic graphs
z To learn about matrix, its types and operations on matrices
3.1 Introduction
Algebra can be thought of as the next level of study of numbers. If we need to determine
anything subject to certain specific conditions, then we need Algebra. In that sense, the
study of Algebra is considered as “Science of determining unknowns”. During third
century AD(CE) Diophantus of Alexandria wrote a monumental book titled “Arithmetica”
in thirteen volumes of which only six has survived. This book is the first source where
the conditions of the problems are stated as equations and they are eventually solved.
Diophantus realized that for many real life situation problems, the variables considered
are usually positive integers.
86 10th Standard Mathematics
The term “Algebra” has evolved as a misspelling of the word ‘al-jabr’ from one of
the important work titled Al-Kitāb al-mukhtaşar fī hisāb al-jabr wa’l-muqābala (“The
Compendious Book on Calculation by Completion and Balancing”) written by Persian
Mathematician Al-Khwarizmi of 9th Century AD(CE) Since Al-Khwarizmi’s Al-Jabr book
provided the most appropriate methods of solving equations, he is hailed as “Father of
Algebra”.
In the earlier classes, we had studied several important concepts in Algebra. In this
class, we will continue our journey to understand other important concepts which will be
of much help in solving problems of greater scope. Real understanding of these ideas will
benefit much in learning higher mathematics in future classes.
Simultaneous Linear Equations in Two Variables
Let us recall solving a pair of linear equations in two variables.
Definition
Linear Equation in two variables
Any first degree equation containing two variables x and y is called a linear
equation in two variables. The general form of linear equation in two variables x and
y is ax+by+c = 0 , where atleast one of a, b is non-zero and a, b, c are real numbers.
Note that linear equations are first degree equations in the given variables.
Note
¾ xy – 7 = 3 is not a linear equation in two variables since the term xy is of degree 2.
¾ A linear equation in two variables represent a straight line in xy plane.
Example 3.1 The father’s age is six times his son’s age. Six years hence the age of father
will be four times his son’s age. Find the present ages (in years) of the son and father.
Solution Let the present age of father be x years and
the present age of son be y years
Given, x = 6y … (1)
x + 6 = 4(y + 6) … (2)
Substituting (1) in (2), 6y + 6 = 4 (y + 6)
6y + 6 = 4y + 24 gives, y = 9
Therefore, son’s age = 9 years and father’s age = 54 years.
Algebra 87
(1) × 1 gives, 2x - 3y = 6 3
Y
2 2x–3y =6
(2) × 2 gives, 2x +2y = 2 x+y =1
1
--------------------------------------------------------------------
−4 X′ -3 -2 -1 0 1 2 3 4 5 6 7X
-5y =4 gives, y = -1
5 -2 9
, − 4
5
5
−4 4 9 -4
Substituting y = in (2), x − = 1 we get, x = Y¢
5 5 5
9 −4 Fig. 3.1
Therefore, x = , y = .
5 5
3.2 Simultaneous Linear Equations in Three Variables
Right from the primitive needs of calculating amount
spent for various items in a super market, finding ages of
people under specific conditions, finding path of an object
when it is thrown upwards at an angle, Algebra plays a vital
role in our daily life.
Any point in the space can be determined uniquely
by knowing its latitude, longitude and altitude. Hence
to locate the position of an object at a particular place
situated on the Earth, three satellites are positioned to
arrive three equations. Among these three equations,
we get two linear equations and one quadratic (second
degree) equation. Hence we can solve for the variables
latitude, longitude and altitude to uniquely fix the position
of any object at a given point of time. This is the basis of Fig. 3.2
Geo-Positioning System (GPS). Hence the concept of linear equations in three variables
is used in GPS systems.
3.2.1 System of Linear Equations in Three Variables
In earlier classes, we have learnt different methods of solving Simultaneous Linear
Equations in two variables. Here we shall learn to solve the system of linear equations in
three variables namely, x, y and z. The general form of a linear equation in three variables
x, y and z is ax + by + cz + d = 0 where a, b, c, d are real numbers, and atleast one of
a, b, c is non-zero.
Note
¾ A linear equation in two variables of the ¾ A linear equation in three variables of the
form ax + by + c = 0 , represents a form ax + by + cz + d = 0 , represents a
straight line. Y plane. Z
ax+by+cz+d =0
ax
+b
y+
c
=0
O X
O
X′ X
Y ¢ Fig. 3.3(i)
Y Fig. 3.3(ii)
Y¢
88 10th Standard Mathematics
General Form: A system of linear equations in three variables x, y, z has the general form
a1x + b1y + c1z + d1 = 0
a2x + b2y + c2z + d2 = 0
a 3x + b3y + c3z + d3 = 0
Each equation in the system represents a plane in three dimensional space and
solution of the system of equations is precisely the point of intersection of the three
planes defined by the three linear equations of the system. The system may have only one
solution, infinitely many solutions or no solution depending on how the planes intersect
one another.
The figures presented below illustrate each of these possibilities
Example 3.3 Solve the following system of linear equations in three variables
3x – 2y + z =2 , 2x + 3y – z = 5 , x + y + z = 6 .
Solution 3x − 2y + z = 2 …(1) 2x + 3y – z = 5 …(2) x +y +z = 6 …(3)
Algebra 89
5x + y = 7 …(4)
17x = 17 gives, x = 1
Substituting x = 1 in (4), 5 + y = 7 gives, y = 2
Substituting x = 1 , y = 2 in (3), 1 + 2 + z = 6 we get, z = 3
Therefore, x = 1, y = 2 , z = 3
Example 3.4 In an interschool atheletic meet, with 24 individual events, securing a total
of 56 points, a first place secures 5 points, a second place secures 3 points, and a third place
secures 1 point. Having as many third place finishers as first and second place finishers,
find how many athletes finished in each place.
Solution Let the number of I, II and III place finishers be x , y and z respectively.
Total number of events = 24; Total number of points = 56.
Hence, the linear equations in three variables are
x + y + z = 24 …(1) 5x + 3y + z = 56 …(2) x + y = z …(3)
Substituting (3) in (1) we get, z + z = 24 gives, z = 12
Therefore, (3) equation will be, x + y = 12
(2) is 5x + 3y = 44
(−)
3×(3) is 3x + 3y = 36
2x = 8 we get, x = 4
Substituting x = 4 , z = 12 in (3) we get, y = 12 − 4 = 8
Therefore, Number of first place finishers is 4
Number of second place finishers is 8
Number of third place finishers is 12.
Example 3.5 Solve x + 2y – z = 5 ; x − y + z = −2 ; −5x − 4y + z = −11
Solution Let, x + 2y – z =5 …(1) x – y + z =–2 …(2) –5x –4y + z = –11 …(3)
Adding (1) and (2) we get, x + 2y – z = 5
(+)
x – y + z = –2
2x + y = 3 …(4)
6x + 3y =9
Dividing by 3 2x + y = 3 …(5)
Subtracting (4) and (5), 2x + y =3
2x + y =3
0 = 0
x – z = 2 … (4)
2x - 2z = 3 … (5)
2x - 2z = 3
(−)
Now, (5) −2×(4) we get, 2x - 2z = 4
0 = –1
21x + 4y = 282
(+)
(1) × 4 gives, 12x - 4y = 48
p q r 1
+ − =
2 4 3 4
q
p =
3
q 2 32
p − + 4r = 2 =
5 15 15
By simplifying we get,
6p + 3q − 4r = 3 …(1)
3p = q …(2)
Example 3.9 The sum of thrice the first number, second number and twice the third
number is 5. If thrice the second number is subtracted from the sum of first number and
thrice the third we get 2. If the third number is subtracted from the sum of twice the first,
thrice the second, we get 1. Find the numbers.
Solution Let the three numbers be x, y, z
From the given data we get the following equations,
3x + y + 2z = 5 …(1) x + 3z – 3y = 2 …(2) 2x + 3y – z = 1 …(3)
(1) × 1 gives, 3x + y + 2z = 5
(−)
(2) × 3 gives, 3x – 9y + 9z = 6 Thinking Corner
10y – 7z = –1 …(4) 1. The number of
possible solutions
(1) × 2 gives, 6x + 2y + 4z = 10
(−) when solving system
(3) ×3 gives, 6x + 9y − 3z = 3 of linear equations
−7y + 7z = 7 …(5) in three variables are
_____.
Adding (4) and (5), 10y – 7z = –1
2. If three planes
−7y + 7z = 7
are parallel then
3y =6 gives, y = 2 the number of
possible point(s) of
Substituting y = 2 in (5), −14 + 7z = 7 gives, z = 3
intersection is/are
Substituting y = 2 and z = 3 in (1),
_____.
3x + 2 + 6 = 5 we get
⇒ x = −1
Therefore, x = –1, y = 2, z = 3.
Progress Check
Exercise 3.1
Algebra 93
Note
¾¾ If f (x ) and g(x ) are two polynomials of same degree then the polynomial carrying the
highest coefficient will be the dividend. In case, if both have the same coefficient then
compare the next least degree’s coefficient and proceed with the division.
94 10th Standard Mathematics
Progress Check
−7x 2 + 7x − 7
= −7(x 2 − x + 1)
2x 2 − 2x + 2
(−)
2x 2 − 2x + 2
0
Here, we get zero remainder
Therefore, GCD(2x 3 − 5x 2 + 5x − 3, x 3 + x 2 − x + 2) = x 2 − x + 1
Example 3.11 Find the GCD of 6x 3 − 30x 2 + 60x − 48 and 3x 3 − 12x 2 + 21x − 18 .
Solution Let, f (x) = 6x 3 − 30x 2 + 60x − 48 = 6(x 3 − 5x 2 + 10x − 8) and
g (x) = 3x 3 − 12x 2 + 21x − 18 = 3 (x 3 − 4x 2 + 7x − 6)
Algebra 95
x -2
3 2
x 2 − 3x + 2 x − 5x + 10x − 8
x 3 − 3x 2 + 2x (−)
−2x 2 + 8x − 8
−2x 2 + 6x − 4 (−)
2x - 4
= 2(x − 2)
x -1
x - 2 x − 3x + 2
2
(−)
x 2 - 2x
−x + 2
−x + 2 (−)
0 Here, we get zero as remainder.
GCD of leading coefficients 3 and 6 is 3.
Thus, GCD (6x 3 − 30x 2 + 60x − 48, 3x 3 − 12x 2 + 21x − 18) = 3(x − 2) .
3.3.2 Least Common Multiple (LCM) of Polynomials
The Least Common Multiple of two or more algebraic expressions is the expression
of lowest degree (or power) such that the expressions exactly divide it.
Consider the following simple expressions a 3b 2 , a 2b 3 .
For these expressions LCM = a 3b 3 .
To find LCM by factorization method
(i) Each expression is first resolved into its factors.
(ii) The highest power of the factors will be the LCM.
(iii) If the expressions have numerical coefficients, find their LCM.
(iv) The product of the LCM of factors and coefficient is the required LCM.
Example 3.12 Find the LCM of the following
(i) 8x 4y 2 , 48x 2y 4 (ii) 5x - 10, 5x 2 - 20
(iii) x 4 - 1, x 2 − 2x + 1 (iv) x 3 - 27, (x - 3)2 , x 2 - 9
Thinking Corner
Complete the factor tree for the given polynomials f(x) and g(x). Hence find their
GCD and LCM.
f(x) = 2x3 – 9x2 – 32x –21 g(x) = 2x3 – 7x2 – 43x – 42
2x + 3 x+1 x+2
GCD [f (x) and g (x)] = _____ LCM [f (x) and g (x)] = _____
Exercise 3.2
1. Find the GCD of the given polynomials
(i) x 4 + 3x 3 − x − 3, x 3 + x 2 − 5x + 3 (ii) x 4 - 1 , x 3 − 11x 2 + x − 11
(iii) 3x 4 + 6x 3 − 12x 2 − 24x , 4x 4 + 14x 3 + 8x 2 − 8x
(iv) 3x 3 + 3x 2 + 3x + 3 , 6x 3 + 12x 2 + 6x + 12
Algebra 97
Exercise 3.3
1. Find the LCM and GCD for the following and verify that f (x ) × g(x ) = LCM ×GCD
(i) 21x 2y, 35xy 2 (ii) (x 3 − 1)(x + 1), (x 3 + 1) (iii) (x 2y + xy 2 ), (x 2 + xy )
4. Given the LCM and GCD of the two polynomials p(x) and q(x) find the unknown
polynomial in the following table
S.No. LCM GCD p(x) q(x)
(i) a 3 − 10a 2 + 11a + 70 a -7 a 2 − 12a + 35
(ii) (x 2 + y 2 )(x 4 + x 2y 2 + y 4 ) (x 2 - y 2 ) (x 4 − y 4 )(x 2 + y 2 − xy )
Algebra 99
To find excluded value for a given rational expression in its lowest form, say
p(x )
, consider the denominator q(x) = 0.
q(x )
5
For example, the rational expression is undefined when x = 10 . So, 10 is
x - 10
5
called an excluded value for .
x - 10
Example 3.14 Find the excluded values of the following expressions (if any).
x + 10 7p + 2 x
(i) (ii) 2
(iii) 2
8x 8 p + 13p + 5 x +1
Solution
x + 10
(i)
8x
x + 10
The expression is undefined when 8x = 0 or x = 0 . Hence the excluded
8x
value is 0.
7p + 2
(ii) 2
8 p + 13p + 5
7p + 2
The expression is undefined when 8p 2 + 13p + 5 = 0
2
8 p + 13p + 5
that is, (8 p + 5)(p + 1) = 0
−5 -5
p= , p = −1 . The excluded values are and -1 .
8 8
x
(iii) 2
x +1
Here x 2 ³ 0 for all x. Therefore, x 2 + 1 ≥ 0 + 1 = 1 . Hence, x 2 + 1 ≠ 0 for any x.
Therefore, there can be no real excluded values for the given rational
x
expression 2 .
x +1
Thinking Corner
sin x
1. Are x 2 - 1 and tan x = rational expressions?
cos x
x 3 + x 2 − 10x + 8
2. The number of excluded values of is _____.
x 4 + 8x 2 − 9
Exercise 3.4
Progress Check
x -3
length = km base = (x+y)(x+y)m
3
Fig. 3.5 Fig. 3.6
x3 27y x 4b 2 x2 -1
Example 3.15 (i) Multiply by 5 (ii) Multiply by 4 3
9y 2
x x -1 ab
x 3 27y 3 xb4 2
x − 1 x × b (x + 1)(x − 1) x 4 (x + 1)
2 4 2
Solution (i) ´ 5 = 2 (ii) × = × =
9y 2
x xy x − 1 a 4b 3 x −1 a 4 ×b 3 a 4b
14x 4 7x 14x 4 3y 4
Solution : (i) ÷ 4 = × = 6x 3y 3
y 3y y 7x
2
x − 16 x − 4 (x + 4)(x − 4) x + 4
(ii) ÷ = × = x + 4
x +4 x +4 (x + 4) x − 4
16x 2 − 2x − 3 8x 2 + 11x + 3 16x 2 − 2x − 3 3x 2 − 11x − 4
(iii) ÷ = ×
3x 2 − 2x − 1 3x 2 − 11x − 4 3x 2 − 2x − 1 8x 2 + 11x + 3
(8x + 3)(2x − 1) (3x + 1)(x − 4) (2x − 1)(x − 4) 2x 2 − 9x + 4
= × = =
(3x + 1)(x − 1) (8x + 3)(x + 1) (x − 1)(x + 1) x2 −1
Exercise 3.5
1. Simplify
4x 2y 6xz 3 p 2 − 10p + 21 p 2 + p − 12 5t 3 6t − 12
(i) ´ (ii) × (iii) ×
2z 2 20y 4 p −7 (p − 3)2
4t − 8 10t
2. Simplify
x +4 9x 2 − 16y 2 x 3 − y3 x 2 + 2xy + y 2
(i) × 2 (ii) ×
3x + 4y 2x + 3x − 20 3x 2 + 9xy + 6y 2 x 2 − y2
3. Simplify
2a 2 + 5a + 3 a 2 + 6a + 5 b 2 + 3b − 28 b 2 − 49
(i) ÷ (ii) 2 ÷
3a 2 + 7a + 6 −5a 2 − 35 a − 50 b + 4b + 4 b 2 − 5b − 14
x + 2 x2 − x − 6 12t 2 − 22t + 8 3t 2 + 2t − 8
(iii) ÷ (iv) ÷
4y 12y 2 3t 2t 2 + 4t
a 2 + 3a − 4 a 2 + 2a − 8
4. If x = 2
and y = 2
find the value of x 2y -2 .
3a − 3 2a − 2a − 4
Activity 1
(i) The length of a rectangular garden is the sum of a number
and its reciprocal. The breadth is the difference of the
square of the same number and its reciprocal. Find the
length, breadth and the ratio of the length to the breadth
of the rectangle.
(ii) Find the ratio of the perimeter to the area of the given 13x 37x
12x
triangle.
5x 35x
1. Write an expression that represents the 2. Find the base of the given parallelogram
perimeter of the figure and simplify. 4x 2 + 10x − 50
whose perimeter is
(x − 3)(x + 5)
2 cm x +1
cm
3x x
5 m
3
x-
6
cm ?
x2
1 1 1
Example 3.18 Simplify 2
+ 2 − 2
x − 5x + 6 x − 3x + 2 x − 8x + 15
1 1 1 Thinking Corner
Solution 2 + 2 − 2
x − 5x + 6 x − 3x + 2 x − 8x + 15 Say True or False
1 1 1 1. The sum of two rational
= + −
(x − 2)(x − 3) (x − 2)(x − 1) (x − 5)(x − 3) expressions is always a
rational expression.
(x − 1)(x − 5) + (x − 3)(x − 5) − (x − 1)(x − 2)
= 2. The product of two
(x − 1)(x − 2)(x − 3)(x − 5)
rational expressions
2 2 2
(x − 6x + 5) + (x − 8x + 15) − (x − 3x + 2) is always a rational
= expression.
(x − 1)(x − 2)(x − 3)(x − 5)
Algebra 103
x 2 − 11x + 18 (x − 9)(x − 2)
= =
(x − 1)(x − 2)(x − 3)(x − 5) (x − 1)(x − 2)(x − 3)(x − 5)
x −9
=
(x − 1)(x − 3)(x − 5)
Exercise 3.6
x (x + 1) x (1 − x ) x + 2 x −1 x3 y3
1. Simplify (i) + (ii) + (iii) +
x −2 x −2 x + 3 x −2 x −y y −x
(2x + 1)(x − 2) (2x 2 − 5x + 2) 4x x +1
2. Simplify (i) − (ii) 2 −
x −4 x −4 x −1 x −1
1 2x 3 + x 2 + 3
3. Subtract 2 from
x +2 (x 2 + 2)2
x 2 + 6x + 8 3
4. Which rational expression should be subtracted from 8
to get 2
x +8 x − 2x + 4
2x + 1 2x − 1 1 2B
5. If A = ,B= find - 2
2x − 1 2x + 1 A - B A - B2
x 1 (A + B )2 + (A − B )2 2(x 2 + 1)
6. If A = ,B= , prove that =
x +1 x +1 A÷B x (x + 1)2
7. Pari needs 4 hours to complete a work. His friend Yuvan needs 6 hours to complete
the same work. How long will it take to complete if they work together?
8. Iniya bought 50 kg of fruits consisting of apples and bananas. She paid twice as
much per kg for the apple as she did for the banana. If Iniya bought ₹ 1800 worth of
apples and ₹ 600 worth bananas, then how many kgs of each fruit did she buy?
Progress Check
81 f 12g 4 h 14
Solution (i) 256(x - a )8 (x - b)4 (x - c)16 (x - d )20 = 16 (x − a )4 (x − b)2 (x − c)8 (x − d )10
144a 8b 12c 16 4 a 4b 6c 8
(ii) =
81f 12g 4h 14 3 f 6g 2h 7
Example 3.20 Find the square root of the following expressions
(i) 16x 2 + 9y 2 − 24xy + 24x − 18y + 9 (ii) (6x 2 + x − 1)(3x 2 + 2x − 1)(2x 2 + 3x + 1)
(iii) 15x 2 +
(
)
3 + 10 x + 2 5x 2 + 2 5 + 1 x + 2 3x 2 +
( ) ( )
2 + 2 3 x + 2 2
Solution (i) 2 2
16x + 9y − 24xy + 24x − 18y + 9
= (4x )2 + (−3y )2 + (3)2 + 2(4x )(−3y ) + 2(−3y )(3) + 2(4x )(3)
= (4x − 3y + 3)2 = 4x − 3y + 3
= 3x ( 5x + 1 + 2) ( 5x + 1 )
= 5x + 1 × ( ) ( 3x + 2 )
( )
5x 2 + 2 5 + 1 x + 2 = 5x 2 + 2 5x + x + 2
= 5x (x + 2) + 1(x + 2) = ( )
5x + 1 (x + 2)
3x 2 + ( )
2 + 2 3 x + 2 2 = 3x 2 + 2x + 2 3x + 2 2
=x ( 3x + 2 + 2 ) ( 3x + 2 = (x + 2)) ( 3x + 2 )
Therefore,
2
15x +
(
)
3 + 10 x + 2 5x 2 + 2 5 + 1 x + 2 3x 2 +
( ) ( 2 + 2 3 )x + 2 2
= ( 5x + 1 )( 3x + 2 )( 5x + 1 (x + 2) ) ( 3x + 2 )(x + 2) = ( 5x + 1) ( 3x + 2 )(x + 2)
Exercise 3.7
4x 2 20x 30y 9y 2 2x 3y
Hence, + + 13 − + = + 5 −
y2 y x x2 y x
Example 3.23 If 9x 4 + 12x 3 + 28x 2 + ax + b is a perfect square, find the values of a and b.
Solution 3x 2 + 2x + 4
4 3 2
3x 2 9x + 12x + 28x + ax + b
(−)
9x 4
6x 2 + 2x 12x 3 + 28x 2
(−)
12x 3 + 4x 2
6x 2 + 4x + 4 24x 2 + ax + b
(−)
24x 2 + 16x + 16
0
Because the given polynomial is a perfect square a − 16 = 0 , b − 16 = 0
Therefore a = 16 , b = 16 .
Exercise 3.8
Quadratic Expression
An expression of degree n in variable x is a 0x n + a1x n −1 + a2x n −2 + ... + an −1x + an where
a 0 ¹ 0 and a1, a2 ,...an are real numbers. a 0 , a1, a2 , ... an are called coefficients of the
expression.
In particular an expression of degree 2 is called a Quadratic Expression which is
expressed as p(x ) = ax 2 + bx + c, a ¹ 0 and a, b, c are real numbers.
We have, ax 2 + bx + c = 0
b c
a x 2 + x + = 0
a a
b c
(
x 2 + x + = 0 since a ≠ 0
a a
)
2 2
b b b c
x + (2x ) + − + = 0
2
2a 2a 2a a
2
b b b2 c
That is, x + (2x ) + = 2 −
2
2a 2a 4a a
2
2
x + b = b − 4ac
2a 4a 2
b ± b 2 − 4ac
x+ =
2a 2a
−b ± b 2 − 4ac
x =
2a
−b + b 2 − 4ac -b - b 2 - 4ac
Therefore, the roots are and
2a 2a
Activity 2
(2k+6)m
Consider a rectangular garden in front of a
house, whose dimensions are (2k + 6) metre
k metre
Example 3.25 Write down the quadratic equation in general form for which sum and
product of the roots are given below.
7 5 3 1
(i) 9, 14 (ii) - , (iii) - , -
2 2 5 2
Solution (i) General form of the quadratic equation when the roots are given is
x 2 - (sum of the roots) x + product of the roots = 0
x 2 − 9x + 14 = 0
7 5
(ii) x 2 − − x + = 0 gives
⇒ 2x 2 + 7x + 5 = 0
2 2
Algebra 109
3 1 10x 2 + 6x − 5
(iii) 2
x − − x + − = 0 ⇒ =0
5 2 10
Therefore, 10x 2 + 6x − 5 = 0 .
Example 3.26 Find the sum and product of the roots for each of the following quadratic
equations : (i) x 2 + 8x − 65 = 0 (ii) 2x 2 + 5x + 7 = 0
(iii) kx 2 − k 2x − 2k 3 = 0
Solution Let a and b be the roots of the given quadratic equation
(i) x 2 + 8x − 65 = 0
a = 1, b = 8, c = –65
b c
α+β =− = –8 and αβ = = –65
a a
α + β = −8 ; αβ = −65
(ii) 2x 2 + 5x + 7 = 0
a = 2, b = 5, c = 7
b -5 c 7
α+β =− = and αβ = =
a 2 a 2
5 7
α + β = − ; αβ =
2 2
(iii) kx 2 − k 2x − 2k 3 = 0
a = k, b = -k 2 , c = –2k3
b -(-k 2 ) c -2k 3
α+β =− = =k and αβ = = =–2k 2
a k a k
Exercise 3.9
1. Determine the quadratic equations, whose sum and product of roots are
5 -3
(i) -9, 20 (ii) , 4 (iii) , -1 (iv) −(2 − a )2 , (a + 5)2
3 2
2. Find the sum and product of the roots for each of the following quadratic equations
1 10
(i) x 2 + 3x − 28 = 0 (ii) x 2 + 3x = 0 (iii) 3 + = 2 (iv) 3y 2 − y − 4 = 0
a a
3.6.4 Solving Quadratic Equations
We have already learnt how to solve linear equations in one, two and three
variable(s). Recall that the values of the variables which satisfies a given equation are
called its solution(s). In this section, we are going to study three methods of solving
quadratic equation, namely factorization method, completing the square method and
using formula.
( 2x − 3 )( )
2x − 3 =0
2x − 3 = 0 or 2x − 3 = 0
2x = 3 or 2x = 3
3
Therefore the solution is x = .
2
Algebra 111
x x −1 1
Example 3.30 Solve + =2
x −1 x 2
x 1 x −1
Solution Let y = then = .
x −1 y x
x x −1 1 1 5
Therefore, + = 2 becomes y + =
x −1 x 2 y 2
1
2y 2 − 5y + 2 = 0 then, y = , 2
2
x 1
= we get, 2x = x − 1 implies x = −1
x −1 2
x
= 2 we get, x = 2x − 2 implies x = 2
x −1
Therefore, the roots are x = −1 , 2.
Exercise 3.10
2 2 2
3 3 1
2
2 2 2 ( )
x − 3x + = 2 + (Add co-efficient of x to both sides)
2
x − 3 = 17 (writing the LHS as complete square)
2 4
3 17
x- =± (Taking the square root on both sides)
2 2
3 17 3 17
x= + or x = −
2 2 2 2
3 + 17 3 - 17
Therefore, x = ,
2 2
Example 3.32 Solve 2x 2 − x − 1 = 0
Solution 2x 2 − x − 1 = 0
x 1
x2 - - =0 ( ÷ 2 make co-efficient of x 2 as 1)
2 2
x 1
x2 - =
2 2
2 2
x 1 1 1
x − + = +
2
2 4 2 4
2 2
x − 1 = 9 = 3
4 16 4
1 3 1
x − = ± ⇒ x = 1, -
4 4 2
Solving a Quadratic Equation by Formula Method
The formula for finding roots of a quadratic equation ax 2 + bx + c = 0 (derivation
−b ± b 2 − 4ac
given in section 3.6.2) is x = .
2a
The formula for finding roots of a quadratic equation was known to Ancient
Babylonians, though not in a form as we derived. They found the roots by
creating the steps as a verse, which is a common practice at their times.
Babylonians used quadratic equations for deciding to choose the dimensions
of their land for agriculture.
Algebra 113
−2 ± (2)2 − 4(1)(−2) −2 ± 12
x= = = −1 ± 3
2(1) 2
Therefore, x = −1 + 3 , −1 − 3
−b ± b 2 − 4ac
p=
2a
substituting the values of a, b and c in the formula we get,
(2 5 ) − 4(3)(−5)
2
−2 5 ±
−2 5 ± 80 − 5 ± 2 5
p= = =
2(3) 6 3
5
Therefore, x = ,- 5
3
Example 3.36 Solve pqx 2 − (p + q )2 x + (p + q )2 = 0
Solution Compare the coefficients of the given equation with the standard form
ax 2 + bx + c = 0
a = pq , b = −(p + q )2 , c = (p + q )2
−b ± b 2 − 4ac
x=
2a
substituting the values of a, b and c in the formula we get,
2
− −(p + q )2 ± −(p + q )2 − 4(pq )(p + q )2
x =
2pq
(p + q )2 ± (p + q )4 − 4(pq )(p + q )2
=
2pq
114 10th Standard Mathematics
(p + q )2 ± (p + q )2 (p + q )2 − 4pq
=
2pq
(p + q )2 ± (p + q )2 (p 2 + q 2 + 2pq − 4 pq )
=
2pq
(p + q )2 ± (p + q )2 (p − q )2
=
2pq
(p + q )2 ± (p + q )(p − q ) (p + q ){(p + q ) ± (p − q )}
= =
2pq 2pq
p +q p +q p +q p +q
Therefore, x = × 2p , × 2q we get, x = ,
2pq 2pq q p
Activity 3
Serve the fishes (Equations) with its appropriate food (roots). Identify a fish which
cannot be served?
4x2+12x+9 =0
x2 + 6x + 9 =0
x2–x–20 =0
2x 2
–5x–12=0
x2 –1=0
3 3 x2+16 = 0
- ,-
2 2
4.5
1, –1 –4, 5
3 4,–4
– ,4
2 –3, –3
Exercise 3.11
Example 3.37 The product of Kumaran’s age (in years) two years ago and his age four
years from now is one more than twice his present age. What is his present age?
Solution Let the present age of Kumaran be x years.
Two years ago, his age = (x − 2) years.
Four years from now, his age = (x + 4) years.
Given, (x − 2)(x + 4) = 1 +2x
x 2 + 2x − 8 = 1 +2x gives (x − 3)(x + 3) = 0 then, x = ±3
Therefore, x = 3 (Rejecting −3 as age cannot be negative)
Kumaran’s present age is 3 years.
Example 3.38 A ladder 17 feet long is leaning against a wall. If the ladder, vertical wall
and the floor from the bottom of the wall to the ladder form a right triangle, find the
height of the wall where the top of the ladder meets if the distance between bottom of the
wall to bottom of the ladder is 7 feet less than the height of the wall? A
t
By Pythagoras theorem, AC 2 = AB 2 + BC 2
(17)2 = x 2 + (x − 7)2 ; 289 = x 2 + x 2 − 14x + 49 B x–7 C
Fig. 3.7
x 2 − 7x − 120 = 0 hence, (x − 15)(x + 8) = 0 then, x = 15 (or) −8
Example 3.39 A flock of swans contained x 2 members. As the clouds gathered, 10x went
to a lake and one-eighth of the members flew away to a garden. The remaining three pairs
played about in the water. How many swans were there in total?
Solution As given there are x2 swans.
1
As per the given data x 2 − 10x − x 2 = 6 we get, 7x 2 − 80x − 48 = 0
8
−b ± b 2 − 4ac 80 ± 6400 − 4(7)(−48) 80 ± 88
x = = =
2a 14 14
4
Therefore,
x = 12, - .
7
4
Here x = - is not possible as the number of swans cannot be negative.
7
Hence, x = 12. Therefore total number of swans is x 2 = 144.
Example 3.40 A passenger train takes 1 hr more than an express train to travel a distance
of 240 km from Chennai to Virudhachalam. The speed of passenger train is less than that
of an express train by 20 km per hour. Find the average speed of both the trains.
Solution Let the average speed of passenger train be x km/hr.
Then the average speed of express train will be (x + 20) km/hr
240
Time taken by the passenger train to cover distance of 240 km = hr
x
240
Time taken by express train to cover distance of 240 km = hr
x + 20
240 240
Given, = +1
x x + 20
1 1 x + 20 − x
240 − = 1 gives, 240 = 1 we get, 4800 = (x 2 + 20x )
x x + 20 x (x + 20)
x 2 + 20x − 4800 = 0 gives, (x + 80)(x − 60) = 0 we get, x = –80 or 60.
Therefore x = 60 (Rejecting -80 as speed cannot be negative)
Average speed of the passenger train is 60 km/hr
Average speed of the express train is 80 km/hr.
Exercise 3.12
24
1. If the difference between a number and its reciprocal is, find the number.
5
2. A garden measuring 12m by 16m is to have a pedestrian pathway that is ‘w’ meters
wide installed all the way around so that it increases the total area to 285 m2. What
is the width of the pathway?
3. A
bus covers a distance of 90 km at a uniform speed. Had the speed been 15 km/hour
more it would have taken 30 minutes less for the journey. Find the original speed of
the bus.
4. A
girl is twice as old as her sister. Five years hence, the product of their ages (in
years) will be 375. Find their present ages.
5. A pole has to be erected at a point on the boundary of a circular ground of diameter
20 m in such a way that the difference of its distances from two diametrically opposite
fixed gates P and Q on the boundary is 4 m. Is it possible to do so? If answer is yes at
what distance from the two gates should the pole be erected?
6. F
rom a group of 2x 2 black bees , square root of half of the group went to a tree. Again
eight-ninth of the bees went to the same tree. The remaining two got caught up in a
fragrant lotus. How many bees were there in total?
Algebra 117
7. M
usic is been played in two opposite galleries with certain group of people. In the
first gallery a group of 4 singers were singing and in the second gallery 9 singers
were singing. The two galleries are separated by the distance of 70 m. Where should
a person stand for hearing the same intensity of the singers voice? (Hint: The ratio
of the sound intensity is equal to the square of the ratio of their corresponding
distances).
8. T
here is a square field whose side is 10 m. A square flower bed is prepared in its
centre leaving a gravel path all round the flower bed. The total cost of laying the
flower bed and gravelling the path at ₹3 and ₹4 per square metre respectively is ₹364.
Find the width of the gravel path.
9. Two women together took 100 eggs to a market, one had more than the other.
Both sold them for the same sum of money. The first then said to the second: “If
I had your eggs, I would have earned ₹ 15 ”, to which the second replied: “If I had
2
your eggs, I would have earned ₹ 6 ”. How many eggs did each had in the
3
beginning?
10. The hypotenuse of a right angled triangle is 25 cm and its perimeter 56 cm. Find
the length of the smallest side.
Example 3.41 Determine the nature of roots for the following quadratic equations
(i) x 2 − x − 20 = 0 (ii) 9x 2 − 24x + 16 = 0 (iii) 2x 2 − 2x + 9 = 0
Solution (i) x 2 − x − 20 = 0
Here, a = 1 , b = −1 , c = −20
Now, ∆ = b 2 − 4ac
∆ = (−1)2 − 4(1)(−20) = 81
Here, ∆ = 81 > 0 . So, the equation will have real and unequal roots
(ii) 9x 2 − 24x + 16 = 0
Here, a = 9 , b = −24 , c = 16
Example 3.42 (i) Find the values of ‘k’, for which the quadratic equation
kx 2 − (8k + 4) + 81 = 0 has real and equal roots?
(ii) Find the values of ‘k’ such that quadratic equation
(k + 9)x 2 + (k + 1)x + 1 = 0 has no real roots?
Solution (i) kx 2 − (8k + 4) + 81 = 0
Since the equation has real and equal roots, ∆ = 0 .
That is, b 2 − 4ac = 0
Here, a = k , b = −(8k + 4) , c = 81
2
That is,
−(8k + 4) − 4(k )(81) = 0
64k 2 + 64k + 16 − 324k = 0
64k 2 − 260k + 16 = 0
2 2
If ps = qr then D = −4 ps − qr = −4 qr − qr = 0 (using (1))
Thus, D = 0 if ps = qr and so the roots will be real and equal.
Exercise 3.13
1. Determine the nature of the roots for the following quadratic equations
(i) 15x 2 + 11x + 2 = 0 (ii) x 2 − x − 1 = 0 (iii) 2t 2 − 3t + 3 2 = 0
(iv) 9y 2 − 6 2y + 2 = 0 (v) 9a 2b 2x 2 − 24abcdx + 16c 2d 2 = 0 , a ¹ 0 , b ¹ 0
2. F
ind the value(s) of ‘k’ for which the roots of the following equations are real and
equal. (i) (5k − 6)x 2 + 2kx + 1 = 0 (ii) kx 2 + (6k + 2)x + 16 = 0
3. If the roots of (a − b)x 2 + (b − c)x + (c − a ) = 0 are real and equal, then prove that b,
a, c are in arithmetic progression.
4. If a, b are real then show that the roots of the equation
(a − b)x 2 − 6(a + b)x − 9(a − b) = 0 are real and unequal.
5. I f the roots of the equation (c 2 − ab)x 2 − 2(a 2 − bc)x + b 2 − ac = 0 are real and equal
prove that either a=0 (or) a 3 + b 3 + c 3 = 3abc
Thinking Corner
Fill up the empty box in each of the given expression so that the resulting quadratic
polynomial becomes a perfect square.
(i) x 2 + 14x + (ii) x 2 − 24x + (iii) p 2 + 2qp +
c Constant term
αβ = =
a Co-efficient of x 2
Progress Check
Roots of co-efficients Sum Product
Quadratic quadratic of x 2 , x and of of
constants b c Conclusion
equation equation Roots roots -
α and β α+β αβ a a
4x2–9x+2=0
2
x − 4 = 0
5
2x2–15x–27=0
Example 3.44 If the difference between the roots of the equation x 2 − 13x + k = 0 is 17
find k.
Solution x 2 − 13x + k =0 here, a = 1 , b = −13 , c = k Thinking Corner
If the constant term
Let , be the roots of the equation. Then of ax2+bx+c=0 is
−b −(−13) zero, then the sum
α + β = = = 13 ...(1) Also α − β = 17 ...(2) and product of roots
a 1
are and
(1)+(2) we get, 2a = 30 gives a = 15
.
Therefore, 15 + b = 13 (from (1)) gives b = −2
c k
But, αβ = = gives 15 × (−2) = k we get, k = −30
a 1
α β α2 β 2
(i) (α - β ) (ii) α + β (iii) α - β (iv) α + β
2 2 3 3 4 4
(v) + (vi) +
β α β α
Solution x 2 + 7x + 10 = 0 here, a = 1 , b = 7 , c = 10
α β α2 + β 2 (α + β )2 − 2αβ 49 − 20 29
(v) + = = = =
β α αβ αβ 10 10
Algebra 121
α2 β 2 α 3 + β 3 (α + β )3 − 3αβ(α + β )
(vi) + = =
β α αβ αβ
=
(
(−343) − 3 10 × (−7)) = −343 + 210 = −133
10 10 10
Example 3.46 If , are the roots of the equation 3x + 7x − 2 = 0 , find the values of
2
α β α2 β 2
(i) + (ii) +
β α β α
Solution 3x + 7x − 2 = 0 here, a = 3 , b = 7 , c = −2
2
3
1 1
Product of the roots (α β ) × (β α) = α β = (αβ ) = − = −
2 2 3 3 3
2 8
The required equation is x 2 - (Sum of the roots)x + (Product of the roots)=0
1 1
x 2 − − x − = 0 gives 8x 2 + 2x − 1 = 0
4 8
(iii) 2α + β , 2β + α
1 3
Sum of the roots 2α + β + 2β + α = 3(α + β ) = 3 =
2 2
Product of the roots = (2α + β )(2β + α) = 4αβ + 2α2 + 2β 2 + αβ
= 5αβ + 2(α2 + β 2 ) = 5αβ + 2 (α + β ) − 2αβ
2
1 1 1
= 5 − + 2 − 2 ×− =0
2 4 2
The required equation is x 2 - (Sum of the roots)x + (Product of the roots)=0
3
x 2 − x + 0 = 0 gives 2x 2 − 3x = 0
2
Exercise 3.14
6. If one root of the equation 3x 2 + kx + 81 = 0 (having real roots) is the square of the
other then find k.
Algebra 123
5 5
x2
y = x2
y=4
4 4
4 x2
y= 1
y = x2
3 3
2 2
1 1
X′ –3 –2 –1 0 1 2 3 X X′ –3 –2 –1 0 1 2 3 X
Y′ Y′
Fig. 3.10 Fig. 3.11
−b
Hint : For a quadratic equation , the axis is given by x = and the vertex is given by
−b −∆ 2a
, where ∆ = b 2 − 4ac is the discriminant of the quadratic equation
2a 4a
ax 2 + bx + c = 0 .
We have already studied how to find the roots of any quadratic equation
ax + bx + c = 0 where a,b,c Î ℝ and a ≠ 0 theoretically. In this section, we will learn how
2
Algebra 125
Step 2 Plot the points for the above ordered pairs (x, y) on the graph using suitable
scale.
Y
Scale
10
x-axis : 1 cm = 1 unit
y-axis : 1 cm = 2 units
(−5, 8) 8
)
(4, 8
6
12
+x −
4
y= 2
x
2
)
(−4, 0) (3, 0
X′ –6 –5 –4 –3 –2 –1 0 1 2 3 4 5 X
–2
–4
–6
(−3, –6) (2, –6)
–8
–10
(−2, –10) (1, –10)
–12
(−1, –12) (0, –12)
–14
Y′
Fig. 3.12
Step 3 Draw the parabola and mark the co-ordinates of the parabola which intersect the
X axis.
Step 4 The roots of the equation are the x coordinates of the intersecting points (–4, 0)
and (3,0)of the parabola with the X axis which are −4 and 3 respectively.
Since there are two points of intersection with the X axis, the quadratic equation
x + x − 12 = 0 has real and unequal roots.
2
(ii) x 2 − 8x + 16 = 0
Step 1 Prepare the table of values for the equation y = x 2 − 8x + 16
x −1 0 1 2 3 4 5 6 7 8
y 25 16 9 4 1 0 1 4 9 16
Step 2 Plot the points for the above ordered pairs (x, y) on the graph using suitable
scale.
Y
26 Scale
x-axis : 1 cm = 1 unit
(–1, 25) y-axis : 1 cm = 2 units
24
22
20
18
14
16
8x +
12
x −
y= 2
10
(1, 9)
(7, 9)
8
4 (2, 4) (6, 4)
2 (5, 1)
)
(3, 1) ,0
(4
X′ –5 –4 –3 –2 –1 0 1 2 3 4 5 6 7 8 X
–2
Y′
Fig. 3.13
Step 3 Draw the parabola and mark the coordinates of the parabola which intersect
with the X axis.
Step 4 The roots of the equation are the x coordinates of the intersecting points of the
parabola with the X axis (4,0) which is 4.
Since there is only one point of intersection with X axis, the quadratic equation
x − 8x + 16 = 0 has real and equal roots.
2
(iii) x 2 + 2x + 5 = 0
Let y = x 2 + 2x + 5
Algebra 127
Step 2 Plot the above ordered pairs(x, y) on the graph using suitable scale.
Y
Scale
x-axis : 1 cm = 1 unit 20 (3, 20)
y-axis : 1 cm = 2 units
18
5
2x +
16
x +
y= 2
14
(2, 13)
12
10
(−3, 8)
8 (1, 8)
6
(−2, 5) (0, 5)
4
(−1, 4)
2
X –6 –5 –4 –3 –2 –1 0 1 2 3 4 5 6 7 X
Y
Fig. 3.14
Step 3 Join the points by a free-hand smooth curve this smooth curve is the graph of
y = x 2 + 2x + 5
Step 4 The solutions of the given quadratic equation are the x coordinates of the
intersecting points of the parabola the X axis.
Here the parabola doesn’t intersect or touch the X axis.
So, we conclude that there is no real root for the given quadratic equation.
Progress Check
Connect the graphs to its respective number of points of intersection with X axis and
to its corresponding nature of solutions which is given in the following table.
1.
2 Real and equal roots
X O X
Y
2.
X O X 1 No real roots
Y
Y
O
X X
2
3. No real roots
Y
0
4. Real and equal roots
X O X
Y
5.
X O X 0 Real and unequal roots
Y
Y
O
X X
Y
x-axis : 1 cm = 1 unit
y-axis : 1 cm = 1 unit
preparing the table of values as below 9
x −2 −1 0 1 2
Scale
y 8 (2, 8)
6
8 02 2 8
+
8)
x
Step 2 To solve 2x − x − 6 = 0 , subtract
2,
2
=
7
(–
y
2x 2 − x − 6 = 0 from y = 2x 2 (1,7)
6 (0, 6)
that is y = 2x 2 )
(−) 1 ,5
0 = 2x 2 − x − 6 (– 5
y =x +6
y= 2
2x
4)
4
2,
The equation y = x + 6 represents a
(–
straight line. Draw the graph of y=x+6 by 3
forming table of values as below
x −2 −1 0 1 2 (–1, 2) 2 (1, 2)
y 4 5 6 7 8 1
Step 3 Mark the points of intersection of the (0, 0)
curve y = 2x 2 and the line 0 1 2 3 4 X
Y –2 –1
y = x + 6 . That is, (–1.5, 4.5) and (2,8) Y
Step 4 The x coordinates of the respective Fig. 3.15
3
y = x + 4x + 3 and hence find the roots of
2
4x +
x2 + x + 1 = 0 12
x +
y= 2
Solution
10
Step 1 Draw the graph of y = x 2 + 4x + 3 by
(1, 8)
preparing the table of values as below 8
8)
(2,
x −4 −3 −2 −1 0 1 2 6
5)
y 3 0 –1 0 3 8 15
(1,
4
, 3)
Step 2 To solve x + x + 1 = 0 , subtract
2 (−4 (0, 3) y=
3x +
2 2
x + x + 1 = 0 from y = x 2 + 4x + 3
2
0)
2)
(−1, 0
3,
that is, )
(0,
(−
X –4 –3 –2 –1 0 1 2 X
y = x 2 + 4x + 3
(–) –2
)
(−2, –1)
–1
0 = x2 + x + 1
1,
(−
)
–4
–4
y= 3x+2
2,
(−
Y
Fig. 3.16
130 10th Standard Mathematics
The equation represent a straight line. Draw the graph of y = 3x+2 forming the
table of values as below.
x −2 −1 0 1 2
y –4 –1 2 5 8
Step 3 Observe that the graph of y = 3x+2 does not intersect or touch the graph of the
parabola y = x 2 + 4x + 3 .
Thus x 2 + x + 1 = 0 has no real roots.
x-axis : 1 cm = 1 unit
y-axis : 1 cm = 1 unit
2 2
(–3, 4) 4 (2, 4)
that is y = x +x −2
2
Scale
(–) 3
0 = x2 + x − 2
2
x−
y= 0 2
x +
y= 2
The equation y = 0 represents the
1
X axis.
(–2, 0) (1, 0)
Step 3 Mark the point of intersection of 0 1 2 3 X
X –3 –2 –1
the curve x 2 + x − 2 with the –1
X axis. That is (–2,0) and (1,0)
–2 (0, –2)
(–1, –2)
Step 4 The x coordinates of the respective
Y
points form the solution set {−2,1}
Fig. 3.17
for x 2 + x − 2 =0
x −2 −1 0 1 2 3 4
y 15 8 3 0 –1 0 3
Algebra 131
that is y = x 2 − 4x + 3 Y
(–2, 15) Scale
(−) 14
0 = x 2 − 6x + 9 x-axis : 1 cm = 1 unit
3
y-axis : 1 cm = 2 units
− 4x +
y= 2x − 6 12
2
The equation y = 2x − 6 represent
y =x
10
a straight line. Draw the graph of
y = 2x − 6 forming the table of values as 8
(–1, 8) y=
below.
2x
6 −
6
x 0 1 2 3 4 5
4 4)
y –6 –4 –2 0 2 4 (0, 3) (4, 3) (5,
2 (4, 2)
The line intersect
y = 2x − 6 (3,
(1, 0) 0)
y = x − 4x + 3 only at one point.
2 (3, 0)
X –2 –1 0 1 2 3 4 5 X
1)
Step 3 Mark the point of intersection of –2 (2, –
the curve y = x 2 − 4x + 3 and y = 2x − 6 (2, –2)
that is (3,0). –4
(1, –4)
Exercise 3.15
1. Graph the following quadratic equations and state their nature of solutions.
(i) x 2 − 9x + 20 = 0 (ii) x 2 − 4x + 4 = 0 (iii) x 2 + x + 7 = 0
(iv) x 2 − 9 = 0 (v) x 2 − 6x + 9 = 0 (vi) (2x − 3)(x + 2) = 0
2
2. Draw the graph of y = x − 4 and hence solve x 2 −x −12 = 0
3.8 Matrices
Introduction
Let us consider the following information. Vanitha has 12 story books, 20
notebooks and 4 pencils. Radha has 27 story books, 17 notebooks and 6 pencils. Gokul
has 7 story books, 11 notebooks and 4 pencils. Geetha has 10 story books, 12 notebooks
and 5 pencils.
Details Story Books Note Books Pencil
Vanitha 12 20 4
Radha 27 17 6
Gokul 7 11 4
Geetha 10 12 5
Now we arrange this information in the tabular form as follows.
First row 12 20 4
Second row 27 17 6
Third row 7 11 4
Fourth row 10 12 5
First Second Third
Column Column Column
Here the items possessed by four people are aligned or positioned in a rectangular
array containing four horizontal and three vertical arrangements. The horizontal
arrangements are called “rows” and the vertical arrangements are called “columns”. The
whole rectangular arrangement is called a “Matrix”. Generally, if we arrange things in a
rectangular array, we call it as “ Matrix”.
Applications of matrices are found in several scientific fields. In Physics, matrices
are applied in the calculations of battery power outputs, resistor conversion of electrical
energy into other forms of energy. In computer based applications, matrices play a vital
role in the projection of three dimensional image into a two dimensional screen, creating
a realistic seeming motions. In graphic software, Matrix Algebra is used to process
linear transformations to render images. One of the most important usage of matrices
are encryption of message codes. The encryption and decryption process are carried out
using matrix multiplication and inverse operations. The concept of matrices is used in
transmission of codes when the messages are lengthy. In Geology, matrices are used for
taking seismic surveys. In Robotics, matrices are used to identify the robot movements.
Definition
A matrix is a rectangular array of elements. The horizontal arrangements are called
rows and vertical arrangements are called columns.
Algebra 133
4 8
0
For example, is a matrix.
1 9 −2
Usually capital letters such as A, B, C, X, Y, … etc., are used to represent the
matrices and small letters such as a, b, c, l, m, n, a12 , a13 , ... to indicate the entries or
elements of the matrices.
The following are some examples of matrices
8 4 −1
3 + 1 2 −1
1 1 + x
5 4 x3 sin x
(iii) 1.5 8 9
(i) 2 (ii)
9 0 1 cos x 2 tan x 1 −7
13
3 9
3.8.1 Order of a Matrix
If a matrix A has m number of rows and n
number of columns, then the order of the matrix Progress Check
A is (Number of rows) ´ (Number of columns) 1. Find is the element in the second
that is, m ´n .We read m ´n as m cross n or m by row and third column of the
n. It may be noted that m ´n is not a product of m 1 −2 3
and n. matrix
2 1 5
General form of a matrix A with m rows and
n columns (order m ´n ) can be written in the 2. Find is the order of the matrix
form sin q
cos q
a ... a1n
11 a12 ... a1 j tan q
a a22 ... a2 j ... a2n
A = 21
3. Determine the entries denoted
am 1 am 2 ... amj ... amn by a11, a22 , a 33 , a 44 from the matrix
2 1 3 4
where, a11, a12 ,... denote entries of the matrix.
5 9 −4 7
a11 is the element in first row, first column, a12 is
5
the element in the first row, second column, and 3 8 9
2
so on. 7 0 1 4
In general, aij is the element in the row ith
th th
and j column and is referred as (i,j) element.
With this notation, we can express the matrix A as A = (aij )m×n where i = 1, 2,....m and
j = 1, 2,...n .
Note
¾¾ When giving the order of a matrix, you should always mention the number of rows
first, followed by the number of columns.
For example,
S.No. Matrices Elements of the matrix Order of the matrix
1. sin q − cos q a11 = sin q , a12 = −cos q ,
cos q 2×2
sin q a21 = cos q , a22 = sin q
2. 1 3 a11 = 1 , a12 = 3 ,
2 5 a21 = 2 , a22 = 5 , 3×2
1
2 −4
a 31 = 21 , a 32 = −4
Activity 4
(i) Take calendar sheets of a particular month in a particular year.
(ii) C onstruct matrices from the dates of the calendar sheet.
(iii) Write down the number of possible matrices of orders
2 ´ 2, 3 ´ 2, 2 ´ 3, 3 ´ 3, 4 ´ 3, etc.
(iv) Find the maximum possible order of a matrix that you can
create from the given calendar sheet.
(v) Mention the use of matrices to organize information from
daily life situations.
3.8.2 Types of Matrices
In this section, we shall define certain types of matrices.
1. Row Matrix
A matrix is said to be a row matrix if it has only one row and any number of columns.
A row matrix is also called as a row vector.
3
For example, A = (8 9 4 3) , B = − 1 3 are row matrices of order 1´ 4
2
and 1×3 respectively.
In general A = (a11 a12 a13 ... a1n ) is a row matrix of order 1´n .
2. Column Matrix
A matrix is said to be a column matrix if it has only one column and any number of
rows. It is also called as a column vector.
sin x 8
5 −3
For example, A = cos x , B = and C = are column matrices of order
7 23
1
3 ´ 1 , 2 ´ 1 and 4 ´ 1 respectively. 17
a
11
a
21
In general, A = a 31 is a column matrix of order m ´1 .
a
m1
Algebra 135
Definition : In a square matrix, the elements of the form a11, a22, a33, . . . (i.e) aii are
1 3
called leading diagonal elements. For example in the matrix 4 5 , 1 and 5 are leading
diagonal elements.
4. Diagonal Matrix
A square matrix, all of whose elements, except those in the leading diagonal are zero
is called a diagonal matrix.
(ie) A square matrix A = (aij ) is said to be diagonal matrix if aij = 0 for i ¹ j . Note
that some elements of the leading diagonal may be zero but not all.
8 0 0 1 0 0
For example, , 0 −3 0 , 0 1 0 are diagonal matrices.
0 0 0
0 0 11
5. Scalar Matrix
A diagonal matrix in which all the leading diagonal elements are equal is called a
scalar matrix.
5 0 0
4 0 k 0 0
Thus , 0 k 0 , 0 5 0
0 4
0 0 5
0 0 k
In general, A = (aij )m×m is said to be a scalar matrix if
0 when i ≠ j
aij = where k is constant.
k when i = j
1 if i = j
Thus, the square matrix A = (aij ) is an identity matrix if aij =
0 if i ≠ j
A unit matrix of order n is written as I .
n
1 0 0
1 0
I 2 = , I 3 = 0 1 0 are identity matrices of order 2 and 3 respectively.
0 1
0 0 1
7. Zero matrix (or) null matrix
A matrix is said to be a zero matrix or null matrix if all its elements are zero.
0 0 0
0 0
For example, (0), 0 0 0 are all zero matrices of order 1 ´ 1 , 2 ´ 2 and
,
0 0
0 0 0
3 ´ 3 but of different orders. We denote zero matrix of order n ´ n by On .
0 0 0
is a zero matrix of the order 2 ´ 3 .
0 0 0
1 7 −3 8 0 0
For example, A = 0 2 4 is an upper triangular matrix and B = 4 5 0 is a
0 0 7 −11 3 1
lower triangular matrix.
Algebra 137
Equal Matrices
Progress Check
Two matrices A and B are said to be equal if and
only if they have the same order and each element of 1. The number of column(s)
matrix A is equal to the corresponding element of in a column matrix are
matrix B. That is, aij = bij for all i, j. _______.
5 1 2. The number of row(s) in a
For example, if A = , row matrix are _______.
0 3
3. The non-diagonal elements
12 + 22 sin2 q + cos2 q in any unit matrix are
then we
B = 2 ______.
1 + 3 − 5 2 + sec q − tan q
2
2 2
4. Does there exist a square
note that A and B have same order and aij = bij for matrix with 32 elements?
every i, j. Hence A and B are equal matrices.
The negative of a matrix
The negative of a matrix Am´n denoted by −Am×n is the matrix formed by replacing
each element in the matrix Am´n with its additive inverse.
Additive inverse of an element k is -k . That is, every element of –A is the negative
of the corresponding element of A.
2 −4 9 −2 4 −9
For example, if A =
then −A =
5 −3 −1 −5 3 1
2×3 2×3
Example 3.53 Consider the following information regarding the number of men and
women workers in three factories I, II and III.
Factory Men Women
I 23 18
II 47 36
III 15 16
Represent the above information in the form of a matrix. What does the entry in the
second row and first column represent?
Solution The information is represented in the form of a 3 ´ 2 matrix as follows
23 18
47 36
A =
15 16
The entry in the second row and first column represent that there are 47 men workers
in factory II.
Example 3.54 If a matrix has 16 elements, what are the possible orders it can have?
Solution We know that a matrix of order m ´ n , has mn elements. Thus to find all possible
orders of a matrix with 16 elements, we will find all ordered pairs of natural numbers
whose product is 16.
Activity 5
No. Elements Possible orders Number of possible Orders
1. 4 3
2. 1×9, 9×1, 3×3
3. 20
4. 8 4
5. 1
6. 100
7. 1×10, 10×1, 2×5, 5×2
Do you find any relationship between number of elements (second column) and
number of possible orders (fourth column)? If so, what is it?
a 31 = 32 × 12 = 9 × 1 = 9 ; a 32 = 32 × 22 = 9 × 4 = 36 ; a 33 = 32 × 32 = 9 × 9 = 81
1 4 9
Hence the required matrix is A = 4 16 36
9 36 81
a −b 2a + c 1 5
Example 3.56 Find the value of a, b, c, d from the equation =
2a − b 3c + d 0 2
Solution The given matrices are equal. Thus all corresponding elements are equal.
Therefore, a − b = 1 …(1)
2a + c = 5 …(2)
2a − b = 0 …(3)
3c + d = 2 …(4)
(3) gives 2a − b = 0
2a = b …(5)
Algebra 139
Exercise 3.16
8
9 3
4
3
5
1. In the matrix A = −1 7
2 , write (i) The number of elements
1 4 3 0
6
8 −11 1
(ii) The order of the matrix (iii) Write the elements a22, a23, a24 , a 34 , a 43, a 44 .
2. If a matrix has 18 elements, what are the possible orders it can have? What if it has
6 elements?
a − e b − f
a b e f
−
c d g h = c − g d − h
1 2 3 1 7 0
Example 3.57 If A = 4 5 6 , B = 1 3 1 , find A+B.
7 8 9 2 4 0
1 2 3 1 7 0 1 + 1 2 + 7 3 + 0 2 9 3
Solution A + B = 4 5 6 + 1 3 1 = 4 + 1 5 + 3 6 + 1 = 5 8 7
7 8 9 2 4 0 7 + 2 8 + 4 9 + 0 9 12 9
Example 3.58 Two examinations were conducted for three groups of students namely
group 1, group 2, group 3 and their data on average of marks for the subjects Tamil,
English, Science and Mathematics are given below in the form of matrices A and B. Find
the total marks of both the examinations for all the three groups.
Tamil English Science Mathematics
Group1 22 15 14 23
A = Group2 50 62 21 30
Group3 53 80 32 40
Algebra 141
1 3 −2 1 8
Example 3.59 If A = 5 −4 6 , B = 3 4 , find A+B.
−3 2 9 9 6
Solution It is not possible to add A and B because they have different orders.
Additive Identity
The null matrix or zero matrix is the identity for matrix addition.
Let A be any matrix.
Then, A + O = O + A = A where O is the null matrix or zero matrix of same order as
that of A.
Additive Inverse
If A be any given matrix then –A is the additive inverse of A.
In fact we have A + (−A) = (−A) + A = O
Example 3.62 Find the value of a, b, c, d, x, y from the following matrix equation.
d 8 3 a 2 2a 0 1
+
3b a −2 −4 = b 4c + −5 0
Solution
First, we add the two matrices on both left, right hand sides to get
d + 3 8 + a 2 2a + 1
=
3b − 2 a − 4 b − 5 4c
Algebra 143
Exercise 3.17
1
9 5 7
1. If A = 3 4 , B = 3 3 then verify that
8 −3 1 0
(i) A + B = B + A (ii) A + (−A) = (−A) + A = O.
4 3 1 2 3 4 8 3 4
2. If A = 2 3 −8, B = 1 9 2 and C = 1 −2 3 then verify that
1 0 −4 −7 1 −1 2 4 −1
A + (B + C ) = (A + B ) + C .
144 10th Standard Mathematics
7 0 3 0
3. Find X and Y if X+Y = and X −Y =
0 4
3 5
0 4 9 7 3 8
4. If A = , B =
1 4 9 find the value of (i) B - 5A (ii) 3A - 9B
8 3 7
x −3 3x − z 1 0
5. Find the values of x, y, z if (i) =
x + y + 7 x + y + z 1 6
(Order of left hand matrix) ´ (order of right hand matrix) ® (order of product matrix).
(3 × 3 ) (3 × 2 ) ® (3 × 2 )
Matrices are multiplied by multiplying the elements in a row of the first matrix by
the elements in a column of the second matrix, and adding the results.
a b ag + bk ah + bl ai + bm
g h i
For example, product of matrices c d × = cg + dk ch + dl ci + dm
k l m
e f eg + fk eh + fl ei + fm
The product AB can be found if the number of columns of matrix A is equal to the
number of rows of matrix B. If the order of matrix A is m ´ n and B is n ´ p then the order
of AB is m ´ p .
Properties of Multiplication of Matrix
(a) Matrix multiplication is not commutative in general
If A is of order m ´ n and B of the order n ´ p then AB is defined but BA is not
defined. Even if AB and BA are both defined, it is not necessary that they are equal.
In general AB ¹ BA.
Algebra 145
Note
¾¾ If x and y are two real numbers such that xy = 0 then either x = 0 or y = 0 . But this
condition may not be true with respect to two matrices.
¾¾ AB = 0 does not necessarily imply that A = 0 or B = 0 or both A, B = 0
Illustration
1 −1 1 1
≠ 0 and B =
A = 1 1 ≠ 0
−1 1
1 −1 1 1 1−1 1 − 1 0 0
But AB = × =
1 1
−1 + 1 −1 + 1 = 0 0 = 0
−1 1
Thus A ¹ 0, B ¹ 0 but AB = 0 .
8 3 1
1 2 0
Example 3.64 If A = , B = 2 4 1 , find AB.
3 1 5
5 3 1
Solution We observe that A is a 2 ´ 3 matrix and B is a 3×3 matrix, hence AB is defined
and it will be of the order 2 × 3.
8 3 1
1 2 0
Given A = , B = 2 4 1
3 1 5
2×3 5 3 1
3×3
1 2 0 8 3 1
AB = ×2 4 1
3 1 5
5 3 1
8+4+0 3+8+0 1 + 2 + 0 12 11 3
= =
24 + 2 + 25 9 + 4 + 15 3 + 1 + 5 51 28 9
2 1 2 0
Example 3.65 If A = , B =
1 3 find AB and BA. Check if AB = BA .
1 3
Solution We observe that A is a 2 ´ 2 matrix and B is a 2 ´ 2 matrix, hence AB is defined
and it will be of the order 2 ´ 2 .
2 1 2 0 4 + 1 0 + 3 5 3
× = =
AB =
1 3 1 3 2 + 3 0 + 9 5 9
Therefore, AB ¹ BA .
2 −2 2 2 2 2
Example 3.66 If A = and B =
− 2
2 2 2
Show that A and B satisfy commutative property with respect to matrix multiplication.
Solution We have to show that AB = BA
2 −2 2 2 2 2 2 2 2 2 −2 2
LHS AB = × RHS BA = ×
2 2 − 2 2 − 2 2 2 2
4+4
4 2 − 4 2
4+4 −4 2 + 4 2
= =
2 2 − 2 2 4 + 4 −2 2 + 2 2 4+4
8 0 8 0
= =
0 8 0 8
Note
Hence LHS = RHS (ie) AB = BA
¾¾ If A and B are any two
non zero matrices, then
2 1 x 4
Example 3.67 Solve =
1 2 y 5 (A + B )2 ≠ A2 + 2AB + B 2 .
2 1 x 4 ¾¾ However if AB = BA then
Solution × =
1 2 5
2×2 y 2×1 (A + B )2 = A2 + 2AB + B 2
2x + y 4
By matrix multiplication =
x + 2y 5
Rewriting 2x + y = 4 ...(1)
x + 2y = 5 ...(2)
−3y = − 6 gives y = 2
Algebra 147
RHS A(BC )
1 −1 1 − 2 2 + 1 −1 3
1 2
BC = 2 1 × = 2 + 2 4 − 1 = 4
3
2 −1
1 3 2×2 1 + 6 2 − 3 7 −1
3×2
−1 3
A(BC) = (1 −1 2)1×3 × 4 3
7 −1
3×2
RHS AB + AC
1 1 1 2 1 − 4 2 + 2 −3 4
× = =
AB =
−1 3 −4 2 −1 − 12 −2 + 6 −13 4
1 1 −7 6 −7 + 3 6 + 2 −4 8
× = =
AC =
−1 3 3 2 7 + 9 −6 + 6 16 0
3. A
has ‘a’ rows and ‘ a + 3 ’ columns. B has ‘b’ rows and ‘17–b’ columns, and if both
products AB and BA exist, find a, b?
2 5 1 −3
4. If A = , B =
2 5 find AB, BA and check if AB = BA?
4 3
1 3 1 −1 2 1 3 2
5. Given that A = , B = , C =
3 5 2
−4 1 3
5 −1
verify that A(B + C ) = AB + AC .
Algebra 149
1 2 1 −2
6. Show that the matrices A = , B =
−3 1 satisfy commutative propertyAB=BA
3 1
1 7
5 2 9
12. If A = , B = 1 2 verify that (AB ) = B A
T T T
1 2 8
5 −1
3 1
13. If A = show that A2 − 5A + 7I = 0
−1 2 2
Exercise 3.19
1
5. y 2 + is not equal to
y2
2 2 2
y4 + 1
(1) ( 2 ) y + 1 (3) y − 1 + 2 (4) y + 1 − 2
y2 y y y
x 8
6. 2 − 2 gives
x − 25 x + 6x + 5
x 2 − 7x + 40 x 2 + 7x + 40
(1) (2)
(x − 5)(x + 5) (x − 5)(x + 5)(x + 1)
x 2 − 7x + 40 x 2 + 10
(3) (4)
(x 2 − 25)(x + 1) (x 2 − 25)(x + 1)
256x 8y 4z 10
7. The square root of is equal to
25x 6y 6z 6
16 x 2z 4 y2 16 y 16 xz 2
(1) (2) 16 2 4 (3) (4)
5 y2 x z 5 xz 2 5 y
Algebra 151
16. If number of columns and rows are not equal in a matrix then it is said to be a
(1) diagonal matrix (2) rectangular matrix
(3) square matrix (4) identity matrix
17. Transpose of a column matrix is
(1) unit matrix (2) diagonal matrix
(3) column matrix (4) row matrix
1 3 5 7
=
18. Find the matrix X if 2X +
5 7 9 5
−2 −2 2 2 1 2 2 1
(1)
(2) (3) (4)
2 −1 2 −1
2 2
2 2
19. Which of the following can be calculated from the given matrices
1 2 1 2 3
A = 3 4, B = 4 5 6 , (i) A2 (ii) B2 (iii) AB (iv) BA
5 6 7 8 9
(1) (i) and (ii) only (2) (ii) and (iii) only
(3) (ii) and (iv) only (4) all of these
1
0
1 2 3 0 1
20. If A = , B = 2 −1 and C =
. Which of the following statements
3 2 1 −2 5
0 2
5 5
0
1
are correct? (i) AB + C = (ii) BC = 2 −3
5 5
−4 10
2 5 −8 20
(AB )C =
(iii) BA + C = 3 0 (iv) −8 13
(1) (i) and (ii) only (2) (ii) and (iii) only
(3) (iii) and (iv) only (4) all of these
Unit Exercise - 3
1
1. Solve (x + y − 5) = y − z = 2x − 11 = 9 − (x + 2z )
3
2. One hundred and fifty students are admitted to a school. They are distrbuted over
three sections A, B and C. If 6 students are shifted from section A to section C,
the sections will have equal number of students. If 4 times of students of section C
exceeds the number of students of section A by the number of students in section B,
find the number of students in the three sections.
3. I n a three-digit number, when the tens and the hundreds digit are interchanged the
new number is 54 more than three times the original number. If 198 is added to the
number, the digits are reversed. The tens digit exceeds the hundreds digit by twice as
that of the tens digit exceeds the unit digit. Find the original number.
4. Find the least common multiple of xy(k 2 + 1) + k (x 2 + y 2 ) and xy(k 2 − 1) + k (x 2 − y 2 )
10. Solve y + 1 + 2y − 5 = 3
11. A boat takes 1.6 hours longer to go 36 kms up a river than down the river. If the
speed of the water current is 4 km per hr, what is the speed of the boat in still water?
12. Is it possible to design a rectangular park of perimeter 320 m and area 4800 m 2 ? If so
find its length and breadth.
t2
13. At t minutes past 2 pm, the time needed to 3 pm is 3 minutes less than . Find t.
4
14. The number of seats in a row is equal to the total number of rows in a hall. The total
number of seats in the hall will increase by 375 if the number of rows is doubled and
the number of seats in each row is reduced by 5. Find the number of rows in the hall
at the beginning.
15. If a and b are the roots of the polynomial f (x ) = x 2 − 2x + 3, find the polynomial
a −1 b −1
whose roots are (i) a + 2, b + 2 (ii) , .
a +1 b +1
16. If –4 is a root of the equation x 2 + px − 4 = 0 and if the equation x 2 + px + q = 0 has
equal roots, find the values of p and q.
17. Two farmers Senthil and Ravi cultivates three varieties of grains namely rice, wheat
and ragi. If the sale (in `) of three varieties of grains by both the farmers in the
Algebra 153
p 0 0 −q 2 −2
, B = , C = 2
19. Given A = 1 0 2 2 and if BA = C , find p and q.
0 2
3 0 6 3 3 6
, B = , C =
20. A = 8 5 1 1 find the matrix D, such that CD–AB = 0
4 5
Points to Remember
c Constant term
Product of the roots αβ = =
a Co-efficient of x 2
zz If the roots of a quadratic equation are a and b , then the equation is given by
x 2 − (α + β )x + αβ = 0 .
zz The value of the discriminant (∆ = b 2 − 4ac) decides the nature of roots as follows
(i) When ∆ > 0 , the roots are real and unequal.
(ii) When ∆ = 0 , the roots are real and equal.
(iii) When ∆ < 0 , there are no real roots.
zz Solving quadratic equation graphically.
zz Order of a matrix
If a matrix A has m number of rows and n number of columns, then the order of the
matrix A is (Number of rows)´ (Number of columns) that is, m ´n .We read m ´n
as m cross n or m by n. It may be noted that m ´n is not a product of m and n.
zz Types of matrices
(i) A matrix is said to be a row matrix if it has only one row and any number of
columns. A row matrix is also called as a row vector.
(ii) A matrix is said to be a column matrix if it has only one column and any
number of rows. It is also called as a column vector.
(iii) A matrix in which the number of rows is equal to the number of columns is
called a square matrix.
(iv) A square matrix, all of whose elements, except those in the leading diagonal
are zero is called a diagonal matrix.
(v) A diagonal matrix in which all the leading diagonal elements are same is called
a scalar matrix.
(vi) A square matrix in which elements in the leading diagonal are all “1” and rest
are all zero is called an identity matrix (or) unit matrix.
(vii) A matrix is said to be a zero matrix or null matrix if all its elements are zero.
(viii) If A is a matrix, the matrix obtained by interchanging the rows and columns of
A is called its transpose and is denoted by AT .
(ix) A square matrix in which all the entries above the leading diagonal are zero is
called a lower triangular matrix.
If all the entries below the leading diagonal are zero, then it is called an upper
triangular matrix.
(x) Two matrices A and B are said to be equal if and only if they have the same
order and each element of matrix A is equal to the corresponding element of
matrix B. That is, aij = bij for all i, j.
Algebra 155
zz The negative of a matrix Am´n denoted by −Am×n is the matrix formed by replacing
each element in the matrix Am´n with its additive inverse.
Two matrices can be added or subtracted if they have the same order. To add or
subtract two matrices, simply add or subtract the corresponding elements.
Thus if A = (aij )m×n then , kA = (kaij )m×n for all i = 1,2,…,m and for all
j = 1,2,…,n.
ICT CORNER
ICT 3.1
Step 1: Open the Browser type the URL Link given below (or) Scan the QR Code. Chapter named
“Algebra” will open. Select the work sheet “Simultaneous equations”
Step 2: In the given worksheet you can see three linear equations and you can change the equations by typing
new values for a, b and c for each equation. You can move the 3-D graph to observe. Observe the nature of
solutions by changing the equations.
Step 1 Step 2 Expected results
ICT 3.2
Step – 1 Open the Browser type the URL Link given below (or) Scan the QR Code. GeoGebra work book
named “ALGEBRA” will open. Click on the worksheet named “Nature of Quadratic Equation”.
Step - 2: In the given worksheet you can change the co-efficient by moving the sliders given. Click on “New
position” and move the sliders to fix the boundary for throwing the shell. Then click on “Get Ball” and click
“fire” to hit the target. Here you can learn what happen to the curve when each co-efficient is changed.
Step 1 Step 2 Expected results
4
GEOMETRY
“The knowledge of which geometry aims is the knowledge of eternal”
– Plato
Learning Outcomes
z To recall congruent triangles and understand the
definition of similar triangles.
z To understand the properties and construction of similar triangles and
apply them to solve problems.
z To prove basic proportionality theorem, angle bisector theorem and
study their applications and study the construction of triangles under
given conditions.
z To prove Pythagoras theorem and study its applications.
z To understand the concept of tangent to a circle and study construction
of tangent to circle.
z To understand and apply concurrency theorems.
4.1 Introduction
The study of Geometry is concerned with knowing properties of various shapes and
structures. Arithmetic and Geometry were considered to be the two oldest branches of
mathematics. Greeks held Geometry in high esteem and used its properties to discuss
various scientific principles which otherwise would have been impossible. Eratosthenes
used the similarity of circle to determine the circumference of the Earth, distances
of the moon and the sun from the Earth, to a remarkable accuracy. Apart from these
achievements, similarity is used to find width of rivers, height of trees and much more.
157
4.2 Similarity
Two figures are said to be similar if every
aspect of one figure is proportional to other
figure. For example:
The above houses look the same but
different in size. Both the mobile phones are the same but they vary
in their sizes. Therefore, mathematically we say that two objects are
similar if they are of same shape but not necessarily they need to have
the same size. The ratio of the corresponding measurements of two
similar objects must be proportional.
Here is a box of geometrical shapes. Collect the similar objects and Fig. 4.1
list out.
In this chapter, we will be discussing specifically the
use of similar triangles which is of utmost importance
where if it is beyond our reach to physically measure the
distance and height with simple measuring instruments.
The concept of similarity is widely used in the fields of
engineering, architecture and construction.
Here are few applications of similarity
(i) By analyzing the shadows that make triangles,
Fig. 4.2
we can determine the actual height of the objects.
(ii) Used in aerial photography to determine the distance from sky to a particular
location on the ground.
(iii) Used in Architecture to aid in design of their work.
4.2.1 Similar triangles
In class IX, we have studied congruent triangles. We can say that two geometrical figures
are congruent, if they have same size and shape. But, here we shall study about geometrical
figures which have same shape but proportional sizes. These figures are called “similar”.
Fig. 4.3
158 10th Standard Mathematics
2 3 2 3 2 3 2 3
B C Q R B C Q R
Fig. 4.4 Fig. 4.5
∆ABC ≅ ∆PQR DABC DPQR
∠A = ∠P, ∠B = ∠Q, ∠C = ∠R . ∠A = ∠P, ∠B = ∠Q, ∠C = ∠R
AB = PQ, BC = QR,CA = RP AB ¹ PQ, BC ¹ QR,CA ¹ RP
AB BC CA AB BC CA
= = =1 but = = > 1 or < 1
PQ QR RP PQ QR RP
Same shape and same size. Same shape but not same size.
Thinking Corner
1. Are square and a rhombus similar or congruent. Discuss.
2. Are a rectangle and a parallelogram similar. Discuss.
4.2.2 Criteria of Similarity
The following criteria are sufficient to prove that two triangles are similar.
AA Criterion of similarity
P
If two angles of one triangle are respectively A R
1
equal to two angles of another triangle, then the two 1 C
triangles are similar, because the third angle in both 2
2
triangles must be equal. Therefore, AA similarity B
criterion is same as the AAA similarity criterion. Q
Fig. 4.6
So if ∠A = ∠P = 1 and ∠B = ∠Q = 2 then DABC DPQR .
SAS Criterion of similarity A
If one angle of a triangle is equal to one angle of another 1 R
triangle and if the sides including them are proportional then C
the two triangles are similar.
Thus if ∠A = ∠P = 1 and B 1
Q P
AB AC Fig. 4.7
= then DABC DPQR
PQ PR
Geometry 159
Thinking Corner
Are any two right angled triangles similar? If so why?
AB BC CA AD BE CF
= = = = =
PQ QR RP PS QT RU Fig. 4.10 Q S R
C
3. If two triangles are similar, then the ratio of 3 D
A
the corresponding sides are equal to the ratio 1 1
of the corresponding perimeters.
2 2 3
DABC DDEF then F
E Fig. 4.11
AB BC CA AB + BC + CA B
= = = P
DE EF FD DE + EF + FD A Q
1 2
1
4. The ratio of the area of two similar triangles are equal
to the ratio of the squares of their corresponding sides. 2
B
area(∆ABC ) AB 2 BC 2 AC 2 3 3
= = =
area(∆PQR) PQ 2 QR 2 PR 2 C
Fig. 4.12 R
5. If two triangles have common vertex and their bases are A
on the same straight line, the ratio between their areas is B
Definition 1
Two triangles are said to be similar if their corresponding sides are proportional.
Definition 2
The triangles are equiangular if the corresponding angles are equal.
Illustration Two triangles, DXYZ and DLMN are similar because the corresponding angles
are equal. X L
1 Note
1
2
(i) A pair of equiangular
Y 3
N
triangles are similar.
2
3 (ii) If two triangles are similar,
Z M then they are equiangular.
Fig. 4.14
XY YZ XZ
(i) ∠X = ∠L, ∠Y = ∠M , ∠Z = ∠N (by angles) (ii) = = (by sides)
LM MN LN
Here the vertices X, Y, Z correspond to the vertices L, M, N respectively. Thus in
symbol DXYZ DLMN
P
Example 4.1 Show that D PST D PQR
P 2 2
(i) (ii)
4 T
S
2
T 3
2 3
S
1
R R
Q Fig. 4.15
Q Fig. 4.16
Solution
(i) In D PST and D PQR , (ii) In D PST and D PQR ,
PS 2 2 PT 4 2 PS 2 2 PT 2 2
= = , = = = = , = =
PQ 2 + 1 3 PR 4+2 3 PQ 2 + 3 5 PR 2+3 5
PS PT PS PT
Thus, = and ÐP is common Thus, = and ÐP is common
PQ PR PQ PR
Therefore, by SAS similarity, Therefore, by SAS similarity,
D PST D PQR D PST D PQR
Note
¾¾ If we change exactly one of the four given lengths, then we can make these triangles similar.
A
Example 4.3 Observe Fig.4.18 and find ÐP . 3
3c
m
3cm
AB 3 1
Solution In D BAC and D PRQ , = = ; 60o
RQ 6 2 B C R
6cm
BC 6 1 CA 3 3 1
= = ; = = m
QP 12 2 PR 6 3 2 3c
6c
6
m
AB BC CA
Therefore, = =
RQ QP PR P 12cm Q
time = 4 seconds
C
distance
= speed ´ time
90 cm
= 1.2 × 4 = 4.8 m
B D x E
Let x be the length of the shadow Fig. 4.19
after 4 seconds
BE AB 4.8 + x 3.6
Since, D ABE DCDE , = gives = = 4 (since 90 cm = 0.9 m)
DE CD x 0. 9
C
4.8 + x = 4x gives 3x = 4.8 so, x =1.6 m
The length of his shadow DE = 1.6 m
m
8c
10cm
E
2cm
10
D AOQ DBOP
O P
AO OQ AQ
= = Q
BO OP BP Fig. 4.21 6 9
10 AQ 10 × 9
= gives AQ = = 15 cm B
6 9 6
Example 4.7 The perimeters of two similar triangles ABC and PQR are
respectively 36 cm and 24 cm. If PQ = 10 cm, find AB.
Solution The ratio of the corresponding sides B P
of similar triangles is same as the ratio of their
perimeters.
m
Since DABC DPQR ,
10c
?
R
AB BC AC 36
= = =
PQ QR PR 24
AB 36 AB 36 A Q
= gives =
PQ 24 10 24 C
36 × 10 Fig. 4.22
AB = = 15 cm
24
Example 4.8 If D ABC is similar to D DEF such that BC = 3 cm, EF = 4 cm and area of
D ABC = 54 cm2. Find the area of D DEF .
Solution Since the ratio of area of two similar triangles is equal to the ratio of the squares
of any two corresponding sides, we have
Area (∆ABC )
BC 2 54 32
= gives = 2
Area (∆DEF ) EF 2 Area (∆DEF ) 4
16 × 54
Area (∆DEF ) = = 96 cm2
9 D
Example 4.9 Two poles of height ‘a’ metres
and ‘b’ metres are ‘p’ metres apart. Prove that
the height of the point of intersection of the lines B
b
joining the top of each pole to the foot of the O
ab
opposite pole is given by metres. a
a +b h
Solution Let AB and CD be two poles of height C A
x L y
‘a’ metres and ‘b’ metres respectively such that p
Fig. 4.23
the poles are ‘p’ metres apart. That is AC = p
metres. Suppose the lines AD and BC meet at O, such that OL = h metres
Geometry 163
Geometry 165
7
3. Locate 7 points (the greater of 7 and 4 in )
4
Q1,Q2 ,Q3 ,Q4 ,Q5 ,Q6 and Q7 on QX so that
QQ1 = Q1Q2 = Q2Q3 = Q3Q4 = Q4Q5 = Q5Q6 = Q6Q7
7
4. Join Q4 (the 4th point, 4 being smaller of 4 and 7 in ) to R and draw a line through Q7
4
parallel to Q4R, intersecting the extended line segment QR at R ¢ .
5. Draw a line through R ¢ parallel to RP intersecting the extended line segment QP at P ¢
Then ∆P ′QR ′ is the required triangle each of whose sides is seven-fourths of the
corresponding sides of DPQR .
Exercise 4.1
1. Check whether the which triangles are similar and find the value of x.
C A
(i) (ii)
1
3 2
5 P
E
2
x
A 5 B 70o o
110
3 D
B 3 Q 3 C
2. A girl looks the reflection of the top of the lamp post on the mirror which is 66 m
away from the foot of the lamppost. The girl whose height is 12.5 m is standing
2.5 m away from the mirror. Assuming the mirror is placed on the ground facing
the sky and the girl, mirror and the lamppost are in a same line, find the height of
the lamp post.
3. A vertical stick of length 6 m casts a shadow 400 cm long on the ground and at the same
time a tower casts a shadow 28 m long. Using similarity, find the height of the tower.
4. Two triangles QPR and QSR, right angled at P and S respectively are drawn
on the same base QR and on the same side of QR. If PR and SQ intersect at T, A
E
prove that PT × TR = ST × TQ. 3
8. If DABC DDEF such that area of DABC is 9cm2 and the area of DDEF is
P
16cm2 and BC = 2.1 cm. Find the length of EF.
6m
Q R
9. Two vertical poles of heights 6 m and 3 m are erected above a
3m
y
horizontal ground AC. Find the value of y. A B C
2
10. Construct a triangle similar to a given triangle PQR with its sides equal to of the
3
2
corresponding sides of the triangle PQR (scale factor ).
3
4
11. Construct a triangle similar to a given triangle LMN with its sides equal to of the
5
4
corresponding sides of the triangle LMN (scale factor ).
5
6
12. Construct a triangle similar to a given triangle ABC with its sides equal to of the
5
6
corresponding sides of the triangle ABC (scale factor ).
4
7
13. Construct a triangle similar to a given triangle PQR with its sides equal to of the
3
7
corresponding sides of the triangle PQR (scale factor ).
3
4.3 Thales Theorem and Angle Bisector Theorem
4.3.1 Introduction
Thales, (640 - 540 BC (BCE)) the most famous Greek mathematician
and philosopher lived around seventh century BC (BCE). He possessed
knowledge to the extent that he became the first of seven sages of
Greece. Thales was the first man to announce that any idea that emerged
should be tested scientifically and only then it can be accepted. In this
aspect, he did great investigations in mathematics and astronomy and
discovered many concepts. He was credited for providing first proof in
Thales
mathematics, which today is called by the name “Basic Proportionality (640 - 540 BC (BCE))
Theorem”. It is also called “Thales Theorem” named after its discoverer.
The discovery of the Thales theorem itself is a very interesting story. When Thales
travelled to Egypt, he was challenged by Egyptians to determine the height of one of several
magnificent pyramids that they had constructed. Thales accepted the challenge and used
similarity of triangles to determine the same successfully, another triumphant application of
Geometry. Since X0, X1 and H0 are
known, we can determine the height
H1 of the pyramid.
ht H1
of sig
Line H0
To understand the basic
proportionality theorem or Thales X0
H1 H0
X1 =
theorem, let us do the following X1 X0
activity.
Fig. 4.27
Geometry 167
Activity 2
Take any ruled paper and draw a triangle ABC with its base on one of the lines.
Several parallel lines will cut the triangle ABC. A
Select any one line among them and name the points
M N
where it meets the sides AB and AC as P and Q.
P Q
AP AQ
Can we find the ratio of and . By measuring AP,
PB QC R S
PB, AQ and QC through a scale, verify whether the ratios are
equal or not? Try for different parallel lines, say MN and RS. B C
AM AN AR AS Fig. 4.28
Now find the ratios , and , .
MB NC RB SC
Check if they are equal? The conclusion will lead us to one of the most important
theorem in Geometry, which we will discuss below.
Statement 3
D 1 2 E
A straight line drawn parallel to a side of triangle intersecting
the other two sides, divides the sides in the same ratio. 1 2
B C
Proof Fig. 4.29
Corollary
If in D ABC , a straight line DE parallel to BC, intersects AB at D and AC at E, then
AB AC AB AC A
(i) = (ii) = .
AD AE DB EC
Proof
D E
In DABC, DE BC ,
AD AE
therefore, = (by Basic Proportionality Theorem)
DB EC B C
Fig. 4.30
DB EC
(i) Taking reciprocals, we get = (ii) Add 1 to both the sides
AD AE
DB EC AD AE
Add 1 to both in the sides +1 = +1 +1 = +1
AD AE DB EC
DB + AD EC + AE AB AC AB AC
= so, = Therefore, =
AD AE AD AE DB EC
Is the converse of Basic Proportionality Theorem also true? To examine let us do the
following illustration.
Illustration
Draw an angle XAY on your notebook as shown in Fig.4.31 and on ray AX, mark
points B1, B2 , B3 , B4 and B such that AB1 = B1B2 = B2B3 = B3B4 = B4B = 1 cm.
Similarly on ray AY, mark points C 1,C 2 ,C 3 ,C 4 and C, such that
AC1=C1C2 = C2C3 = C3C4 = C4C = 2 cm, Join B1 C 1 and BC.
A
AB1 1 AC 1
Observe that = = and B1C 1 BC B1
B1B C 1C 4 B2 C1
B3
Similarly joining B2C2, B3C3 and B4C4 you see that B4 C2
AB2 AC 2 2 B
= = and B2C 2 BC C3
B2B C 2C 3
AB3 AC 3 3 C4
= = and B 3C 3 BC
B 3B C 3C 2
C
AB4
4 AC 4
= = and B 4C 4 BC
B4 B C 4C 1 Fig. 4.31
X Y
From this we observe that if a line divides two sides of a triangle in the same ratio,
then the line is parallel to the third side.
Therefore, we obtain the following theorem called converse of the Thales theorem.
Theorem 2: Converse of Basic Proportionality Theorem
Statement
If a straight line divides any two sides of a triangle in the same ratio, then the line
must be parallel to the third side.
Geometry 169
Proof A
AD AE
Given : In ∆ABC , =
DB EC E
D
To prove : DE BC
F
Construction : Draw BF DE
B Fig. 4.32 C
AD AF
3. = … (2) Thales theorem (In DABC taking F in AC)
DB FC
4. AE AF From (1) and (2)
=
EC FC
AE AF Adding 1 to both sides
+1 = +1
EC FC
AE + EC AF + FC
=
EC FC
AC AC
=
EC FC
EC = FC Cancelling AC on both sides
The internal bisector of an angle of a triangle divides the opposite side internally in
the ratio of the corresponding sides containing the angle.
Proof
C E
Given : In D ABC, AD is the internal bisector 2 1
AB BD
To prove : = D
AC CD
1
1 2
Construction :
Draw a line through C parallel to AB. A B
Extend AD to meet line through C at E Fig. 4.33
No Statement Reason
∠AEC = ∠BAE = ∠1 Two parallel lines cut by a transversal make alternate
1.
angles equal.
D ACE is isosceles
2. In ∆ ACE ,∠CAE = ∠CEA
AC = CE … (1)
DABD DECD
3. AB BD By AA Similarity
=
CE CD
AB BD From (1) AC = CE .
4. =
AC CD Hence proved.
Activity 3
Step 1: Take a chart and cut it like a triangle as shown in Fig.4.34(a).
Step 2: Then fold it along the symmetric line AD. Then C and B will be one upon the other.
A A
Step 3: Similarly fold it along CE, then B and A will
be one upon the other.
In the three cases, the internal bisector of an angle of a triangle divides the opposite
side internally in the ratio of the corresponding sides containing the angle.
Geometry 171
5. AB BD From (1)
=
AC DC
AB BA
6. = From (1) and (2)
AC AE
7. AC = AE … (3) Cancelling AB
8. ∠1 = ∠2 DACE is isosceles by (3)
9. AD bisects ÐA Since, ∠1 = ∠BAD = ∠2 = ∠DAC . Hence proved
Example 4.12 In DABC , if DE BC , AD = x , DB = x − 2, and EC = x − 1 then find
the lengths of the sides AB and AC.
A
Solution In DABC we have DE BC .
x
x+
AD AE
By Thales theorem, we have = D
2
DB EC E
2
x +2
x–
x
= gives x (x − 1) = (x − 2)(x + 2)
x–
x -2 x −1
B
1
Hence, x 2 − x = x 2 − 4 so, x = 4 Fig. 4.36
C
When x = 4 , AD = 4 , DB = x − 2 = 2 , AE = x + 2 = 6 , EC = x − 1 = 3 .
Hence, AB = AD + DB = 4 + 2 = 6 , AC = AE + EC = 6 + 3 = 9 .
Therefore, AB = 6, AC = 9 .
Example 4.13 D and E are respectively the points on the sides AB and AC of a D ABC
such that AB=5.6 cm, AD=1.4 cm, AC=7.2 cm and AE = 1.8 cm, show that DE BC .
Solution We have AB = 5.6 cm, AD = 1.4 cm, AC = 7.2 cm and AE = 1.8 cm.
A
BD = AB − AD = 5.6–1.4 = 4.2 cm 1.8
and EC = AC –AE = 7.2–1.8 = 5.4 cm. E 5
1.4
.4
AD 1.4 1 AE 1.8 1
= = and = = D C
DB 4.2 3 EC 5.4 3
4.2
AD AE
= Fig. 4.37
DB EC B
Therefore, by converse of Basic Proportionality Theorem, we have DE is parallel to BC.
Hence proved.
172 10th Standard Mathematics
BE BC
Example 4.14 In the Fig.4.38, DE AC and DC AP . Prove that = .
EC CP
Solution In DBPA, we have DC AP . By Basic Proportionality Theorem,
BC BD A
we have = …(1)
CP DA
D
In DBCA, we have DE AC . By Basic Proportionality
Theorem, we have
BE BD
= …(2)
EC DA B E C P
BE BC Fig. 4.38
From (1) and (2) we get, = . Hence proved.
EC CP
A
Example 4.15 In the Fig.4.39, AD is the bisector of ÐA . If BD = 4 cm,
DC = 3 cm and AB = 6 cm, find AC.
m
6c
Solution In DABC , AD is the bisector of ÐA
Therefore by Angle Bisector Theorem C
B 4 cm D 3 cm
BD AB Fig. 4.39
=
DC AC
4 6 9
= gives 4AC = 18 . Hence, AC = = 4.5 cm
3 AC 2
AB BD
=
AC DC
B x D 6–x C
10 x 5 x 6 cm
= gives =
14 6 − x 7 6−x Fig. 4.40
30
So, 12x = 30 we get, x = = 2.5 cm
12
Therefore, BD = 2.5 cm, DC = 6 − x = 6 − 2.5 = 3.5 cm
Progress Check
1. A straight line drawn _______ to a side of a triangle divides the other two sides
proportionally.
2. Basic Proportionality Theorem is also known as _______.
Geometry 173
In this section, let us construct a triangle when the following are given :
(i) the base, vertical angle and the median on the base
(ii) the base, vertical angle and the altitude on the base
(iii) the base, vertical angle and the point on the base H
where the bisector of the vertical angle meets the
base. C
q F
First, we consider the following construction,
O
Construction of a segment of a circle on a given line
segment containing an angle q
Construction 90o– q
A q G B
Step 1: Draw a line segment AB .
Step 2: At A, take ∠BAE = q Draw AE.
Step 3: Draw, AF ^ AE . E
Step 6: Take any point C on the circle, By the alternate segments theorem, the major arc
ACB is the required segment of the circle containing the angle q .
Note
¾¾ If C 1,C 2 ,... are points on the circle, then all the triangles DBAC 1, DBAC 2 ,... are with
same base and the same vertical angle.
Construction of a triangle when its base, the vertical angle and the median from the
vertex of the base are given.
Example 4.17 Construct a DPQR in which PQ = 8 cm, ∠R = 60° and the median RG
from R to PQ is 5.8 cm. Find the length of the altitude from R to PQ. R
Solution H
60 o
5.8cm
R F S G
P 8cm Q
60 o
Rough diagram
5. O
8c
m
L M P 60o G 8cm Q
N
E Fig. 4.42
Construction
Step 6: From G mark arcs of radius 5.8 cm on the circle. Mark them as R and S .
Geometry 175
Construct a triangle when its base, the vertical angle and the altitude from the vertex
to the base are given. P
o
30
∠P = 30° and the altitude from P to QR is of length 4.2 cm.
4.2cm
Solution
G
H Q 5cm R
Rough diagram
F
X
O
A B
P M S
30 o
4.2cm
G
Q 30o 5cm R
Construction
Step 6: From G mark an arc in the line XY at M, such that GM = 4.2 cm.
Construct of a triangle when its base, the vertical angle and the point A
on the base where the bisector of the vertical angle meets the base
60 o
Example 4.19 Draw a triangle ABC of base BC = 8 cm, ∠A = 60 and
the bisector of ÐA meets BC at D such that BD = 6 cm. 6cm D
B 8cm C
Solution
H Rough diagram
J
A
O 30
o
30 o
6cm
B 60o 8cm G D C
Construction I
Exercise 4.2
1. In D ABC , D and E are points on the sides AB and AC respectively such that
AD 3
DE BC (i) If = and AC = 15 cm find AE.
DB 4
(ii) If AD = 8x − 7 , DB = 5x − 3 , AE = 4x − 3 and EC = 3x − 1 , find the value of x.
Geometry 177
3. In D ABC, D and E are points on the sides AB and AC respectively. For each of the
following cases show that DE BC
(i) AB = 12 cm, AD = 8 cm, AE = 12 cm and AC = 18 cm.
(ii)AB = 5.6 cm, AD = 1.4 cm, AC = 7.2 cm and AE = 1.8 cm.
B
4. In fig. if PQ BC and PR CD prove that Q
AR AQ QB DR P
(i) = (ii) = . A C
AD AB AQ AR R
D
5. Rhombus PQRB is inscribed in D ABC such that ÐB is one of its angle. P, Q and R
lie on AB, AC and BC respectively. If AB = 12 cm and BC = 6 cm, find the sides
PQ, RB of the rhombus.
B C
8. In D ABC, AD is the bisector of ∠A meeting side BC at D, if AB = 10 cm,
AC = 14 cm and BC = 6 cm, find BD and DC
11. ABCD is a quadrilateral in which AB = AD, the bisector of ÐBAC and ÐCAD intersect
the sides BC and CD at the points E and F respectively. Prove that EF BD .
12. Construct a D PQR which the base PQ = 4.5 cm, ∠R = 35 and the median from R
to RG is 6 cm.
13. Construct a D PQR in which QR = 5 cm, ∠P = 40° and the median PG from P to
QR is 4.4 cm. Find the length of the altitude from P to QR.
14. Construct a D PQR such that QR = 6.5 cm, ∠P = 60° and the altitude from P to
QR is of length 4.5 cm.
178 10th Standard Mathematics
15. Construct a D ABC such that AB = 5.5 cm, ∠C = 25° and the altitude from C to
AB is 4 cm.
16. Draw a triangle ABC of base BC = 5.6 cm, ∠A = 40° and the bisector of ÐA
meets BC at D such that CD = 4 cm.
17. Draw D PQR such that PQ = 6.8 cm, vertical angle is 50° and the bisector of the
vertical angle meets the base at D where PD = 5.2 cm.
Three numbers (a, b, c) are said to form Pythagorean Triplet, if they form sides of a
right triangle. Thus (a, b, c) is a Pythagorean Triplet if and only if c 2 = a 2 + b 2 .
Now we are in a position to study this most famous and important theorem not only
in Geometry but in whole of mathematics.
Activity 4
25
20
12
15
5 9 12
15
20
4 12 16
(i) (ii) (iii) (iv)
Fig. 4.45
Step 1: Take a chart paper, cut out a right angled triangle of measurement as given in
triangle (i) .
Step 2: Take three more different colour chart papers and cut out three triangles
such that the sides of triangle (ii) is three times of the triangle (i), the sides
of triangle (iii) is four times of the triangle (i), the sides of triangle (iv) is five
times of triangle (i).
Geometry 179
Step 3: Now keeping the common side length 12 place the triangle (ii) and (iii) over the
triangle (iv) such that the sides of these two triangles [(ii) and (iii)] coincide
with the triangle (iv).
Observe the hypotenuse side and write down the equation. What do you conclude?
Note
¾¾ In a right angled triangle, the side opposite to 90° (the right angle) is called the
hypotenuse.
¾¾ The other two sides are called legs of the right angled triangle.
¾¾ The hypotenuse will be the longest side of the triangle.
Proof
Given : In DABC , ∠A = 90°
B D C
To prove : AB + AC = BC
2 2 2 Fig. 4.46
Construction : Draw AD ^ BC
AB BC
=
BD AB
AB = BC × BD … (1)
2
Example 4.20 An insect 8 m away initially from the foot of a lamp post which is 6 m tall,
crawls towards it moving through a distance. If its distance from the top of the lamp post is
equal to the distance it has moved, how far is the insect away from the foot of the lamp post?
Solution Distance between the insect and the foot of the lamp post BD = 8 m
The height of the lamp post, AB = 6 m A
x
x 2 = 36 + 64 − 16x + x 2
16x = 100 then x = 6.25
Then, BC = 8 − x = 8 − 6.25 = 1.75 m
Therefore the insect is 1.75 m away from the foot B 8–x C x D
8m
of the lamp post. Fig. 4.47
Geometry 181
Example 4.21 P and Q are the mid-points of the sides CA and CB respectively of a
D ABC , right angled at C. Prove that 4(AQ 2 + BP 2 ) = 5AB 2 .
A
Solution Since, DAQC is a right triangle at C, AQ 2 = AC 2 + QC 2 … (1)
Also, DBPC is a right triangle at C, BP 2 = BC 2 + CP 2 … (2)
P
From (1) and (2), AQ 2 + BP 2 = AC 2 + QC 2 + BC 2 + CP 2
4(AQ 2 + BP 2 ) = 4AC 2 + 4QC 2 + 4BC 2 + 4CP 2
B Q C
= 4AC 2 + (2QC )2 + 4BC 2 + (2CP )2 Fig. 4.48
2 2
= 4AC + BC + 4BC + AC 2 2
(Since P and Q are mid points)
= 5(AC 2 + BC 2 )
Example 4.22 What length of ladder is needed to reach a height of 7 ft along the wall
when the base of the ladder is 4 ft from the wall? Round off your answer to the next tenth
place. A
wall
7 feet
x 2 = 65 . Hence, x = 65
The number 65 is between 8 and 8.1. Ground
8 = 64 < 65 < 65.61 = 8.1
2 2
B 4 feet C
Therefore, the length of the ladder is approximately 8.1 ft. Fig. 4.49
Progress Check
3. If the square of the longest side of a triangle is equal to sums of squares of other
two sides, then the triangle is _________.
Exercise 4.3
1. A man goes 18 m due east and then 24 m due north. Find the distance of his current
position from the starting point? Sarah
house
2. There are two paths that one can choose to
go from Sarah’s house to James house. One
1.5 miles
way is to take C street, and the other way
B Street
t
ree
requires to take A street and then B street. St
James C
house
How much shorter is the direct path along C A Street
street? (Using figure).
2 miles
3. To get from point A to point B you must avoid walking through a pond. You must
walk 34 m south and 41 m east. To the nearest meter, how many meters would be
saved if it were possible to make a way through the pond? Z Y
6. 5 m long ladder is placed leaning towards a vertical wall such that it reaches the
wall at a point 4 m high. If the foot of the ladder is moved 1.6 m towards the wall,
then find the distance by which the top of the ladder would slide upwards on the
wall.
Geometry 183
Q Q Q
O O O
B
A
A
Fig. 4.52(a) Fig. 4.52(b) P Fig. 4.52(c)
P P
(iii) Thus the number of (iii) Thus the number of (iii) Thus the number of
points of intersection of points of intersection of points of intersection of
a line and circle is zero. a line and circle is one. a line and circle is two.
Note
The word “tangent” comes
¾ The line segment AB inscribed in the from the latin word “tangere” which
circle in Fig.4.52(c) is called chord of means “to touch” and was introduced
the circle. Thus a chord is a sub-section by Danish mathematician, ‘Thomas
of a secant. Fineko’ in 1583.
Definition
If a line touches the given circle at only one point, then it is called tangent to the circle.
A
Some results on circles and tangents O
1. A tangent at any point on a circle and the radius through the point
P
are perpendicular to each other.
Q
Fig. 4.54
B
2. (a) No tangent can be (b) Only one tangent can be (c) Two tangents can be
drawn from an interior drawn at any point on a drawn from any exterior
point of the circle. circle. point of a circle.
A A
A
O P O
P O
B B
B
Fig. 4.55(a) Fig. 4.55(b) Fig. 4.55(c)
A
3. The lengths of the two tangents drawn from an exterior
point to a circle are equal, O P
The distance between their centers OP = d . It is clear from the Fig. 4.57 that when
the circles touch externally OP = d = OQ + PQ = r1 + r2 .
5. If two circles touch internally, the distance between their centers
P
is equal to the difference of their radii, that is OP = r1 − r2 . O r
1 r2 Q
Proof : Let two circles with centers at O and P touch each other at Q.
Let OQ = r1 and PQ = r2 and let r1 > r2 . Fig. 4.58
The distance between their centers OP = d . It is clear from the Fig. 4.58 that when
the circles touch internally, OP = d = OQ − PQ P
OP = r1 − r2 .
B D
6. The two direct common tangents drawn to the circles are equal in
length, that is AB = CD.
Proof :
The lengths of tangents drawn from P to the two circles are equal. A C
O
Therefore, PA = PC and PB = PD .
gives PA − PB = PC − PD
Fig. 4.59
AB = CD
Thinking Corner
1. Can we draw two tangents parallel to each other on a circle?
2. Can we draw two tangents perpendicular to each other on a circle?
R
Alternate segment
In the Fig. 4.60, the chord PQ divides the circle
into two segments. The tangent AB is drawn such that it S Q
1
touches the circle at P.
2
The angle in the alternate segment for ÐQPB (Ð1) T
is ÐQSP (Ð1) and that for ÐQPA (Ð2) is ÐPTQ (Ð2) . 2 1
Theorem 6 : Alternate Segment theorem A P B
Fig. 4.60
Statement R
If a line touches a circle and from the point of
contact a chord is drawn, the angles between the tangent S Q
and the chord are respectively equal to the angles in the
corresponding alternate segments. O
Proof
T
Given : A circle with centre at O, tangent AB
touches the circle at P and PQ is a chord. S and T are
two points on the circle in the opposite sides of chord A P B
PQ. Fig. 4.61
6. ∠QPB = ∠PSQ ...(6) From (4) and (5); Hence (i) is proved.
Example 4.24 Find the length of the tangent drawn from a point whose distance from the
centre of a circle is 5 cm and radius of the circle is 3 cm.
T
Solution Given OP = 5 cm, radius r = 3 cm
m
52 = 32 + PT 2 gives PT 2 = 25 − 9 = 16
Fig. 4.62
Length of the tangent PT = 4 cm
Geometry 187
OR 2 = OP 2 − PR 2
4cm
m
5c
OR 2 = 52 − 42 = 25 − 16 = 9 ⇒ OR = 3 cm y
O R T
OT = OR+RT = 3+y ... (1)
4cm
In DPRT , TP 2 = TR 2 + PR 2 … (2)
Q
and D OPT we have, OT 2 = TP 2 + OP 2
Fig. 4.63
OT 2 = (TR 2 + PR 2 ) + OP 2 (substitute for TP2 from (2))
BN = BL = 4 cm
CL = CM = AC – AM = 9 – 3 = 6 cm L
B C
Fig. 4.65
Gives BC = BL + CL = 4 + 6 = 10 cm
Example 4.28 If radii of two concentric circles are 4 cm and 5 cm then find the length of
the chord of one circle which is a tangent to the other circle.
Solution OA = 4 cm, OB = 5 cm; also OA ^ BC .
OB 2 = OA2 + AB 2
52 = 42 + AB 2 gives
⇒ AB 2 = 9 O
Therefore AB = 3 cm
4cm
5c
BC = 2AB hence
⇒ BC = 2 × 3 = 6 cm
B A C
4.5.1 Construction
Fig. 4.66
Construction of tangents to a circle
m
3c
Solution Given, radius r = 3 cm P
T¢
Rough diagram
Construction
TT ¢ to OP which passes
through P. P N
Example 4.30 Draw a circle of radius 4 cm. At a point L on it draw a tangent to the circle
using the alternate segment.
Geometry 189
Solution M
Given, radius=4 cm N O
4cm
M
T
L
T¢ Rough diagram
Construction
A
8cm
O P
7.4 B
cm
3cm
Rough diagram
8cm
O P
M
Fig. 4.69
190 10th Standard Mathematics
Construction
Step 1: With centre at O, draw a circle of radius 3 cm.
Step 2: Draw a line OP of length 8 cm.
Step 3: Draw a perpendicular bisector of OP, which cuts OP at M.
Step 4: With M as centre and MO as radius, draw a circle which cuts previous circle
at A and B.
Step5: Join AP and BP. AP and BP are the required tangents. Thus length of the
tangents are PA = PB = 7.4 cm.
Verification : In the right angle triangle OAP , PA2 = OP 2 − OA2 = 64 – 9 = 55
PA = 55 = 7.4 cm (approximately) .
4.6 Concurrency Theorems
Definition A
Special cevians
(i) A median is a cevian that divides the opposite
side into two congruent(equal) lengths. The term cevian comes
(ii) An altitude is a cevian that is perpendicular to from the name of Italian
the opposite side. engineer Giovanni Ceva,
(iii) An angle bisector is a cevian that bisects the who proved a well known
corresponding angle. theorem about cevians.
Ceva’s Theorem (without proof ) A
Statement
Let ABC be a triangle and let D,E,F be points on lines BC, E
CA, AB respectively. Then the cevians AD, BE, CF are F
BD CE AF
concurrent if and only if × × = 1 where the lengths
DC EA FB
are directed. This also works for the reciprocal of each of the ratios B D C
Fig. 4.70
as the reciprocal of 1 is 1.
Note
¾¾ The cevians do not necessarily lie within the triangle, although they do in the diagram.
Geometry 191
Q
Menelaus Theorem (without proof )
Statement
A
A necessary and sufficient condition for points P, Q, R on
the respective sides BC, CA, AB (or their extension) of a triangle R
BP CQ AR
ABC to be collinear is that × × = −1 where all
PC QA RB
B P C
segments in the formula are directed segments. Fig. 4.71
Menelaus
Menelaus was a Greek mathematician who lived during the Roman empire in both
Alexandria and Rome during first century CE. His work was largely on the geometry of spheres.
Menelaus theorem was first discussed in his book, sphaerica and later mentioned by
Ptolemy in his work Almagest.
Menelaus theorem proves that spheres are made up of spherical triangles.
Note
A
Example 4.32 Show that in a triangle, the medians are concurrent.
Solution Medians are line segments joining each vertex to the E
midpoint of the corresponding opposite sides.
F
Thus medians are the cevians where D, E, F are midpoints of
BC, CA and AB respectively. C
D
BD
Since D is a midpoint of BC, BD = DC so = 1 …(1) Fig. 4.72
DC B
CE
CE
Since, E is a midpoint of CA, CE EA so
=EA
CE = =11 … (2)
=
EA
EA
AF
Since, F is a midpoint of AB, AF = FB so = 1 … (3)
FB
Thus, multiplying (1), (2) and (3) we get,
BD CE AF
´ ´ =1×1×1=1 Centroid is the point
DC EA FB
of concurrence of the
And so, Ceva’s theorem is satisfied. medians.
Hence the Medians are concurrent.
192 10th Standard Mathematics
and So, CD = AC – AD = 5 – 1 = 4.
Example 4.34 Suppose AB, AC and BC have lengths 13, 14 and 15 respectively. If
AF 2 CE 5
= and = . Find BD and DC.
FB 5 EA 8
BD CE AF
Using Ceva’s theorem, we have, × × = 1 …(1) F
DC EA FB
AF CE E
Substitute the values of and in (1),
FB EA
BD 5 2
we have × × =1 B x D y C
DC 8 5 Fig. 4.74
x 10 x 1
× = 1 we get, × = 1 . Hence, x = 4y …(2)
y 40 y 4
BC = BD + DC = 15 so, x + y = 15 … (3)
Geometry 193
Example 4.35 In a garden containing several trees, three particular trees P, Q, R are
located in the following way, BP = 2 m, CQ = 3 m, A
RA = 10 m, PC = 6 m, QA = 5 m, RB = 2 m, where
A, B, C are points such that P lies on BC, Q lies on
AC and R lies on AB. Check whether the trees P, Q, R
lie on a same straight line.
Q
Solution By Meanlau’s theorem, the trees P, Q, R will
be collinear (lie on same straight line)
BP CQ RA B
if × × = 1 …(1) P C
PC QA RB
Given BP =2 m, CQ =3 m, RA =10 m, PC =6 m, R
Fig. 4.75
QA = 5 m and RB = 2 m
BP CQ RA 2 3 10 60
Substituting these values in (1) we get, × × = × × = =1
PC QA RB 6 5 2 60
Hence the trees P, Q, R lie on a same straight line.
Progress Check
Exercise 4.4
1. The length of the tangent to a circle from a point P, which is 25 cm away from the
centre is 24 cm. What is the radius of the circle?
2. LMN is a right angled triangle with ∠L = 90° . A circle is inscribed in it. The
lengths of the sides containing the right angle are 6 cm and 8 cm. Find the radius of
the circle. C
z z
10 E
10 cm and 12 cm as shown in figure,
x
Find AD, BE and CF. y
x D y
A 12cm B
4. PQ is a tangent drawn from a point P to a circle with centre O and QOR is a diameter
of the circle such that ∠POR = 120° . Find ÐOPQ .
194 10th Standard Mathematics
3cm
?
Join D to E and extend it to meet at F. Find BF. D
F
11. An artist has created a triangular stained glass window and has one
strip of small length left before completing the window. She needs
10cm
to figure out the length of left out portion based on the lengths of
5cm
the other sides as shown in the figure.
12. Draw a tangent at any point R on the circle of radius 3.4 cm and
centre at P ? A 3cm E 4cm C
13. Draw a circle of radius 4.5 cm. Take a point on the circle. Draw the tangent at that
point using the alternate segment theorem.
14. Draw the two tangents from a point which is 10 cm away from the centre of a circle
of radius 5 cm. Also, measure the lengths of the tangents.
15. Take a point which is 11 cm away from the centre of a circle of radius 4 cm and draw
the two tangents to the circle from that point.
16. Draw the two tangents from a point which is 5 cm away from the centre of a circle of
diameter 6 cm. Also, measure the lengths of the tangents.
17. Draw a tangent to the circle from the point P having radius 3.6 cm,
and centre at O. Point P is at a distance 7.2 cm from the centre.
Exercise 4.5
Multiple choice questions
AB BC
1. If in triangles ABC and EDF, = then they will be similar, when
DE FD
(1) ∠B = ∠E (2) ∠A = ∠D (3) ∠B = ∠D (4) ∠A = ∠F
Geometry 195
5. The perimeters of two similar triangles DABC and DPQR are 36 cm and 24 cm
respectively. If PQ = 10 cm, then the length of AB is
2 10 6 2
(1) 6 cm (2) cm (3) 66 cm (4) 15 cm
3 3 3
9. Two poles of heights 6 m and 11 m stand vertically on a plane ground. If the distance
between their feet is 12 m, what is the distance between their tops?
(1) 13 m (2) 14 m (3) 15 m (4) 12.8 m
10. In the
given figure, PR = 26 cm, QR = 24 cm, P
∠PAQ = 90° , PA=6 cm and QA = 8 cm. Find ÐPQR A 90o
12. How many tangents can be drawn to the circle from an exterior point?
(1) one (2) two (3) infinite (4) zero
13. The two tangents from an external points P to a circle with centre at O are PA and
PB. If ∠APB = 70° then the value of ÐAOB is
(1) 100° (2) 110° (3) 120° (4) 130°
P
14. In figure CP and CQ are tangents to a circle with centre at O. A
ARB is another tangent touching the circle at R. If CP = 11 cm
and BC = 7 cm, then the length of BR is R C
O
(1) 6 cm (2) 5 cm B
Q
(3) 8 cm (4) 4 cm
P R
15. In figure if PR is tangent to the circle at P and O is the
60
o
centre of the circle, then ÐPOQ is
(1) 120° (2) 100° O
(3) 110° (4) 90° Q
Unit Exercise - 4
A B E B
2. In the given figure AB CD EF .
5c
m
If AB = 6 cm, CD = x cm, EF = 4 cm, BD = 5 cm F
6cm
D
and DE = y cm. Find x and y.
4cm
y
x
3. O is any point inside a triangle ABC. The bisector of ÐAOB , A C E
ÐBOC and ÐCOA meet the sides AB, BC and CA in point D,
E and F respectively. Show that AD × BE ×CF = DB × EC × FA A
Points to Remember
zz Two triangles are similar if
(i) their corresponding angles are equal
(ii) their corresponding sides are in the same ratio or prvoportional.
zz Any congruent triangles are similar but the converse is not true
zz AA similarity criterion is same as the AAA similarity criterion.
zz If one angle of a triangle is equal to one angle of another triangle and the sides
including these angles are in the same ratio then the triangles are similar. (SAS)
zz If three sides of a triangle are proportional to the corresponding sides of another
triangle, then the two triangles are similar (SSS)
zz If two triangles are similar then the ratio of the corresponding sides is equal to the
ratio of the corresponding perimeters.
zz The ratio of the area of two similar triangles are equal to the ratio of the squares of
their corresponding sides.
zz A tangent to a circle will be perpendicular to the radius at the point of contact.
zz Two tangents can be drawn from any exterior point of a circle.
zz The lengths of the two tangents drawn from an exterior point to a circle are equal.
zz Two direct common tangents drawn to two circles are equal in length.
ICT CORNER
ICT 4.1 Expected results
Step 1: O
pen the Browser type the URL Link given below (or) Scan the QR
Code. 10th Standard Mathematics Chapter named “Geometry” will
open. Select the work sheet “Angular Bisector theorem”
Step 2: I n the given worksheet you can see Triangle ABC and its Angular Bisector
CD. and you can change the triangle by dragging the Vertices. Observe the
ratios given on Left hand side and learn the theorem.
Step 1 Step 2
Step 1: O
pen the Browser type the URL Link given below (or) Scan the QR
Code. 10th Standard Mathematics Chapter named “Geometry” will
open. Select the work sheet “Pair of Tangents”.
Step 2: I n the given worksheet you can change the radius and Distance by moving
the sliders given on Left hand side. Move the Slider in the middle to see the
steps for construction.
Step 1 Step 2
https://www.geogebra.org/m/jfr2zzgy#chapter/356194
or Scan the QR Code.
Geometry 199
5
COORDINATE GEOMETRY
“A line is breadthless length” - Euclid
Learning Outcomes
5.1 Introduction
In the earlier classes, we initiated the study of coordinate geometry where we studied
about coordinate axes, coordinate plane, plotting of points in a plane, distance between two
points, section formulae, etc. All these concepts form the basics of coordinate geometry.
Let us now recall some of the basic formulae.
Recall
Distance between two points
B(x2, y2)
d
Distance between two points A(x 1, y1 ) and B(x 2 , y2 ) is
A(x1, y1)
AB = d = (x 2 − x 1 )2 + (y2 − y1 )2 .
Fig. 5.1
Mid-point of line segment
B(x2, y2)
M
The mid-point M, of the line segment joining
x + x y + y
A(x 1, y1 ) and B(x 2 , y2 ) is 1 2
, 1 2
. A(x1, y1) Fig. 5.2
2 2
Section Formula
B(x2, y2)
Internal Division
n
Let A (x 1, y1 ) and B (x 2 , y2 ) be two distinct points such that point P
C(x3, y3)
Centroid of a triangle
2
1 G
The coordinates of the centroid (G) of a triangle with vertices
2 1
1
x + x + x y + y + y A(x , 2
A (x 1, y1 ) , B (x 2 , y2 ) and C (x 3 , y 3 ) are given by 1 2 3
, 1 2 3
.
1 y )
1
3 3 Fig. 5.5 B(x2, y2)
Progress Check
1. Complete the following table.
Mid Internal External
S.No. Points Distance
Point Point Ratio Point Ratio
(i) (3, 4), (5, 5) 2:3 2:3
13
(ii) (–7,13),(–3,1) − , 5 (–13, 15)
3
2. A(0, 5), B(5, 0) and C(-4, -7) are vertices of a triangle then its centroid will be at
_________.
Using 2s = a + b + c , we can calculate the area of triangle ABC by using the Heron’s
formula s(s - a )(s - b)(s - c) . But this procedure of finding length of sides of D ABC
and then calculating its area will be a tedious procedure.
Progress Check
The vertices of D PQR are P(0, - 4) , Q(3, 1) and R(-8, 1)
1. Draw D PQR on a graph paper.
2. Check if D PQR is equilateral.
3. Find the area of D PQR .
4. Find the coordinates of M, the mid-point of QP.
5. Find the coordinates of N, the mid-point of QR.
6. Find the area of D MPN .
7. What is the ratio between the areas of D MPN and D PQR ?
Similarly, if the area of D ABC is zero, then the three points lie on the same straight
line. Thus, three distinct points A (x 1, y1 ) , B (x 2 , y2 ) and C (x 3 , y 3 ) will be collinear if and
only if area of ∆ABC = 0 .
Y ,y 4) C (x3, y3)
7 D (x 4
5.3 Area of a Quadrilateral 6
5
If ABCD is a quadrilateral, then considering the
4
diagonal AC, we can split the quadrilateral ABCD into 3
two triangles ABC and ACD. 2
1
= {(x y + x 2y4 + x 4y1 ) − (x 2y1 + x 4y2 + x1y4 )}
2 1 2
B (x2,y2) C (x3,y3)
P Q R S
1
+
2 2 3
{
(x y + x 3y4 + x 4y2 ) − (x 3y2 + x 4y3 + x 2y4 ) X′ O } X
Y¢
1 Fig. 5.9
= {(x 1y2 + x 2y 3 + x 3y 4 + x 4y1 ) − (x 2y1 + x 3y2 + x 4y 3 + x 1y 4 )}
=
2
1
= {(x 1 − x 3 )(y2 − y 4 ) − (x 2 − x 4 )(y1 − y 3 )} sq.units.
2
The following pictorial representation helps us to write the above formula very easily.
Take the vertices A(x 1, y1 ) , B(x 2 , y2 ) , C (x 3 , y 3 ) and D(x 4 , y 4 ) in counter-clockwise direction
and write them column-wise as that of the area of a triangle.
204 10th Standard Mathematics
x x2 x3 x4 x 1
1
1
=
2
y1 y2 y3 y4 y1
Therefore, area of the quadrilateral ABCD
1
= {(x y + x 2y3 + x 3y4 + x 4y1 ) − (x 2y1 + x 3y2 + x 4y3 + x1y4 )} sq.units.
2 1 2
Note
¾ To find the area of a quadrilateral, we divide it into triangular regions, which have no
common area and then add the area of these regions.
¾ The area of the quadrilateral is never negative. That is, we always take the area of
quadrilateral as positive.
Thinking Corner
1. If the area of a quadrilateral formed by the points (a, a), (–a, a), (a, –a) and
(–a, –a), where a ¹ 0 is 64 square units, then identify the type of the quadrilateral
2. Find all possible values of a.
Example 5.1 Find the area of the triangle whose vertices are (-3, 5) , (5, 6) and (5, - 2)
Solution Plot the points in a rough diagram and take them in counter-clockwise order.
Let the vertices be A (-3, 5) , B (5, - 2) , C (5, 6)
(x 1, y1 ) (x 2 , y2 ) (x 3 , y 3 ) Y C(5,6)
6
A(–3,5)
5
The area of DABC is
4
1
= {(x y + x 2y3 + x 3y1 ) − (x 2y1 + x 3y2 + x1y3 )}
2 1 2
3
2
1 1
=
2
{(6 + 30 + 25) − (25 − 10 − 18)}
X′ -5 -4 -3 -2 -1 0 1 2 3 4 5X
-1
1
= {61 + 3} -2 B(5,–2)
2 Y¢
1 Fig. 5.10
= (64) = 32 sq.units
2
Example 5.2 Show that the points P(-1.5 , 3) , Q(6 , -2) , R(-3 , 4) are collinear.
Solution The points are P(-1.5 , 3) , Q(6 , -2) , R(-3 , 4)
1
Area of D PQR = {(x y + x 2y3 + x 3y1 ) − (x 2y1 + x 3y2 + x1y3 )}
2 1 2
1 1
= {(3 + 24 − 9) − (18 + 6 − 6)} = {18 − 18} = 0
2 2
Therefore, the given points are collinear.
Example 5.3 If the area of the triangle formed by the vertices A(-1, 2) , B(k , -2) and
C(7, 4) (taken in order) is 22 sq. units, find the value of k.
Example 5.4 If the points P(-1, -4) , Q(b, c) and R(5, - 1) are collinear and if 2b + c = 4 ,
then find the values of b and c.
Solution Since the three points P(-1, - 4) , Q(b, c) and R(5, - 1) are collinear,
Area of triangle PQR = 0
1
{(x y + x 2y3 + x 3y1 ) − (x 2y1 + x 3y2 + x1y3 )} = 0
2 1 2
1
2
{(−c − b − 20) − (−4b + 5c + 1)} = 0
−c − b − 20 + 4b − 5c − 1 = 0
b - 2c = 7 …(1)
Also, 2b + c = 4 …(2) (from given information)
Solving (1) and (2) we get b = 3 , c = −2
Example 5.5 The floor of a hall is covered with identical tiles which are in the shapes of
triangles. One such triangle has the vertices at (-3 , 2) , (-1, -1) and (1, 2) . If the floor of
the hall is completely covered by 110 tiles, find the area of the floor.
Solution Vertices of one triangular tile are at
(-3 , 2) , (-1, -1) and (1, 2)
1
Area of this tile =
2
{(3 − 2 + 2) − (−2 − 1 − 6)} sq.units
1
= (12) = 6 sq.units A(–3,2) ,2)
2 C(1
Since the floor is covered by 110 triangle shaped
identical tiles, B(–1,–1)
Example 5.6 Find the area of the quadrilateral formed by the points (8, 6) , (5, 11) , (-5, 12)
and (-4, 3) .
Solution Before determining the area of quadrilateral, plot the vertices in a graph.
Let the vertices be A(8,6), B(5,11), C(–5,12) and D(–4,3)
1 C(–5,12) Y
= {(x y + x 2y3 + x 3y4 + x 4y1 ) − (x 2y1 + x 3y2 + x 4y3 + x1y4 )}
2 1 2
12 B(5,11)
10
1 8
= {(88 + 60 − 15 − 24) − (30 − 55 − 48 + 24)} 6
2 A(8,6)
4
1
= {109 + 49} D(–4,3) 2
2
X′ -6 -4 -2 0 2 4 6 8 10 X
1 Y¢
= {158} = 79 sq.units Fig. 5.12
2
Progress Check
Given a quadrilateral ABCD with vertices A(–3, –8), B(6, –6), C(4, 2), D(–8, 2)
Y
6
1. Find the area of D ABC . 4
D(–8,2) C(4,2)
2. Find the area of D ACD . 2
X′ -8 -6 -4 -2 0 2 4 6 8 10 X
3. Calculate area of D ABC + area of D ACD . -2
-4
4. Find the area of quadrilateral ABCD. -6
-8 B(6,–6)
5. Compare the answers obtained in 3 and 4. A(–3,–8)
-10
Y¢
Fig. 5.13
Y
Example 5.7 The given diagram shows a plan for constructing a 9
C(4,9)
1
= {(10 + 45 + 28 + 2) − (10 + 20 + 9 + 14)} X′ 0 1 2 3 4 5 X
2 Y¢
1 1 2 5 4 1 2 Fig. 5.14
= {85 − 53} Use:
2 2 2 5 9 7 2
1
= (32) = 16 sq.units.
2
So, area of parking lot = 16 sq.feets
Construction rate per square feet = ₹ 1300
Therefore, total cost for constructing the parking lot = 16 × 1300 = ₹20800
Activity 1
(i) Take a graph sheet.
(ii) Consider a triangle whose base is the line joining the points (0,0) and (6,0)
Activity 2
Y C(5,7)
7
6 Two French
Find the area of the mathematicians Rene
5 D(5,5)
shaded region 4 Descartes and
3 Pierre-de-Fermat were
2 the first to conceive
1
A(1,1)
B(8,1) the idea of modern
X′ 0 1 2 3 4 5 6 7 8 9X
coordinate geometry by
Y¢
1630s.
Fig. 5.15
Exercise 5.1
4. In each of the following, find the value of ‘a’ for which the given points are collinear.
(i) (2, 3), (4, a) and (6, –3) (ii) (a, 2–2a), (–a+1, 2a) and (–4–a, 6–2a)
5. Find the area of the quadrilateral whose vertices are at
(i) (–9, –2), (–8, –4), (2, 2) and (1, –3) (ii) (–9, 0), (–8, 6), (–1, –2) and (–6, –3)
6. Find the value of k, if the area of a quadrilateral is 28 sq.units, whose vertices are
(–4, –2), (–3, k), (3, –2) and (2, 3)
7. If the points A(-3, 9) , B(a, b) and C(4, - 5) are collinear and if a + b = 1 , then find
a and b.
8. Let P(11, 7) , Q(13.5, 4) and R(9.5, 4) be the mid-
points of the sides AB, BC and AC respectively of D(–10,6)
C(6,10)
D ABC . Find the coordinates of the vertices A, B
G(3,7)
and C. Hence find the area of D ABC and compare H(–6,4)
2
E(1.5,1)
1
10. In the figure, find the area of (i) triangle AGF G(–4.5,0.5)
O
(ii) triangle FED (iii) quadrilateral BCEG. X′ -6 -5 -4 -3 -2 -1
-1
1 2 3 4X
C(2,–1)
-2
B(–4,–2) Y¢
5.4 Inclination of a line
The inclination of a line or the angle of inclination of a line is the angle which a
straight line makes with the positive direction of X axis measured in the counter-clockwise
direction to the part of the line above the X axis. The inclination of the line is usually
denoted by q .
Note
¾ The inclination of X axis and every line parallel to X axis is 0° .
¾ The inclination of Y axis and every line parallel to Y axis is 90° .
Definition
If q is the angle of inclination of a non-vertical straight line, then tan q is called the
slope or gradient of the line and is denoted by m.
Therefore the slope of the straight line is m = tan q , 0 ≤ q ≤ 180° , q ≠ 90°
To find the slope of a straight line when two points are given
Y
7
B(x2,y2)
Slope m = tan q 6
5
opposite side (y2–y1)
4
= 3
adjacent side A(x1,y1) q
2 C
(x2–x1)
1
BC q
= 0
AC X′ 1 2 3 4 5 6 7 8 9X
Y¢
Fig. 5.17
y 2 − y1
m = .
x 2 − x1
Note
change in y coordinates ¾ The slope of a vertical
Slope m = line is undefined.
change in x coordinates
y 2 - y1
The slope of the line through (x 1, y1 ) and (x 2 , y2 ) with x 1 ¹ x 2 is .
x 2 - x1
Values of slopes
S. No. Condition Slope Diagram
Y
4
3
Y
4
3
The line has positive 0∠q∠90°
2
slope (A line with 1
(ii) 0 < q < 90° q
positive slope rises
X′ -1 0 1 2 3 4 5 6 7 8 X
from left to right). -1
Y¢
Fig. 5.18(b)
Y
4
3
The line has negative 2
90°∠q∠180°
slope (A line with q
(iii) 90° < q < 180° 1
negative slope falls
X′ -1 0 1 2 3 4 5 6 7 8 X
from left to right). -1
Y¢
Fig. 5.18(c)
Y
4
3
Y
4
q = 90°
3
2
The slope is 1
(v) q = 90°
undefined.
X′ -1 0 1 2 3 4 5 6 7 8 X
-1
Y¢
Fig. 5.18(e)
Activity 3
Y
6
5 l2
The diagram contain four lines l1
4
l1, l2, l3 and l4. 3
Progress Check
Write down the slope of each of the lines shown on the grid below. One is solved for you.
Y Y
(i) (ii) Slope = ?
Slope = ?
s
t
O X
O X Y Y
q
Y r
(iii) (iv) (v)
p
Slope = ?
Fig. 5.20
change in y coordinate 3
Solution (iii) Slope of the line p = = =1
change in x coordinate 3
m1m2 = −1 . 4
3
tan q1 = − tan(90° − q2 )
tan q1 = tan (−(90° − q2 )) = tan (q2 − 90°)
q1 = q2 − 90° (since 0 ≤ q1, q2 ≤ 180° )
Coordinate Geometry 213
q2 = 90° + q1
We get, q = 60°
Example 5.9 Find the slope of a line joining the given points
1 1 2 3
(i) (-6, 1) and (-3, 2) (ii) − , and , (iii) (14, 10) and (14, -6)
3 2 7 7
Solution
(i) (-6, 1) and (-3, 2)
y 2 − y1 2 −1 1
The slope = = = .
x 2 − x1 −3 + 6 3
1 1 2 3
(ii) − , and ,
3 2 7 7 Progress Check
3 1 6−7
−
Fill the missing boxes
The slope = 7 2 = 14
2 1 6+7
+ S.No. Points Slope
7 3 21
1 A(–a, b), B(3a,–b)
1 21 3
=− × =− . 2 A(2, 3), B(_,_) 2
14 13 26
3 0
(iii) (14, 10) and (14, - 6)
4 undefined
−6 − 10 −16
The slope = = .
14 − 14 0
The slope is undefined.
Example 5.10 The line r passes through the points (–2, 2) and (5, 8) and the line s
passes through the points (–8, 7) and (–2, 0). Is the line r perpendicular to s ?
8−2 6
Solution The slope of line r is m1 = =
5+2 7
0−7 −7
The slope of line s is m2 = =
−2 + 8 6
6 −7
The product of slopes = × = −1
7 6
That is, m1m2 = −1
Therefore, the line r is perpendicular to line s.
Example 5.11 The line p passes through the points (3, - 2) , (12, 4) and the line q passes
through the points (6, - 2) and (12, 2) . Is p parallel to q ?
4+2 6 2
Solution The slope of line p is m1 = = =
12 − 3 9 3
2+2 4 2
The slope of line q is m2 = = =
12 − 6 6 3
Thus, slope of line p = slope of line q.
Therefore, line p is parallel to the line q.
Example 5.12 Show that the points (-2, 5) , (6, - 1) and (2, 2) are collinear.
Solution The vertices are A(-2, 5) , B(6, -1) and C(2, 2) .
− 1 − 5 −6 −3 Y
Slope of AB = = = 6
6+2 8 4 A
5
2 +1 3 −3 (–2,5)
Slope of BC = = = 4
2 − 6 −4 4 3
1+2 3
(ii) (a) Slope of BC = = = −3
5 − 6 −1
1+2 3
(b) Slope of AD = = =3
2 −1 1
Example 5.14 Consider the graph representing growth of population (in crores). Find
the slope of the line AB and hence estimate the population in the year 2030?
Y
Solution The points A(2005, 96) and B(2015, 100)
are on the line AB. 102
100 − 96 4 2
Slope of AB = = = 100
B(2015, 100)
k - 96 2 k − 96 2
= gives = 0
2030 - 2005 5 25 5 X′ 2005 2010 2015 2020 2025 X
Y¢ Year
k - 96 = 10 Fig. 5.24
k = 106
Hence the estimated population in 2030 = 106 Crores.
Example 5.15 Without using Pythagoras theorem, show that the points (1, - 4) , (2, - 3)
and (4, - 7) form a right angled triangle.
Solution Let the given points be A(1, - 4) , B(2, - 3) and C(4, - 7) .
−3 + 4 1
The slope of AB = = =1
2 −1 1
−7 + 3 −4
The slope of BC = = = −2
4−2 2
−7 + 4 −3
The slope of AC = = = −1
4 −1 3
Slope of AB ´ slope of AC = (1)(−1) = −1 Thinking Corner
AB is perpendicular to AC. ∠A = 90° Provide three examples of
using the concept of slope in
Therefore, D ABC is a right angled triangle.
real-life situations.
Example 5.16 Prove analytically that the line segment joining the mid-points of two sides
of a triangle is parallel to the third side and is equal to half of its length.
Solution Let P (a, b) Q(c, d ) and R(e, f ) be the vertices of a triangle.
Let S be the mid-point of PQ and T be the mid-point of PR
P(a,b)
a + c b + d a + e b + f
Therefore, S = , and T =
2 , 2
2 2
b + f b +d S
−
Now, slope of ST = 2 2 = f −d T
a +e a +c e −c
−
2 2 Q(c,d)
(e,f)
f −d Fig. 5.25
And slope of QR = R
e −c
Therefore, ST is parallel to QR. (since, their slopes are equal)
2 2 Note
a + e a + c b + f b + d
Also ST = − + −
2 2 2 2 ¾ This example
illustrates how a
1 geometrical result
= (e − c)2 + ( f − d )2
2 can be proved
1 using coordinate
ST = QR Geometry.
2
Thus ST is parallel to QR and half of it.
Exercise 5.2
1. What is the slope of a line whose inclination with positive direction of x -axis is
(i) 90 ° (ii) 0 °
2. What is the inclination of a line whose slope is (i) 0 (ii) 1
3. Find the slope of a line joining the points
( )
(i) 5, 5 with the origin (ii) (sin q, - cos q) and (- sin q, cos q)
4. What is the slope of a line perpendicular to the line joining A(5, 1) and P where P is
the mid-point of the segment joining (4, 2) and (-6, 4) .
5. Show that the given points are collinear: (-3, - 4) , (7, 2) and (12, 5)
6. If the three points (3, - 1) , (a, 3) and (1, - 3) are collinear, find the value of a.
1
7. The line through the points (-2, a ) and (9, 3) has slope - . Find the value of a.
2
8. The line through the points (-2, 6) and (4,8) is perpendicular to the line through the
points (8,12) and (x , 24) . Find the value of x.
9. Show that the given points form a right angled triangle and check whether they
satisfies pythagoras theorem
(i) A(1, - 4) , B(2, - 3) and C(4, - 7) (ii) L(0, 5) , M(9, 12) and N (3, 14)
Coordinate Geometry 217
(0,–2)
X′ 0 X
(X axis) is y = 0 (fig 5.28) (0,–3)
(0,–4)
Y¢
Y¢
Fig. 5.27
Fig. 5.28
Y
(1,b)
(2,b)
(3,b)
(4,b)
(5,b)
(0,b)
x=c
(c,–2)
¾ If c < 0 , then the line x=c lies left to the side of the Y axis (c,–3)
¾ If c = 0 , then the line x=c is the Y axis itself. (c,–4)
Y¢
Fig. 5.30
Example 5.17 Find the equation of a straight line passing
through (5,7) and is (i) parallel to X axis (ii) parallel to Y axis.
Solution (i) The equation of any straight line parallel to X axis is y=b.
Since it passes through (5,7), b = 7 .
Therefore, the required equation of the line is y=7.
(ii) The equation of any straight line parallel toY axis is x=c
Since it passes through (5,7), c = 5
Therefore, the required equation of the line is x=5.
Example 5.19 Calculate the slope and y intercept of the straight line 8x − 7y + 6 = 0
Solution Equation of the given straight line is 8x − 7y + 6 = 0
7y = 8x + 6 (bringing it to the form y = mx + c )
86 For, the point
y = x+ …(1) (x, y) in a xy plane, the
77
Comparing (1) with y = mx + c x coordinate x is called
“Abscissae” and the
8 6 y coordinate y is called
Slope m = and y intercept c = “Ordinate”.
7 7
Example 5.20 The graph relates temperatures y (in Fahrenheit degree) to temperatures x
(in Celsius degree) (a) Find the slope and y intercept (b) Write an equation of the line
(c) What is the mean temperature of the earth in Fahrenheit degree if its mean temperature
is 25° Celsius?
change in y coordinate 68 − 32 36 9
Solution (a) From the figure, slope = = = = = 1.8
change is x coordinate 20 − 0 20 5
The line crosses the Y axis at (0, 32) 80
Y
9 70 (20, 68)
So the slope is and y intercept is 32.
5 60
50
Fahrenheit
(b) Use the slope and y intercept to write an equation 40
9 30 (0, 32)
The equation is y = x + 32
5 20
slope m. 4
(y–y1)
3
A(x1, y1) q
Let P (x , y ) be any point other than A on the given 2
(x–x1)
line. Slope of the line joining A(x 1, y1 ) and P (x , y ) is given 1
q
by
y − y1 X ′ -1 0 1 2 3 4 5 6 7 8 X
m = tan q = Y′ M
x − x1
Fig. 5.32
220 10th Standard Mathematics
Example 5.22 Find the equation of a line passing through the point A(1, 4) and
perpendicular to the line joining points (2, 5) and (4, 7) .
Y
Solution 8
7 C
Let the given points be A(1, 4) , B(2, 5) and C (4, 7) . (4, 7)
6
7−5 2 B
5
Slope of line BC = = =1 90o (2, 5)
4−2 2 4 A(1, 4)
Let m be the slope of the required line. 3
2
Since the required line is perpendicular to BC,
1
m ´1 = −1
X′ -3 -2 -1 0 1 2 3 4 5 6 7 X
m = −1
Y′
The required line also pass through the point A(1,4). Fig. 5.33
The equation of the required straight line is y − y1 = m(x − x 1 )
y - 4 = −1(x − 1)
y - 4 = −x + 1
we get, x +y −5 = 0
Example 5.23 Find the equation of a straight line passing through (5, - 3) and (7, - 4) .
Solution The equation of a straight line passing through the two points (x 1, y1 ) and (x 2 , y2 ) is
Coordinate Geometry 221
y - y1 x − x1
=
y 2 - y1 x 2 − x1
The graet mathematical
Substituting the points we get, physicists like Galileo and Newton
y +3 x −5 used coordinate geometry to
=
−4 + 3 7−5 characterize the motions of
gives 2y + 6 = −x + 5 objects in plane and space.
Therefore, x + 2y + 1 = 0
y - y1 x − x1 y - 10 x −6
= gives =
y 2 - y1 x 2 − x1 12 - 10 14 − 6
y - 10 x −6
=
2 8
Therefore, x − 4y + 34 = 0
Example 5.25 Find the equation of a line which passes through (5,7) and makes intercepts
on the axes equal in magnitude but opposite in sign.
Solution Let the x intercept be ‘a’ and y intercept be ‘–a’.
x y
The equation of the line in intercept form is + =1
a b
x y
gives + = 1 (Here b = –a)
a −a
Therefore, x −y = a ...(1)
Since (1) passes through (5,7)
Therefore, 5 - 7 = a gives a = −2
Thus the required equation of the straight line is x − y = −2 ; or x − y + 2 = 0
Example 5.26 Find the intercepts made by the line 4x − 9y + 36 = 0 on the coordinate axes.
Solution Equation of the given line is 4x − 9y + 36 = 0
we write it as 4x - 9y = −36 (bringing it to the normal form)
x y
Dividing by -36 we get, + =1 ...(1)
−9 4
Comparing (1) with intercept form, we get x intercept a = −9 ; y intercept b = 4
Example 5.27 A mobile phone is put to use when the battery power is 100%. The percent
of battery power ‘y’ (in decimal) remaining after using the mobile phone for x hours is
assumed as y = −0.25x + 1
(i) Draw a graph of the equation.
60%
(ii) Find the number of hours elapsed if the battery power is 40%.
(iii) How much time does it take so that the battery has no power?
Solution Y 40%
(i) 1.25
Battery power
1.00 y
= Fig. 5.36
0.75 −
0.
25
0.50 x
+
0.25 1
X′ -3 -2 -1 0 1 2 3 4 5 6 7 X
Y¢ Hours
(ii) To find the time when the battery power is 40%, we have to take y = 0.40
0.40 = −0.25x + 1 gives 0.25x = 0.60
0.60
we get, x = = 2.4 hours.
0.25
(iii) If the battery power is 0 then y = 0
Therefore, 0 = −0.25x + 1 gives-0.25x = 1 hence x = 4 hours.
Thus, after 4 hours, the battery of the mobile phone will have no power.
Example 5.28 A line makes positive intercepts on coordinate axes whose sum is 7 and it
passes through (-3, 8) . Find its equation.
Solution If a and b are the intercepts then a + b = 7 or b = 7 − a
x y
By intercept form + =1 ...(1)
a b
x y
We have + =1
a 7 −a
As this line pass through the point (-3, 8) , we have
−3 8
+ = 1 gives –3(7–a) + 8a = a(7–a)
a 7 −a
−21 + 3a + 8a = 7a − a 2
So, a 2 + 4a − 21 = 0
Solving this equation (a − 3)(a + 7) = 0
a = 3 or a = −7
Since a is positive, we have a = 3 and b = 7–a = 7–3 =4.
x y
Hence + =1
3 4
Therefore, 4x + 3y − 12 = 0 is the required equation.
Y
Example 5.29 A circular garden is bounded 12
North Street
11
by East Avenue and Cross Road. Cross Road 10
A(3,10)
9
oa
sR
8
at E. AD is tangential to the circular garden at
os
Y
Cr
7
A(3, 10). Using the figure. 6 M(7,7)
D
5
(a) Find the equation of 4
Solution (a) (i) East Avenue is the straight line joining C(0, 2) and B(7, 2) . Thus the
equation of East Avenue is obtained by using two-point form which is
y −2 x −0
=
2−2 7−0
y −2 x
= gives y = 2
0 7
(ii) Since the point D lie vertically above C(0, 2) . The x coordinate of D is 0.
Since any point on North Street has x coordinate value 0.
The equation of North Street is x = 0
Therefore, D is (0, 6)
we get, 4q − 6 + 18 = 0
4q = −12 gives q = –3
Thus the Cross Road meets the North Street at D(0, 6) and
East Avenue at E (-3, 2) .
Activity 4
Y
6
5
If line l1 is perpendicular to line l2 and line l3 has
4
slope 3 then 3 A(0, 3)
2 l1
(i) find the equation of line l1 1 , 0) H
B(1
(ii) find the equation of line l2 X′ -1-1
0 1 2 3 4 5 6 7 8 9 X
E
-2 l2
(iii) find the equation of line l3 C(1,–2)
l3
-3 G(2, –3)
Y′
Fig. 5.38
Activity 5
A ladder is placed against a vertical wall with its foot touching the horizontal floor. Find
the equation of the ladder under the following conditions.
Exercise 5.3
1. F
ind the equation of a straight line passing through the mid-point of a line segment
joining the points (1, - 5) , (4,2) and parallel to (i) X axis (ii) Y axis
2. The equation of a straight line is 2(x − y ) + 5 = 0 . Find its slope, inclination and
intercept on the Y axis.
3. F
ind the equation of a line whose inclination is 30˚ and making an intercept -3 on
the Y axis.
4. Find the slope and y intercept of 3x + (1 − 3 )y = 3 .
5. Find the value of ‘a’, if the line through (–2,3) and (8,5) is perpendicular to y = ax + 2
6. T
he hill in the form of a right triangle has its foot at (19, 3) . The inclination of the hill
to the ground is 45˚. Find the equation of the hill joining the foot and top.
7. Find the equation of a line through the given pair of points
2 −1
(i) 2, and , − 2 (ii) (2, 3) and (-7, - 1)
3 2
8. A
cat is located at the point (-6, - 4) in xy plane. A bottle of milk is kept at (5, 11) .
The cat wish to consume the milk travelling through shortest possible distance. Find
the equation of the path it needs to take its milk.
9. F
ind the equation of the median and altitude of DABC through A where the vertices
are A(6, 2) , B(-5, - 1) and C(1, 9)
-5
10. Find the equation of a straight line which has slope and passing through the
4
point (–1,2).
11. You are downloading a song. The percent y (in decimal form) of mega bytes
remaining to get downloaded in x seconds is given by y = −0.1x + 1 .
(i) graph the equation.
(ii) find the total MB of the song.
(iii) after how many seconds will 75% of the song gets downloaded?
(iv) after how many seconds the song will be downloaded completely?
12. Find the equation of a line whose intercepts on the x and y axes are given below.
3
(i) 4, –6 (ii) -5,
4
13. Find the intercepts made by the following lines on the coordinate axes.
(i) 3x − 2y − 6 = 0 (ii) 4x + 3y + 12 = 0
Two straight lines a1x + b1y + c1 = 0 and a2x + b2y + c2 = 0 where the coefficients
are non-zero, are a b
(i) parallel if and only if 1 = 1 ; That is, a1b2 − a2b1 = 0
a2 b2
(ii) perpendicular if and only if a1a2 + b1b2 = 0
Parallel or Parallel or
No. Equations S.No. Equations
perpendicular perpendicular
5x + 2y + 5 = 0 8x − 10y + 11 = 0
1 3
5x + 2y − 3 = 0 4x–5y+16 = 0
3x − 7y − 6 = 0 2y − 9x − 7 = 0
2 4
7x + 3y + 8 = 0 27y + 6x − 21 = 0
Example 5.36 Find the equation of a straight line parallel to Y axis and passing through
the point of intersection of the lines 4x + 5y = 13 and x − 8y + 9 = 0 .
Solution Given lines 4x + 5y − 13 = 0 ...(1)
x − 8y + 9 = 0 ...(2)
To find the point of intersection, solve equation (1) and (2)
x y 1
5 -13 4 5
-8 9 1 -8
x y 1
= =
45 - 104 −13 − 36 −32 − 5
x y 1
= =
-59 −49 −37
59 49
x= , y=
37 37
59 49
Therefore, the point of intersection (x , y ) = ,
37 37
The equation of line parallel to Y axis is x = c.
59 49 59
It passes through (x , y ) = , . Therefore, c = .
37 37 37
59
The equation of the line is x = gives 37x − 59 = 0
37
Example 5.37 The line joining the points A(0, 5) and B(4, 1) is a tangent to a circle whose
centre C is at the point (4, 4) find
(i) the equation of the line AB.
(ii) the equation of the line through C which is perpendicular to the line AB.
(iii) the coordinates of the point of contact of tangent line AB with the circle.
Solution (i) Equation of line AB, A(0, 5) and B(4, 1) 6
Y
5)
y - y1 x − x1 5 A(0,
=
y 2 - y1 x 2 − x1 4 C (4,4)
3
y -5 x −0 2 P
=
1-5 4−0 1 (4, 1)
B
4(y - 5) = −4x gives y –5 = – x
X′ -1 0 1 2 3 4 5 6 7 8 X
-1
x + y – 5 =0
-2
Y¢
(ii) The equation of a line which is perpendicular Fig. 5.40
to the line AB : x + y − 5 = 0 is x − y + k = 0
Since it is passing through the point (4,4), we have
4 – 4 + k = 0 gives k = 0
The equation of a line which is perpendicular to AB and through C is x − y = 0 ...(2)
Coordinate Geometry 231
(iii) The coordinate of the point of contact P of the tangent line AB with the circle is
Activity 6
Find the equation of a straight line for the given diagrams
Y Y
6 3
5 2
4 Slope = 2 1
3 3
X′ -5 04 03 -2 -1 0 1 2 3 4 5 X
2 -1
1 -2
-3 (4, –4)
X′ -2 -1 0 1 2 3 4 5 6 7 X
-1 -4
-2 -5
Y¢ Y¢
Y Y
6 3
5 2
4 Slope = 2 1
3
3
(4, –3) X′ -5 04 03 -2 -1-10 1 2 3 4 5 X
2
1 -2
-3
X′ -3 -2 -1 0 1 2 3 4 5 6 7 X
-1 -4
-2 -5
Y¢ Y¢
Fig. 5.41
Exercise 5.4
3
1. Find the slope of the following straight lines (i) 5y − 3 = 0 (ii) 7x − =0
17
2. Find the slope of the line which is
(i) parallel to y = 0.7x − 11 (ii) perpendicular to the line x = −11
3. Check whether the given lines are parellel or perpendicular
x y 1 2x y 1
(i) + + = 0 and + + =0
3 4 7 3 2 10
(ii) 5x + 23y + 14 = 0 and 23x − 5y + 9 = 0
232 10th Standard Mathematics
4. If the straight lines 12y = −(p + 3)x + 12 , 12x − 7y = 16 are perpendicular then find ‘p’.
5. Find the equation of a straight line passing through the point P(-5, 2) and parallel to
the line joining the points Q(3, - 2) and R(-5, 4) .
6. Find the equation of a line passing through (6,–2) and perpendicular to the line
joining the points (6,7) and (2,–3).
7. A(-3, 0) B(10, - 2) and C(12, 3) are the vertices of DABC . Find the equation of the
altitude through A and B.
8. Find the equation of the perpendicular bisector of the line joining the points
A(-4, 2) and B(6, - 4) .
9. Find the equation of a straight line through the intersection of lines 7x + 3y = 10 ,
5x − 4y = 1 and parallel to the line 13x + 5y + 12 = 0
10. Find the equation of a straight line through the intersection of lines 5x − 6y = 2 ,
3x + 2y = 10 and perpendicular to the line 4x − 7y + 13 = 0
11. Find the equation of a straight line joining the point of intersection of 3x + y + 2 = 0
and x − 2y − 4 = 0 to the point of intersection of 7x − 3y = −12 and 2y = x + 3
12. Find the equation of a straight line through the point of intersection of the lines 8x + 3y = 18 ,
4x + 5y = 9 and bisecting the line segment joining the points (5,–4) and (–7,6).
Exercise 5.5
1. The area of triangle formed by the points (−5,0) , (0,−5) and (5,0) is
(1) 0 sq.units (2) 25 sq.units (3) 5 sq.units (4) none of these
2. A man walks near a wall, such that the distance between him and the wall is 10 units.
Consider the wall to be the Y axis. The path travelled by the man is
(1) x = 10 (2) y = 10 (3) x = 0 (4) y = 0
3. The straight line given by the equation x = 11 is
(1) parallel to X axis (2) parallel to Y axis
(3) passing through the origin (4) passing through the point (0,11)
4. If (5,7), (3,p) and (6,6) are collinear, then the value of p is
(1) 3 (2) 6 (3) 9 (4) 12
5. The point of intersection of 3x − y = 4 and x + y = 8 is
(1) (5,3) (2) (2,4) (3) (3,5) (4) (4,4)
1
6. The slope of the line joining (12, 3) , (4, a ) is . The value of ‘a’ is
8
(1) 1 (2) 4 (3) -5 (4) 2
Coordinate Geometry 233
7. The slope of the line which is perpendicular to a line joining the points (0,0) and
(–8,8) is
1
(1) –1 (2) 1 (3) (4) -8
3
1
8. If slope of the line PQ is then slope of the perpendicular bisector of PQ is
3
1
(1) 3 (2) - 3 (3) (4) 0
3
9. If A is a point on the Y axis whose ordinate is 8 and B is a point on the X axis whose
abscissae is 5 then the equation of the line AB is
(1) 8x + 5y = 40 (2) 8x − 5y = 40 (3) x = 8 (4) y = 5
10. The equation of a line passing through the origin and perpendicular to the line
7x − 3y + 4 = 0 is
(1) 7x − 3y + 4 = 0 (2) 3x − 7y + 4 = 0 (3) 3x + 7y = 0 (4) 7x − 3y = 0
11. Consider four straight lines
(i) l1 : 3y = 4x + 5 (ii) l2 : 4y = 3x − 1 (iii) l 3 : 4y + 3x = 7 (iv) l 4 : 4x + 3y = 2
Which of the following statement is true ?
(1) l1 and l2 are perpendicular (2) l1 and l 4 are parallel
(3) l2 and l 4 are perpendicular (4) l2 and l 3 are parallel
12. A straight line has equation 8y = 4x + 21 . Which of the following is true
(1) The slope is 0.5 and the y intercept is 2.6
(2) The slope is 5 and the y intercept is 1.6
(3) The slope is 0.5 and the y intercept is 1.6
(4) The slope is 5 and the y intercept is 2.6
13. When proving that a quadrilateral is a trapezium, it is necessary to show
(1) Two sides are parallel.
(2) Two parallel and two non-parallel sides.
(3) Opposite sides are parallel.
(4) All sides are of equal length.
14. When proving that a quadrilateral is a parallelogram by using slopes you must find
(1) The slopes of two sides
(2) The slopes of two pair of opposite sides
(3) The lengths of all sides
(4) Both the lengths and slopes of two sides
15. (2, 1) is the point of intersection of two lines.
(1) x − y − 3 = 0; 3x − y − 7 = 0 (2) x + y = 3; 3x + y = 7
(3) 3x + y = 3; x + y = 7 (4) x + 3y − 3 = 0; x − y − 7 = 0
Unit Exercise - 5
1. PQRS is a rectangle formed by joining the points P(-1, -1) , Q(-1, 4) , R(5, 4) and
S(5, -1) . A, B, C and D are the mid-points of PQ, QR, RS and SP respectively. Is
the quadrilateral ABCD a square, a rectangle or a rhombus? Justify your answer.
2. The area of a triangle is 5 sq.units. Two of its vertices are (2,1) and (3, –2). The
third vertex is (x, y) where y = x + 3 . Find the coordinates of the third vertex.
3. Find the area of a triangle formed by the lines 3x + y − 2 = 0 , 5x + 2y − 3 = 0 and
2x − y − 3 = 0
4. I f vertices of a quadrilateral are at A(-5, 7) , B(-4, k ) , C(-1, -6) and D(4, 5) and its
area is 72 sq.units. Find the value of k.
5. Without using distance formula, show that the points (-2, -1) , (4, 0) , (3, 3) and (-3, 2)
are vertices of a parallelogram.
6. Find the equations of the lines, whose sum and product of intercepts are 1 and –6
respectively.
7. The owner of a milk store finds that, he can sell 980 litres of milk each week at
₹14/litre and 1220 litres of milk each week at ₹16/litre. Assuming a linear relationship
between selling price and demand, how many litres could he sell weekly at ₹17/litre?
8. Find the image of the point (3,8) with respect to the line x + 3y = 7 assuming the
line to be a plane mirror.
9. Find the equation of a line passing through the point of intersection of the lines
4x + 7y − 3 = 0 and 2x − 3y + 1 = 0 that has equal intercepts on the axes.
10. A person standing at a junction (crossing) of two straight paths represented by the
equations 2x − 3y + 4 = 0 and 3x + 4y − 5 = 0 seek to reach the path whose equation
is 6x − 7y + 8 = 0 in the least time. Find the equation of the path that he should follow.
Points to Remember
zz The area of a triangle formed by the points (x 1, y1 ) , (x 2 , y2 ) and (x 3 , y 3 ) is
1
{(x y + x 2y3 + x 3y1 ) − (x 2y1 + x 3y2 + x1y3 )} sq.units
2 1 2
zz Three points A(x 1, y1 ) , B(x 2 , y2 ) and C (x 3 , y 3 ) are collinear if and only if
(i) area of ∆ABC = 0 or x 1y2 + x 2y 3 + x 3y1 = x 2y1 + x 3y2 + x 1y 3
(ii) slope of AB=slope of BC or slope of AC
zz The area of a quadrilateral formed by the four points (x 1, y1 ) , (x 2 , y2 ) , (x 3 , y 3 ) and
1
(x 4 , y 4 ) is{(x y + x 2y3 + x 3y4 + x 4y1 ) − (x 2y1 + x 3y2 + x 4y3 + x1y4 )} sq.units.
2 1 2
zz If a line makes an angle q with the positive direction of X axis, then its slope
m = tan q .
y - y1
zz If A(x 1, y1 ), B(x 2 , y2 ) are two distinct points then the slope of AB is 2 .
x 2 - x1
−a
zz Slope of line ax + by + c = 0 is m = .
b
y − y1 x − x1
= Two point form
y 2 − y1 x 2 − x1
zz Two straight lines are parallel if and only if their slopes are equal.
zz Two straight lines with well defined slopes m1 , m2 are perpendicular if and only if
m1 × m2 = −1.
ICT CORNER
ICT 5.1
Step 1: Open the Browser type the URL Link given below (or) Scan the QR Code. GeoGebra work book named
“Co-Ordinate Geometry” will open. In the left side of the work book there are many activity related to mensuration
chapter. Select the work sheet “Area of a Quadrilateral”
Step 2: In the given worksheet you can change the Question by clicking on “New Problem”. Move the slider to see the steps.
Work out each problem and verify your answer.
ICT 5.2
Step 1: Open the Browser type the URL Link given below (or) Scan the QR Code. GeoGebra work book named
“Co-Ordinate Geometry” will open. In the left side of the work book there are many activity related to mensuration
chapter. Select the work sheet “Slope_Equation of a Straight Line”
Step 2: In the given worksheet you can change the Line by Dragging the points A and B on graph. Click on the Check boxes
on Left Hand Side to see various forms of same straight line.
Step 1 Step 2 Expected results
6
TRIGONOMETRY
“The deep study of nature is the most fruitful source of
mathematical discoveries” - Joseph Fourier.
Learning Outcomes
z To recall trigonometric ratios.
z To recall fundamental relations between the
trigonometric ratios of an angle.
z To recall trigonometric ratios of complementary angles.
z To understand trigonometric identities.
z To know methods of solving problems concerning heights and distances
of various objects.
6.1 Introduction
From very ancient times surveyors, navigators and astronomers have made use of
triangles to determine distances that could not be measured directly. This gave birth to
the branch of mathematics what we call today as “Trigonometry”.
Hipparchus of Rhodes around 200 BC(BCE), constructed a table of chord lengths for
a circle of circumference 360 × 60 = 21600 units which corresponds to one unit of
circumference for each minute of arc. For this achievement, Hipparchus is considered as
“The Father of Trigonometry” since it became the basis for further development.
Trigonometry 237
Indian scholars of the 5th century AD(CE), realized that working with half-chords
for half-angles greatly simplified the theory of chords and its application to astronomy.
Mathematicians like Aryabhata, the two Bhaskaras and several others developed
astonishingly sophisticated techniques for calculating half-chord (Jya) values.
Mathematician Abu Al-Wafa of Baghdad believed to have invented the tangent
function, which he called the “Shadow”. Arabic scholars did not know how to translate
the word Jya, into their texts and simply wrote jiba as a close approximate word.
Misinterpreting the Arabic word ‘jiba’ for ‘cove’ or ‘bay’, translators wrote the Arabic
word ‘jiba’ as ‘sinus’ in Latin to represent the half-chord. From this, we have the name ‘sine’
used to this day. The word “Trigonometry” itself was invented by German mathematician
Bartholomaeus Pitiscus in the beginning of 17th century AD(CE).
Recall
Trigonometric Ratios
Let 0° < q < 90°
P Let us take right triangle OMP
Hy
Opposite side
p ot Opposite side MP
en
us sin q = =
e Hypotenuse OP
q Adjacent side OM
M O
cos q = =
Adjacent Side Hypotenuse OP
Fig. 6.1
From the above two ratios we can obtain other four trigonometric ratios as follows.
Note
sin q cos q
tan q = ; cot q = ; ¾¾ All right triangles with q as one of the angle are
cos q sin q
similar. Hence the trigonometric ratios defined
1 1
cosecq = ; sec q = through such right angle triangles do not depend
sin q cosq on the triangle chosen.
Complementary angle
sin(90° − q) = cos q cos(90° − q) = sin q tan(90° − q) = cot q
cosec(90° − q) = sec q sec(90° − q) = cosec q cot(90° − q) = tan q
But OQ = radius = 1
Therefore OP = OQ cos q = cos q
Y
PQ
Similarly, = sin θ
OQ R Q
Gives, PQ = OQ sin q = sin q (since OQ = 1)
1
OP = cosθ, PQ = sinθ … (1)
q
°−
90
Now, from triangle QOR, q
X′ O P X
OR
we have = cos(90° − q)
OQ Y′
Fig. 6.2
Therefore, OR = OQ cos(90° − q)
So, OR = cos(90° − q)
RQ
Similarly, = sin(90° − q)
OQ
Then, RQ = sin(90° − q)
OR = cos(90° − q) , RQ = sin(90° − q) … (2)
Since OPQR is a rectangle, Note
sin(90° − q) = cos q and cos(90° − q) = sin q (tan q)2 = tan2 q (cot q)2 = cot2 q
Trigonometry 239
Thinking Corner
1. When will the values of sin q and cosq be equal?
3. A mong the six trigonometric quantities, as the value of angle increase from
0° to 90° , which of the six trigonometric quantities has undefined values?
(i) sin q > cos q (ii) cos q > sin q (iii) sec q = 2 tan q (iv) cosec q = 2 cot q
(i) sin2q + cos2 q=1 (ii) 1+tan2q = sec2 q (iii) 1 + cot2 q = cosec2q
OM PM
= cos q, = sin q ...(1)
OP OP
By Pythagoras theorem
P
MP 2 + OM 2 = OP 2 ...(2)
q
MP 2 OM 2 OP 2
M O + =
OP 2 OP 2 OP 2
Fig. 6.3 2 2
MP OM OP
2
Gives, + =
OP OP OP
From (1), (sin q)2 + (cos q)2 = 12
Note
¾¾ Though the above identities are true for any angle q , we will consider the six
trigonometric ratios only for 0° < q < 90°
Trigonometry 241
Activity 1
Take a white sheet of paper. Construct two perpendicular lines OX, OY which
meet at O, as shown in the Fig. 6.4(a).
Y
Considering OX as X axis, OY as Y axis.
We will verify the values of sin q and cos q for
certain angles q .
Let q = 30°
Construct a line segment OA of any length such
that ∠AOX = 30°, as shown in the Fig. 6.4(b). O X
Fig. 6.4(a)
Draw a perpendicular from A to OX, meeting at B.
Now using scale, measure the lengths of AB, OB and OA.
Y
AB OB AB
Find the ratios , and .
OA OA OB A
1 + cos q
Example 6.5 Prove that = cosec q + cot q
1 − cos q
1 + cos q 1 + cos q 1 + cos q
Solution = × [multiply numerator and denominator
1 − cos q 1 − cos q 1 + cos q
by the conjugate of 1 - cos q ]
(1 + cos q)2 1 + cos q since sin2 q + cos2 q = 1
= =
1 − cos2 q 2
sin q
1 + cos q
= = cosec q +cotq
sin q
sec q sin q
Example 6.6 Prove that − = cot q
sin q cos q
1
sec q sin q sin q 1 sin q
Solution - = cos q − = −
sin q cos q sin q cos q sin q cos q cos q
1 − sin2 q cos2 q
= = = cot q
sin q cos q sin q cos q
Example 6.7 Prove that sin2 A cos2 B + cos2 A sin2 B + cos2 A cos2 B + sin2 A sin2 B = 1
Solution sin2 A cos2 B + cos2 A sin2 B + cos2 A cos2 B + sin2 A sin2 B
= sin2 A cos2 B + sin2 A sin2 B + cos2 A sin2 B + cos2 A cos2 B
= sin2 A + cos2 A = 1
Example 6.8 If cos q + sin q = 2 cos q , then prove that cos q − sin q = 2 sin q
Solution Now, cos q + sin q = 2 cos q .
Squaring both sides,
(cos q + sin q)2 = ( 2 cos q)2
Trigonometry 243
= 2 sin q
Therefore cos q − sin q = 2 sin q .
Example 6.9 Prove that (cosec q − sin q)(sec q − cos q)(tan q + cot q) =1
Solution (cosec q − sin q)(sec q − cos q)(tan q + cot q)
1 1 sin q cos q
= − sin q − cos q +
sin q cos q cos q sin q
P2 −1
2 cot q = ...(4)
P
2 cot q P2 −1 P P2 −1
Dividing (4) by (3) we get, = × 2 gives, cos q = 2
2 cosec q P P +1 P +1
sin2 A − sin2 B
Example 6.12 Prove that tan A − tan B = 2 2
cos2 A cos2 B
2 2
sin A sin B
Solution tan2 A − tan2 B = −
cos2 A cos2 B
sin2 A cos2 B − sin2 B cos2 A
=
cos2 A cos2 B
sin2 A(1 − sin2 B ) − sin2 B (1 − sin2 A)
=
cos2 A cos2 B
sin2 A − sin2 A sin2 B − sin2 B + sin2 A sin2 B sin2 A − sin2 B
= =
cos2 A cos2 B cos2 A cos2 B
sin A cos ecA+ sin A cot A − sin A + cos A sec A + cos A tan A − cos A
=
(sec A + tan A − 1)(cos ecA+ cot A − 1)
Trigonometry 245
2
=
1 + sin A − cos A 1 + cos A − sin A
cos A sin A
2 sin A cos A
=
(1 + sin A − cos A)(1 + cos A − sin A)
1 + tan2 A 1 − tan A 2
Example 6.15 Show that =
1 + cot2 A 1 − cot A
Solution
LHS RHS
2
1 − tan A
2
1 + tan2 A 1 + tan2 A
1 − tan A
=
1 + cot2 A = 1 − cot A 1
1+ 1 1 −
tan2 A tan A
2
1 + tan2 A 1 − tan A
= = tan2 A ... (1) = = (− tan A)2 = tan2 A ... (2)
2
tan A + 1 tan A − 1
tan2 A tan A
1 + tan2 A 1 − tan A 2
From (1) and (2), =
1 + cot A 1 − cot A
2
sin A cos A
(sin A cos A + 1) −
sin A cos A sin A cos A
=
sin2 A + sin A cos A + cos2 A
(sec A − cossecA)
sin2 A cos2 A
(sin A cos A + 1)(sec A − cos ecA)
= × sin2 A cos2 A = sin2 A cos2 A
(sec A − cos ecA)(1 + sin A cos A)
cos2 q sin2 q
Example 6.17 If = p and = q , then prove that p 2q 2 (p 2 + q 2 + 3) = 1
sin q cos q
2
cos q sin2 q
Solution We have = p ...(1) and = q ...(2)
sin q cos q
cos2 q sin2 q cos2 q sin2 q
2 2 2 2
p q (p + q + 3) =
2 2 2 2 × + + 3 [from (1) and (2)]
sin q cos q sin q cos q
cos q sin q cos q sin q
4 4 4 4
= 2 2 × 2 + + 3
sin q cos q sin q cos q
2
cos6 q + sin6 q + 3 sin2 q cos2 q
= (cos2 q × sin2 q) ×
2 2
sin q cos q
6 6 2 2
= cos q + sin q + 3 sin q cos q
= (cos2 q)3 + (sin2 q)3 + 3 sin2 q cos2 q
= [(cos2 q + sin2 q)3 − 3 cos2 q sin2 q(cos2 q + sin2 q)] + 3 sin2 q cos2 q
= 1 − 3 cos2 q sin2 q(1) + 3 cos2 q sin2 q = 1
Progress Check
Exercise 6.1
(ii) (sin q + sec q)2 + (cos q + cosec q)2 = 1 + (sec q + cosec q)2
9. (i) If sin q + cos q = p and sec q + cosec q = q , then prove that q(p 2 − 1) = 2p
(ii) If sin q(1 + sin2 q) = cos2 q , then prove that cos6 q − 4 cos4 q + 8 cos2 q = 4
cos q 1 a2 − 1
10. If = , then prove that 2 = sin q
1 + sin q a a +1
Theodolite
Theodolite is an instrument which is used in measuring the angle
between an object and the eye of the observer. A theodolite consists of two
graduated wheels placed at right angles to each other and a telescope. The
wheels are used for the measurement of horizontal and vertical angles. The
angle to the desired point is measured by positioning the telescope towards Fig. 6.6
that point. The angle can be read on the telescope scale.
Object
O Angle of Elevation
Eye of the observer
Clinometer
The angle of elevation and depression are usually
measured by a device called clinometer.
h1
h2
a b
C B
a b d2
B C d1
Trigonometry 249
Activity 2
Representation of situations through right triangles. Draw a figure to illustrate the
situation.
Situations Draw a figure
A
C
Example 6.18
Calculate the size of ÐBAC in the given
8 cm
4 cm
triangles.
qo
Solution B A
qo
5 cm B 3 cm A
Fig. 6.12(a) Fig. 6.12(b)
(i) In right triangle ABC [see Fig.6.12(a)] (ii) In right triangle ABC [see Fig.6.12(b)]
opposite side 4 8
tan q = = tan q =
adjacent side 5 3
4 8
q = tan−1 = tan−1(0.8) q = tan−1 = tan−1(2.66)
5 3
q = 38.7° (since tan 38.7° = 0.8011) q = 69.4° (since tan 69.4° = 2.6604)
ÐBAC = 38.7° ∠BAC = 69.4°
250 10th Standard Mathematics
Example 6.19 A tower stands vertically on the ground. From a point on the ground,
which is 48 m away from the foot of the tower, the angle of elevation of the top of the tower
is 30° . Find the height of the tower.
Example 6.20 A kite is flying at a height of 75 m above the ground. The string attached
to the kite is temporarily tied to a point on the ground. The inclination of the string
with the ground is 60° . Find the length of the string, assuming that there is no slack
in the string.
Solution Let AB be the height of the kite above the ground. Then, AB = 75.
Let AC be the length of the string. A
In right triangle ABC, ∠ACB = 60°
AB
sin q =
AC
stri
75 m
75
ng
sin 60° =
AC
3 75 150
gives = so, AC = = 50 3
2 AC 3 60°
Hence, the length of the string is 50 3 m. B Fig. 6.14 C
Example 6.21 Two ships are sailing in the sea on either sides of a lighthouse. The
angle of elevation of the top of the lighthouse as observed from the ships are 30° and
45° respectively. If the lighthouse is 200 m high, find the distance between the two
ships. ( 3 = 1.732 )
B
Solution Let AB be the
lighthouse. Let C and D be the
200m
Trigonometry 251
AB
In right triangle BAC, tan 30° =
AC
1 200
= gives AC = 200 3 ...(1)
3 AC
AB
In right triangle BAD, tan 45° =
AD
200
1= gives AD = 200 ...(2)
AD
Now, CD = AC + AD = 200 3 + 200 [by (1) and (2)]
Example 6.22 From a point on the ground, the angles of elevation of the bottom and top
of a tower fixed at the top of a 30 m high building are 45° and 60° respectively. Find the
height of the tower. ( 3 = 1.732)
C
Solution Let AC be the height of the tower.
Let AB be the height of the building.
h
Then, AC = h metres, AB = 30 m
In right triangle CBP, ∠CPB = 60° A
BC
tan q =
BP
30m
AB + AC 30 + h
tan 60° = so, 3= ...(1)
BP BP
60o
In right triangle ABP, ∠APB = 45° 45o
B P
AB
tan q =
Fig. 6.16
BP
30
tan 45° = gives BP = 30 ...(2)
BP
30 + h
Substituting (2) in (1), we get 3=
30
h = 30( 3 − 1) = 30(1.732 − 1) = 30(0.732) = 21.96
Example 6.23 A TV tower stands vertically on a bank of a canal. The tower is watched
from a point on the other bank directly opposite to it. The angle of elevation of the top of
the tower is 58° . From another point 20 m away from this point on the line joining this
point to the foot of the tower, the angle of elevation of the top of the tower is 30° . Find the
height of the tower and the width of the canal. (tan 58° = 1.6003)
252 10th Standard Mathematics
Solution A
TV Tower
CD = 20 m.
AB AB
In right triangle ABD, tan 30° = =
BD BC + CD
1 AB
= ...(2)
3 BC + 20
1.6003 BC + 20
Dividing (1) by (2) we get, =
1 BC
3
20
BC = = 11.24 m ...(3)
1.7791
AB
1.6003 = [from (1) and (3)]
11.24
AB = 17.99
Hence, the height of the tower is 17.99 m and the width of the canal is 11.24 m .
Example 6.24 An aeroplane sets off from G on a bearing of 24° towards H, a point
250 km away. At H it changes course and heads towards J on a bearing of 55° and a
distance of 180 km away.
(i) How far is H to the North of G? (ii) How far is H to the East of G?
(iii) How far is J to the North of H? (iv) How far is J to the East of H?
sin 24° = 0.4067 sin 11° = 0.1908
cos 24° = 0.9135
N
Trigonometry 253
G
(iii) In right triangle HIJ,
Fig. 6.18 (b)
IJ
sin 11° =
HJ
IJ
0.1908 = ; IJ = 34.34 km
180
Distance of J to the North of H = 34.34 km
Example 6.25 Two trees are standing on flat ground. The angle of elevation of the top of
both the trees from a point X on the ground is 40° . If the horizontal distance between X
and the smaller tree is 8 m and the distance of the top of the two trees is 20 m, calculate
(i) the distance between the point X and the top of the smaller tree.
(ii) the horizontal distance between the two trees.
(cos 40° = 0.7660)
Solution Let AB be the height of the bigger tree and CD be the height of the smaller tree
and X is the point on the ground.
B
CX
(i) In right triangle XCD, cos 40° =
XD
8
XD = =10.44 m 20
0.7660 m
AC + 8
0.7660 = gives AC = 23.32 − 8 = 15.32 m
20 + 10.44
Therefore the horizontal distance between two trees = AC = 15.32 m
Thinking Corner
1. What type of triangle is used to calculate heights and distances?
2. When the height of the building and distances from the foot of the building is
given, which trigonometric ratio is used to find the angle of elevation?
3. If the line of sight and angle of elevation is given, then which trigonometric ratio
is used
(i) to find the height of the building
(ii) to find the distance from the foot of the building.
Exercise 6.2
1. Find the angle of elevation of the top of a tower from a point on the ground, which
is 30 m away from the foot of a tower of height 10 3 m.
2. A road is flanked on either side by continuous rows of houses of height 4 3 m with no
space in between them. A pedestrian is standing on the median of the road facing a row
house. The angle of elevation from the pedestrian to the top of the house is 30° . Find the
width of the road.
3. To a man standing outside his house, the angles of elevation of the top and bottom
of a window are 60° and 45° respectively. If the height of the man is 180 cm and if he
is 5 m away from the wall, what is the height of the window? ( 3 = 1.732)
4. A statue 1.6 m tall stands on the top of a pedestal. From a point on the ground, the
angle of elevation of the top of the statue is 60° and from the same point the angle of
elevation of the top of the pedestal is 40° . Find the height of the pedestal.
(tan 40° = 0.8391, 3 = 1.732)
6. The top of a 15 m high tower makes an angle of elevation of 60° with the bottom of
an electronic pole and angle of elevation of 30° with the top of the pole. What is the
height of the electric pole?
7. A vertical pole fixed to the ground is divided in the ratio 1:9 by a mark on it with
lower part shorter than the upper part. If the two parts subtend equal angles at a
place on the ground, 25 m away from the base of the pole, what is the height of the
pole?
tan 60° =
AB
20
3 =
x 60o
20 × 3 20 × 1.732 A x B
x = = = 11.54 m
3× 3 3 Fig. 6.21
Hence, the distance between the foot of the tower and the ball is 11.54 m.
Example 6.27 The horizontal distance between two buildings is 140 m. The angle of
depression of the top of the first building when seen from the top of the second building
is 30° . If the height of the first building is 60 m, find the height of the second building.
( 3 = 1.732)
Example 6.28 From the top of a tower 50 m high, the angles of depression of the top and
bottom of a tree are observed to be 30° and 45° respectively. Find the height of the tree.
( 3 = 1.732)
Solution The height of the tower AB = 50 m
Let the height of the tree CD = y and BD = x
From the diagram, ∠XAC = 30° = ∠ACM and ∠XAD = 45° = ∠ADB
1=
x 30o
C
In right triangle AMC, M
AM
tan 30° = y
CM 45o
D x B
1 AM
= [since DB = CM]
3 50 Fig. 6.23
Trigonometry 257
50 50 3 50 × 1.732
AM = = = = 28.85 m.
3 3 3
Therefore, height of the tree = CD = MB = AB − AM = 50 − 28.85 = 21.15 m
Example 6.29 As observed from the top of a 60 m high light house from the sea level,
the angles of depression of two ships are 28° and 45° . If one ship is exactly behind the
other on the same side of the lighthouse, find the distance between the two ships.
(tan 28° =0.5317) D X
28o
Solution Let the observer on the 45o
lighthouse CD be at D.
Height of the lighthouse CD = 60 m
60 m
From the diagram,
∠XDA = 28° = ∠DAC and
45o 28o
∠XDB = 45° = ∠DBC C B A
Fig. 6.24
DC
In right triangle DCB, tan 45° =
BC
60
1 = gives BC = 60 m
BC
DC
In right triangle DCA, tan 28° =
AC
60 60
0.5317 = gives AC = = 112.85
AC 0.5317
Distance between the two ships AB = AC − BC = 52.85 m
Example 6.30 A man is watching a boat speeding away from the top of a tower. The boat
makes an angle of depression of 60° with the man’s eye when at a distance of 200 m from
the tower. After 10 seconds, the angle of depression becomes 45°. What is the approximate
speed of the boat (in km / hr), assuming that it is sailing in still water? ( 3 = 1.732)
Solution Let AB be the tower.
X A
Let C and D be the positions of the boat. 45o
60o
From the diagram,
∠XAC = 60° = ∠ACB and
∠XAD = 45° = ∠ADB , BC = 200 m
AB
In right triangle ABC, tan 60° =
BC 45o 60o
AB
gives 3= D C 200m B
200 Fig. 6.25
we get AB = 200 3 ...(1)
258 10th Standard Mathematics
AB
In right triangle ABD, tan 45° =
BD
200 3
gives 1= [by (1)]
BD
we get, BD = 200 3
Now, CD = BD − BC
Exercise 6.3
1. From the top of a rock 50 3 m high, the angle of depression of a car on the ground
is observed to be 30°. Find the distance of the car from the rock.
2. The horizontal distance between two buildings is 70 m. The angle of depression of
the top of the first building when seen from the top of the second building is 45°. If
the height of the second building is 120 m, find the height of the first building.
3. From the top of the tower 60 m high the angles of depression of the top and bottom
of a vertical lamp post are observed to be 38° and 60° respectively. Find the height of
the lamp post. (tan 38° = 0.7813, 3 = 1.732)
4. An aeroplane at an altitude of 1800 m finds that two boats are sailing towards it in
the same direction. The angles of depression of the boats as observed from the
aeroplane are 60° and 30° respectively. Find the distance between the two boats.
( 3 = 1.732)
5. From the top of a lighthouse, the angle of depression of two ships on the opposite
sides of it are observed to be 30° and 60°. If the height of the lighthouse is h meters
and the line joining the ships passes through the foot of the lighthouse, show that the
4h
distance between the ships is m.
3
6. A lift in a building of height 90 feet with transparent glass walls is descending from
the top of the building. At the top of the building, the angle of depression to a fountain
in the garden is 60°. Two minutes later, the angle of depression reduces to 30°. If the
fountain is 30 3 feet from the entrance of the lift, find the speed of the lift which is
descending.
Trigonometry 259
In this section, we try to solve problems when Angles of elevation and depression are
given.
Example 6.31 From the top of a 12 m high building, the angle of elevation of the top of
a cable tower is 60° and the angle of depression of its foot is 30°. Determine the height of
the tower.
Solution As shown in Fig.6.27, OA is the building, O is the point of observation on the
top of the building OA. Then, OA = 12 m.
PP ¢ is the cable tower with P as the top and P ' as the bottom.
Then the angle of elevation of P, ∠MOP = 60° . P
MP = PP ′ − MP ′ = h − OA = h − 12
60o
O M
MP
In right triangle OMP, = tan 60° 30o
OM
12 m
h − 12
gives = 3 A P¢
OM Fig. 6.27
h − 12
so, OM = ...(1)
3
MP ′
In right triangle OMP ¢, = tan 30°
OM
12 1
gives =
OM 3
260 10th Standard Mathematics
so, OM = 12 3 ...(2)
h − 12
From (1) and (2) we have, = 12 3
3
gives h − 12 = 12 3 × 3 we get, h = 48
Example 6.32 A pole 5 m high is fixed on the top of a tower. The angle of elevation of
the top of the pole observed from a point ‘A’ on the ground is 60° and the angle of
depression to the point ‘A’ from the top of the tower is 45°. Find the height of the
tower. ( 3 = 1.732)
Solution Let BC be the height of the tower and CD be the height of the pole.
Let ‘A’ be the point of observation. D
Let BC = x and AB = y.
From the diagram,
5m
∠BAD = 60° and ∠XCA = 45° = ∠BAC
BC
In right triangle ABC, tan 45° = C X
AB 45o
x
gives 1 = so, x = y ...(1)
y
x
BD BC + CD
In right triangle ABD, tan 60° = =
AB AB
x +5
gives 3 = so, 3y = x +5 60o
45o
y A
B y
we get, 3 x =x +5 [From (1)] Fig. 6.28
5 5 3 +1 5(1.732 + 1)
so, x= = × = = 6.83
3 −1 3 −1 3 +1 2
Solution Let W be the point on the window where the angles of elevation and depression
are measured. Let PQ be the house on the opposite side.
Then WA is the width of the street.
Trigonometry 261
= AQ (WR = AQ )
Let PA = x metres. x
AP
In right triangle PAW, tan q1 = W q1
AW A
x q2
gives tan q1 = h
AW
x
so, AW = R Q
tan q1 Fig. 6.29
we get, AW = x cot q ...(1)
AQ
In right triangle QAW, tan q2 =
AW
h
gives tan q2 = Thinking Corner
AW
What is the minimum number
we get, AW = h cot q2 ...(2) of measurements required to
From (1) and (2) we get, x cot q1 = h cot q2 determine the height or distance
cot q2
or angle of elevation?
gives, x =h
cot q1
cot q2 cot q2
Therefore, height of the opposite house = PA+AQ = x + h = h + h = h 1 +
cot q1 cot q1
Hence Proved.
Progress Check
1. The line drawn from the eye of an observer to the point of object is __________.
2. Which instrument is used in measuring the angle between an object and the eye
of the observer?
3. When the line of sight is above the horizontal level, the angle formed is _______.
4. The angle of elevation ___________ as we move towards the foot of the vertical
object (tower).
5. When the line of sight is below the horizontal level, the angle formed is _______.
Exercise 6.4
1. From the top of a tree of height 13 m the angle of elevation and depression of the top
and bottom of another tree are 45° and 30° respectively. Find the height of the
second tree. ( 3 = 1.732)
2. A man is standing on the deck of a ship, which is 40 m above water level. He observes
the angle of elevation of the top of a hill as 60° and the angle of depression of the
base of the hill as 30° . Calculate the distance of the hill from the ship and the height
of the hill. ( 3 = 1.732)
3. If the angle of elevation of a cloud from a point ‘h’ metres above a lake is q1 and the
angle of depression of its reflection in the lake is q2 . Prove that the height that the
h(tan q1 + tan q2 )
cloud is located from the ground is .
tan q2 − tan q1
4. The angle of elevation of the top of a cell phone tower from the foot of a high
apartment is 60° and the angle of depression of the foot of the tower from the top of
the apartment is 30° . If the height of the apartment is 50 m, find the height of the cell
phone tower. According to radiations control norms, the minimum height of a cell
phone tower should be 120 m. State if the height of the above mentioned cell phone
tower meets the radiation norms.
5. The angles of elevation and depression of the top and bottom of a lamp post from the
top of a 66 m high apartment are 60° and 30° respectively. Find
(i) The height of the lamp post.
(ii) The difference between height of the lamp post and the apartment.
(iii) The distance between the lamp post and the apartment. ( 3 = 1.732)
6. Three villagers A, B and C can see C
each other across a valley. The
horizontal distance between A and A
B is 8 km and the horizontal 20o
Exercise 6.5
4. If sin q + cos q = a and sec q + cosecq = b , then the value of b(a 2 - 1) is equal to
(1) 2a (2) 3a (3) 0 (4) 2ab
5 1
5. If 5x = sec q and = tan q , then x 2 - 2 is equal to
x x
1
(1) 25 (2) (3) 5 (4) 1
25
6. If sin q = cos q , then 2 tan2 q + sin2 q − 1 is equal to
-3 3 2 -2
(1) (2) (3) (4)
2 2 3 3
7. If x = a tan q and y = b sec q then
y2 x 2 x 2 y2 x 2 y2 x 2 y2
(1)
− = 1 (2) − = 1 (3) − =1 (4) − =0
b2 a 2 a 2 b2 a 2 b2 a 2 b2
8. (1 + tan q + sec q)(1 + cot q − cosecq) is equal to
(1) 0 (2) 1 (3) 2 (4) -1
10. If the ratio of the height of a tower and the length of its shadow is 3 : 1 , then the
angle of elevation of the sun has measure
(1) 45° (2) 30° (3) 90° (4) 60°
11. The electric pole subtends an angle of 30° at a point on the same level as its foot. At
a second point ‘b’ metres above the first, the depression of the foot of the tower is
60° . The height of the tower (in metres) is equal to
b b b
(1) 3 b (2) (3) (4)
3 2 3
12. A tower is 60 m height. Its shadow is x metres shorter when the sun’s altitude is 45°
than when it has been 30° , then x is equal to
(1) 41.92 m (2) 43.92 m (3) 43 m (4) 45.6 m
13. The angle of depression of the top and bottom of 20 m tall building from the top of
a multistoried building are 30° and 60° respectively. The height of the multistoried
building and the distance between two buildings (in metres) is
(1) 20, 10 3 (2) 30, 5 3 (3) 20, 10 (4) 30, 10 3
14. Two persons are standing ‘x’ metres apart from each other and the height of the first
person is double that of the other. If from the middle point of the line joining their
feet an observer finds the angular elevations of their tops to be complementary, then
the height of the shorter person (in metres) is
x x
(1) 2 x (2) (3) (4) 2x
2 2 2
264 10th Standard Mathematics
15. The angle of elevation of a cloud from a point h metres above a lake is b . The angle
of depression of its reflection in the lake is 45° . The height of location of the cloud
from the lake is
h(1 + tan b ) h(1 − tan b )
(1) (2) (3) h tan(45° − b ) (4) none of these
1 − tan b 1 + tan b
Unit Exercise - 6
sec A − 1 sin A − 1 2
1. Prove that (i) cot2 A
+ sec2 A = 0 (ii) tan q − 1 = 1 − 2 cos2 q
1 + sin A
1 + sec A tan2 q + 1
2
1 + sin q − cos q 1 − cos q
2. Prove that =
1 + sin q + cos q 1 + cos q
3. If x sin q + y cos q = sin q cos q and x sin q = y cos q , then prove that x 2 + y 2 = 1 .
3 3
5. A bird is sitting on the top of a 80 m high tree. From a point on the ground, the angle
of elevation of the bird is 45° . The bird flies away horizontally in such away that it
remained at a constant height from the ground. After 2 seconds, the angle of elevation
of the bird from the same point is 30° . Determine the speed at which the bird flies.
( 3 = 1.732)
6. An aeroplane is flying parallel to the Earth’s surface at a speed of 175 m/sec and at a
height of 600 m. The angle of elevation of the aeroplane from a point on the Earth’s
surface is 37° at a given point. After what period of time does the angle of elevation
increase to 53° ? (tan 53° = 1.3270, tan 37° = 0.7536)
7. A bird is flying from A towards B at an angle of 35° , a point 30 km away from A. At
B it changes its course of flight and heads towards C on a bearing of 48° and distance
32 km away.
(i) How far is B to the North of A? (ii) How far is B to the West of A?
(iii) How far is C to the North of B? (iv) How far is C to the East of B?
(sin 55° = 0.8192, cos 55° = 0.5736, sin 42° = 0.6691, cos 42° = 0.7431)
8. Two ships are sailing in the sea on either side of the lighthouse. The angles of
depression of two ships as observed from the top of the lighthouse are 60° and 45°
3 + 1
metres, find the height
respectively. If the distance between the ships is 200
3
of the lighthouse.
9. A building and a statue are in opposite side of a street from each other 35 m apart.
From a point on the roof of building the angle of elevation of the top of statue is 24° and
the angle of depression of base of the statue is 34° . Find the height of the statue.
(tan 24° = 0.4452, tan 34° = 0.6745)
Trigonometry 265
Points to Remember
zz An equation involving trigonometric ratios of an angle is called a trigonometric
identity if it is true for all values of the angle.
zz Trigonometric identities
ICT CORNER
ICT 6.1
Step 1: Open the Browser type the URL Link given below (or) Scan the QR Code. Chapter named
“Trigonometry” will open. Select the work sheet “Basic Identity”
Step 2: In the given worksheet you can change the triangle by dragging the point “B”. Check the identity for each
angle of the right angled triangle in the unit circle.
ICT 6.2
Step 1: Open the Browser type the URL Link given below (or) Scan the QR Code. Chapter named
“Trigonometry” will open. Select the work sheet “Heights and distance problem-1”
Step 2: In the given worksheet you can change the Question by clicking on “New Problem”. Move the slider, to
view the steps. Workout the problem yourself and verify the answer.
7
MENSURATION
“Nature is an infinite sphere of which the centre is everywhere and
the circumference nowhere”. - Blaise Pascal
Learning Outcomes
To determine the surface area and volume of cylinder,
cone, sphere, hemisphere and frustum.
To compute volume and surface area of combined solids.
To solve problems involving conversion of solids from
one shape to another with no change in volume.
7.1 Introduction
The ancient cultures throughout the world sought the idea of measurements for
satisfying their daily needs. For
example, they had to know how
much area of crops needed to be
grown in a given region; how
much could a container hold?
Cube Cuboid Triangular Prism
etc. These questions were very (Rectangular perllelopiped)
important for making decisions
in agriculture and trade. They
needed efficient and compact
way of doing this. It is for this
reason, mathematicians thought
of applying geometry to real life
situations to attain useful results. Square Pyramid Triangular Pyramid Hexagonal Pyramid
This was the reason for the origin Fig. 7.1
We are already familiar with the areas of plane figures like square, rectangle, triangle,
circle etc. These figures are called 2-dimensional shapes as they can be drawn in a plane.
But most of the objects which we come across in our daily life cannot be represented in a
plane. For example, tubes, water tanks, bricks, ice-cream cones, football etc. These objects
are called solid shapes or 3-dimensional shapes.
We often see solids like cube, cuboid, prism and pyramid. For three dimensional
objects measurements like surface area and volume exist.
In this chapter, we shall study about the surface area and volume
of some of the standard solid shapes such as cylinder, cone, sphere,
hemisphere and frustum.
Example 7.1 A cylindrical drum has a height of 20 cm and base radius of 14 cm. Find its
curved surface area and the total surface area.
Solution Given that, height of the cylinder h = 20 cm ; radius r =14 cm
Now, C.S.A. of the cylinder = 2prh sq. units
22
C.S.A. of the cylinder = 2 × × 14 × 20 = 2 × 22 × 2 × 20 = 1760 cm2
7
T.S.A. of the cylinder = 2pr (h + r ) sq. units
22 22
= 2× × 14 × (20 + 14) = 2 × × 14 × 34
7 7
= 2992 cm2
Therefore, C.S.A. = 1760 cm2 and T.S.A. = 2992 cm2
Mensuration 269
Example 7.2 The curved surface area of a right circular cylinder of height 14 cm is
88 cm2 . Find the diameter of the cylinder.
Solution Given that, C.S.A. of the cylinder =88 sq. cm
2prh = 88
22
2 ´ ´ r ´ 14 = 88 (given h=14 cm)
7
88 × 7
2r = =2
22 × 14
Therefore, diameter = 2 cm
Example 7.3 A garden roller whose length is 3 m long and whose diameter is 2.8 m is
rolled to level a garden. How much area will it cover in 8 revolutions?
Solution Given that, diameter d = 2.8 m and height = 3 m
radius r = 1.4 m
Area covered in one revolution = curved surface area of the cylinder
= 2prh sq. units
22
= 2×
× 1.4 × 3 = 26.4
7
Area covered in 1 revolution = 26.4 m2 Fig. 7.6
Area covered in 8 revolutions = 8 × 26.4 = 211.2
Therefore, area covered is 211.2 m2
Thinking Corner
1. When ‘h’ coins each of radius ‘r’ units and thickness 1 unit is stacked one upon the
other, what would be the solid object you get? Also find its C.S.A.
2. When the radius of a cylinder is double its height, find the relation between its
C.S.A. and base area.
3. Two circular cylinders are formed by rolling two rectangular aluminum sheets each
of dimensions 12 m length and 5 m breadth, one by rolling along its length and the
other along its width. Find the ratio of their curved surface areas.
T.S.A. of the hollow cylinder = C.S.A. + Area of two rings at the top and bottom.
= 2p(R + r )h + 2p(R 2 − r 2 )
Example 7.4 If one litre of paint covers 10 m2, how many litres of paint is required to
paint the internal and external surface areas of a cylindrical tunnel whose
thickness is 2 m, internal radius is 6 m and height is 25 m.
2m
Solution Given that, height h = 25 m; thickness = 2 m.
25m
internal radius r = 6 m
C.S.A. of the cylindrical tunnel = C.S.A. of the hollow cylinder Fig. 7.8
Progress Check
3. The difference between the C.S.A. and T.S.A. of a right circular cylinder is ______.
4. The C.S.A. of a right circular cylinder of equal radius and height is ________ the
area of its base.
Mensuration 271
diagram. The height of the cone is the length of the axis AB, and the slantC r
B
height is the length of the hypotenuse AC. Fig. 7.10
Surface area of a right circular cone A A
Thinking Corner
1. Give practical example of solid cone.
2. Find surface area of a cone in terms of its radius when height is equal to radius.
3. Compare the above surface area with the area of the base of the cone.
Activity 1
(i) Take a semi-circular paper with radius 7 cm and make it a cone. Find the C.S.A.
of the cone.
(ii) Take a quarter circular paper with radius 3.5 cm and make it a cone. Find the
C.S.A. of the cone.
272 10th Standard Mathematics
Example 7.5 The radius of a conical tent is 7 m and the height is 24 m. Calculate the
length of the canvas used to make the tent if the width of the rectangular canvas is 4 m?
Solution Let r and h be the radius and height of the cone respectively.
Given that, radius r =7 m and height h = 24 m
Hence, l = r 2 + h 2
= 49 + 576
l = 625 = 25 m
C.S.A. of the conical tent = prl sq. units
22
Area of the canvas = × 7 × 25 = 550 m2
7
Area of the canvas 550
Now, length of the canvas = = = 137.5 m
width 4
Example 7.6 If the total surface area of a cone of radius 7cm is 704 cm2, then find its
slant height.
2.4cm
Solution Let h and r be the height and radius of the cone and cylinder.
l = 2.5 cm
= pr (2h + l + r )
22
= × 0.7 × (2 × 2.4) + 2.5 + 0.7
7
= 17.6
Progress Check
Sector Cone
Radius Circumference of the base
Area Slant height
Arc length Curved surface area
Every plane section of a sphere is a circle. The line of section of a sphere by a plane
passing through the centre of the sphere is called a great circle;
all other plane sections are called small circles. Q R
h = 2r
That is, Surface area of sphere =curved surface area of cylinder
= 2prh = 2pr (2r )
Fig. 7.15
Surface area of a sphere = 4pr 2 sq.units
Activity 2
(i) Take a sphere of radius ‘r’.
(ii) Take a cylinder whose base diameter and height are equal to the diameter of the
sphere.
(iii) Now, roll thread around the surface of the sphere and the cylinder without
overlapping and leaving space between the threads.
(iv) Now compare the length of the two threads in both the cases.
(v) Use this information to find surface area of sphere.
7.2.1 Hemisphere r
By doing this, we observe that a hemisphere is exactly half the Fig. 7.16
portion of the sphere.
C.S.A. of the sphere 4pr 2
Curved surface area of hemisphere = =
2 2
C.S.A. of a hemisphere = 2pr 2 sq.units
Mensuration 275
Example 7.8 Find the diameter of a sphere whose surface area is 154 m2.
Solution Let r be the radius of the sphere. Activity 3
Given that, surface area of sphere = 154 m2 Using a globe list any two
4pr 2 = 154 countries in the northern and
southern hemispheres.
22
4´ ´r 2 = 154
7 Northern
1 7 Hemisphere
gives r2 = 154 × ×
4 22 Equator
49 7
hence, r2 = we get r = Southern
4 2 Hemisphere
Therefore, diameter is 7 m
Fig. 7.18
Example 7.9 The radius of a spherical balloon increases from 12 cm to 16 cm as air
being pumped into it. Find the ratio of the surface area of the balloons in the two cases.
Solution Let r1 and r2 be the radii of the balloons.
r1 12 3
Given that, = =
r2 16 4 2
4pr12 r12 r 3
2
9
Now, ratio of C.S.A. of balloons = 1
= 2 = = =
4pr22
r2 r2 4 16
Therefore, ratio of C.S.A. of balloons is 9:16.
Thinking Corner
1. Find the value of the radius of a sphere whose surface area is 36p sq. units.
3. Find the surface area of the earth whose diameter is 12756 kms.
276 10th Standard Mathematics
Progress Check
Example 7.10 If the base area of a hemispherical solid is 1386 sq. metres, then find its
total surface area?
Note
Solution Let r be the radius of the hemisphere.
¾ For finding the C.S.A.
Given that, base area = pr 2 = 1386 sq. m and T.S.A. of a hollow
T.S.A. = 3pr sq.m
2 sphere, the formulla for
finding the surface area
= 3 × 1386 = 4158
of a sphere can be used.
Therefore, T.S.A. of the hemispherical solid is 4158 m2.
Thinking Corner
1. Shall we get a hemisphere when a sphere is cut along the small circle?
2. T.S.A of a hemisphere is equal to how many times the area of its base?
3. How many hemispheres can be obtained from a given sphere?
Example 7.11 The internal and external radii of a hollow hemispherical shell are 3 m and
5 m respectively. Find the T.S.A. and C.S.A. of the shell.
Solution Let the internal and external radii of the hemispherical shell be r and R
respectively.
Given that, R = 5 m, r =3 m R
r
C.S.A. of the shell = 2p(R + r ) sq. units
2 2
22
= 2× × (25 + 9) = 213.71 r
7
T.S.A. of the shell = p(3R 2 + r 2 ) sq. units
Fig. 7.19
22
= (75 + 9) = 264
7
Therefore, C.S.A. = 213.71 m 2 and T.S.A. = 264 m2.
Solution Required Ratio = C.S.A. of the sphere: C.S.A. of the cylinder : C.S.A. of the cone
= 4pr 2 : 2prh : prl , (l = r 2 + h 2 = 2r 2 = 2r units)
= 4 : 2: 2 = 2 2 : 2 : 1
Definition
H When a cone ABC is cut through by a plane parallel to its
D r E
L
base, the portion of the cone DECB between the cutting plane
h and the base is called a frustum of the cone.
l
R
B C
Fig. 7.23
Example 7.13 The slant height of a frustum of a cone is 5 cm and the radii of its ends are
4 cm and 1 cm. Find its curved surface area.
Solution Let l, R and r be the slant height, top radius and bottom radius of the frustum.
Given that, l = 5 cm, R = 4 cm, r = 1 cm
Now, C.S.A. of the frustum = p (R + r )l sq. units
22
Thinking Corner
= × (4 + 1) × 5 1. Give two real life examples
7
for a frustum of a cone.
550
=
7 2. Can a hemisphere be
Therefore, C.S.A. = 78.57 cm2 considered as a frustum of
a sphere.
Example 7.14 An industrial metallic bucket is in the shape of the
10m
frustum of a right circular cone whose top and bottom diameters are
10 m and 4 m and whose height is 4 m. Find the curved and total
surface area of the bucket. 4m
Solution Let h, l, R and r be the height, slant height, outer radius
and inner radius of the frustum. 4m
Fig. 7.24
Given that, diameter of the top =10 m; radius of the top R = 5 m.
diameter of the bottom = 4 m; radius of the bottom r = 2 m, height h= 4 m
Now, l = h 2 + (R − r )2
= 42 + (5 − 2)2
l = 16 + 9 = 25 =5m
22 1408
= (5 + 2)5 + 25 + 4 = = 201.14
7 7
Therefore, C.S.A. = 110 m2 and T.S.A. = 201.14 m2
Progress Check
1. The portion of a right circular cone intersected between two parallel planes is
_________.
2. How many frustums can a right circular cone have?
Mensuration 279
Exercise 7.1
1. The radius and height of a cylinder are in the ratio 5:7 and its curved surface area is
5500 sq.cm. Find its radius and height.
2. A solid iron cylinder has total surface area of 1848 sq.m. Its curved surface area is
five – sixth of its total surface area. Find the radius and height of the iron cylinder.
3. The external radius and the length of a hollow wooden log are 16 cm and 13 cm
respectively. If its thickness is 4 cm then find its T.S.A.
4. A right angled triangle PQR where ∠Q = 90 is rotated about QR and PQ. If
QR=16 cm and PR=20 cm, compare the curved surface areas of the right circular
cones so formed by the triangle.
5. 4 persons live in a conical tent whose slant height is 19 cm. If each person require
22 cm2 of the floor area, then find the height of the tent.
6. A girl wishes to prepare birthday caps in the form of right circular cones for her
birthday party, using a sheet of paper whose area is 5720 cm2, how many caps can be
made with radius 5 cm and height 12 cm.
7. The ratio of the radii of two right circular cones of same height is 1:3. Find the ratio
of their curved surface area when the height of each cone is 3 times the radius of the
smaller cone.
8. The radius of a sphere increases by 25%. Find the percentage increase in its surface area.
9. The internal and external diameters of a hollow hemispherical vessel are 20 cm and
28 cm respectively. Find the cost to paint the vessel all over 6m
2
at ` 0.14 per cm .
8m
10. The frustum shaped outer portion of the table lamp has to be
painted including the top part. Find the total cost of painting
12m
the lamp if the cost of painting 1 sq.cm is ` 2.
7.3 Volume
Having discussed about the surface areas of cylinder, cone, sphere,
hemisphere and frustum, we shall now discuss about the volumes of these
solids.
Volume refers to the amount of space occupied by an object. The
volume is measured in cubic units.
7.3.1 Volume of a solid right circular cylinder
h
The volume of a right circular cylinder of base radius ‘r’ and height ‘h’
is given by V = (Base Area) × (Height) = pr 2 × h = pr 2h cubic units.
r
Therefore, Volume of a cylinder = pr h cu. units.
2
Fig. 7.25
280 10th Standard Mathematics
= base area × h
= 250× 2 = 500 m3
Thinking Corner
1. If the height is inversely proportional to the square of its radius, the volume of the
cylinder is ____________.
2. What happens to the volume of the cylinder with radius r and height h, when its
(a) radius is halved (b) height is halved.
Example 7.16 The volume of a cylindrical water tank is 1.078 × 106 litres. If the diameter
of the tank is 7 m, find its height.
Solution Let r and h be the radius and height of the cylinder respectively.
Given that, volume of the tank = 1.078 × 106 = 1078000 litre
1
= 1078 m3 (since 1l = m 3)
1000
7
diameter = 7m gives radius = m
2
volume of the tank = pr 2h cu. units
22 7 7
1078 = × × ×h
7 2 2
Therefore, height of the tank is 28 m
Mensuration 281
Example 7.17 Find the volume of the iron used to make a hollow cylinder of height 9 cm
and whose internal and external radii are 21 cm and 28 cm respectively.
Solution Let r, R and h be the internal radius, external radius and height of the hollow
cylinder respectively.
Given that, r =21cm, R = 28 cm, h = 9 cm
22 ( 2
= 28 − 212 ) × 9
7
22 (
= 784 − 441) × 9 = 9702
7
22 21 21
Volume of cylinder B =
7 cm
× × ×7
7 2 2
= 2425.5 cm3
cylinder A cylinder B
Therefore, volume of cylinder B is greater Fig. 7.27
than volume of cylinder A.
Fig. 7.28
From, Fig.7.28 we see that,
= pr 2h cu. units
1
Volume of a cone = pr 2h cu. units
3
Example 7.19 The volume of a solid right circular cone is 11088 cm3. If its height is 24 cm
then find the radius of the cone.
Solution Let r and h be the radius and height of the cone respectively.
Given that, volume of the cone = 11088 cm3
1 2
pr h = 11088
3
1 22
´ ´ r 2 ´ 24 = 11088
3 7
r 2 = 441
Therefore, radius of the cone r = 21 cm
Thinking Corner
1. Is it possible to find a right circular cone with equal
(a) height and slant height (b) radius and slant height (c) height and radius.
2. There are two cones with equal volumes. What will be the ratio of their radius and
height?
Example 7.20 The ratio of the volumes of two cones is 2:3. Find the ratio of their radii if
the height of second cone is double the height of the first.
Mensuration 283
Solution Let r1 and h1 be the radius and height of the cone-I and let r2 and h2 be the
radius and height of the cone-II.
Progress Check
3cm
greater?
(ii) Verify whether the cone with
greater volume has greater 3 cm 4 cm
Fig. 7.29
surface area.
(iii) Volume of cone A : Volume of cone B = ?
7.3.2 Volume of a hollow sphere / spherical shell (volume of the material used)
Let r and R be the inner and outer radius of the hollow sphere.
Volume enclosed between the outer and inner spheres r
4 4
= pR 3 − pr 3 R
3 3
4
Volume of a hollow sphere = p(R 3 − r 3 ) cu. units
3 Fig. 7.31
7.3.3 Volume of solid hemisphere
r
Let r be the radius of the solid hemisphere.
1
Volume of the solid hemisphere = (volume of sphere) r
2
1 4
= pr 3 Fig. 7.32
2 3
2 3
Volume of a solid hemisphere = pr cu. units
3
7.3.4 Volume of hollow hemisphere (volume of the material used)
Let r and R be the inner and outer radius of the hollow hemisphere.
R
r
Volume of hollow
Volume of outer Volume of inner
hemisphere hemisphere − hemisphere
=
2 2
= pR 3 − pr 3
3 3
Fig. 7.33
2
Volume of a hollow hemisphere = p(R 3 − r 3 ) cu. units
3
Thinking Corner
A cone, a hemisphere and a cylinder have equal bases. The heights of the cone and
cylinder are equal and are same as the common radius. Are they equal in volume?
Mensuration 285
Example 7.21 The volume of a solid hemisphere is 29106 cm3. Another hemisphere whose
volume is two-third of the above is carved out. Find the radius of the new hemisphere.
Solution Let r be the radius of the hemisphere.
Given that, volume of the hemisphere = 29106 cm3
2
Now, volume of new hemisphere = (Volume of original sphere)
3
2
= × 29106
3
Volume of new hemisphere = 19404 cm3
2 3
pr = 19404
3
19404 × 3 × 7
r 3 = = 9261
2 × 22
r = 3 9261 = 21 cm
Therefore, r = 21 cm
Thinking Corner
1. Give any two real life examples of sphere and hemisphere.
2. A plane along a great circle will split the sphere into _____ parts.
3. If the volume and surface area of a sphere are numerically equal, then the radius
of the sphere is ________.
Example 7.22 Calculate the weight of a hollow brass sphere if the inner diameter is 14 cm
and thickness is 1mm, and whose density is 17.3 g/ cm3.
Solution Let r and R be the inner and outer radii of the hollow sphere.
1
Given that, inner diameter d = 14 cm; inner radius r = 7 cm; thickness = 1 mm = cm
10
1 71
Outer radius R = 7 + = = 7.1 cm
10 10
4
Volume of hollow sphere = p (R 3 − r 3 ) cu. cm
3
4 22 (
= × 357.91 − 343) = 62.48 cm3
3 7
But, weight of brass in 1 cm3 = 17.3 gm
Progress Check
Now,
3
1 22 2
= × × 28 + (28 × 7) + 72 × 45
3 7
2 8 cm
1 22
= × × 1029 × 45 = 48510 Fig. 7.35
3 7
Therefore, volume of the frustum is 48510 cm3
Mensuration 287
Exercise 7.2
1. A 14 m deep well with inner diameter 10 m is dug and the earth taken out is evenly
spread all around the well to form an embankment of width 5 m. Find the height of
the embankment.
3. If the circumference of a conical wooden piece is 484 cm then find its volume when
its height is 105 cm.
4. A conical container is fully filled with petrol. The radius is 10m and the height is
15 m. If the container can release the petrol through its bottom at the rate of 25 cu.
meter per minute, in how many minutes the container will be emptied. Round off
your answer to the nearest minute.
5. A right angled triangle whose sides are 6 cm, 8 cm and 10 cm is revolved about the
sides containing the right angle in two ways. Find the difference in volumes of the
two solids so formed.
6. The volumes of two cones of same base radius are 3600 cm3 and 5040 cm3. Find the
ratio of heights.
7. If the ratio of radii of two spheres is 4:7, find the ratio of their volumes.
8. A solid sphere and a solid hemisphere have equal total surface area. Prove that the
ratio of their volume is 3 3 : 4 .
9. The outer and the inner surface areas of a spherical copper shell are 576p cm2 and
324p cm2 respectively. Find the volume of the material required to make the shell.
10. A container open at the top is in the form of a frustum of a cone of height 16 cm with
radii of its lower and upper ends are 8 cm and 20 cm respectively. Find the cost of
milk which can completely fill a container at the rate of `40 per litre.
To calculate the surface area of the combined solid, we should only calculate the
areas that are visible to our eyes. For example, if a cone is surmounted by a hemisphere,
we need to just find out the C.S.A. of the hemisphere and C.S.A. of the cone separately
and add them together. Note that we are leaving the base area of both the cone and the
hemisphere since both the bases are attached together and are not visible.
But, the volume of the solid formed by joining two basic solids will be the sum of the
volumes of the individual solids.
6 cm
Example 7.24 A toy is in the shape of a cylinder surmounted by a
hemisphere. The height of the toy is 25 cm. Find the total surface
area of the toy if its common diameter is 12 cm.
22
= × 6 × (38 + 18)
7
22
= × 6 × 56 = 1056
7
Therefore, T.S.A. of the toy is 1056 cm2
Mensuration 289
10 cm
the box. 15
cm 30cm
Solution Let l, b and h1 be the length, breadth and height of the
cuboid. Also let us take r and h2 be the radius and height of the Fig. 7.39
cylinder.
1
Now, Volume of the box = Volume of the cuboid + (Volume of cylinder)
2
1
= (l × b × h1 ) + (pr 2h2 ) cu. units
2
1 22 15 15
= (30 × 15 × 10) + × × × 30
2 7 2 2
= 4500 + 2651.79 = 7151.79
Therefore, Volume of the box = 7151.79 cm3
1
Now, T.S.A. of the box = C.S.A. of the cuboid+ (C.S.A. of the cylinder)
2
1
= 2(l + b)h1 + (2prh2 )
2
22 15
= 2(45 × 10) + × × 30
7 2
= 900 + 707.14 = 1607.14
Therefore, T.S.A. of the box = 1607.14 cm2
Example 7.26 Arul has to make arrangements for the accommodation of 150 persons
for his family function. For this purpose, he plans to build a tent which is in the shape of
cylinder surmounted by a cone. Each person occupies 4 sq. m of the space on ground and
40 cu. meter of air to breathe. What should be the height of the conical part of the tent if
the height of cylindrical part is 8 m?
1 2
pr 2h1 + pr h2 = 6000
3
1
pr 2 h1 + h2 = 6000
3
22 2100 1
× 8 + h2 = 6000 [using (1)]
7 11 3
1 6000 ´ 7 ´ 11
8 + h2 =
3 22 ´ 2100
1
h = 10 – 8 = 2
3 2
Therefore, the height of the conical tent h2 is 6 m
Now, h1 = 20–12 = 8 cm
(R − r )
2
8 cm
Here, Slant height of the frustum l = + h12 units
6 cm
= 36 + 64
2 0 cm
l = 10 cm
22
= × 324 = 1018.28
7
Therefore, outer surface area of the funnel is 1018.28 cm2
Fig. 7.42
Mensuration 291
= 6 × (Edge)2 + 2pr 2 − pr 2
= 6 × (Edge)2 + pr 2
2
l 1
= 6 × (l ) + p = (24 + p)l 2
2
2 4
1
Total surface area of the remaining solid = (24 + p)l 2 sq. units
4
Activity 4
Combined solids
Exercise 7.3
2. Nathan, an engineering student was asked to make a model shaped like a cylinder
with two cones attached at its two ends. The diameter of the model is 3 cm and its
length is 12 cm. If each cone has a height of 2 cm, find the volume of the model that
Nathan made.
3. From a solid cylinder whose height is 2.4 cm and the diameter 1.4 cm, a cone of the
same height and same diameter is carved out. Find the volume of the remaining
solid to the nearest cm 3 .
12cm
6 cm standing on a hemisphere of radius 6 cm is placed upright in a
right circular cylinder full of water such that it touches the bottom.
Find the volume of the water displaced out of the cylinder, if the
6cm
radius of the cylinder is 6 cm and height is 18 cm.
6 cm
5. A capsule is in the shape of a cylinder with two hemisphere stuck to
each of its ends. If the length of the entire capsule is 12 mm and the diameter of the
capsule is 3 mm, how much medicine it can hold?
8. A shuttle cock used for playing badminton has the shape of a frustum of a cone is
mounted on a hemisphere. The diameters of the frustum are 5 cm and 2 cm. The
height of the entire shuttle cock is 7 cm. Find its external surface area.
7.5 Conversion of Solids from one shape to another with no change in Volume
Conversions or Transformations becomes a common part of our daily life. For
example, a gold smith melts a bar of gold to transform it to a jewel. Similarly, a kid playing
with clay shapes it into different toys, a carpenter uses the wooden logs to form different
house hold articles/furniture. Likewise, the conversion of solids from one shape to another
is required for various purposes.
In this section we will be learning problems involving conversions of solids from one
shape to another with no change in volume.
Example 7.29 A metallic sphere of radius 16 cm is melted and recast into small spheres
each of radius 2 cm. How many small spheres can be obtained?
Solution Let the number of small spheres obtained be n.
Let r be the radius of each small sphere and R be the radius of metallic sphere.
Here, R = 16 cm, r = 2 cm
Now, n ´ (Volume of a small sphere) = Volume of big metallic sphere
4 4
n pr 3 = pR 3
3 3
Mensuration 293
4 4
n p × 23 = p × 163
3 3
Example 7.31 A right circular cylindrical container of base radius 6 cm and height 15
cm is full of ice cream. The ice cream is to be filled in cones of height 9 cm and base
radius 3 cm, having a hemispherical cap. Find the number of cones needed to empty
the container.
Solution Let h and r be the height and radius of the cylinder respectively.
Given that, h = 15 cm, r = 6 cm
Volume of the container V = pr 2h cubic units.
22
= × 6 × 6 × 15
7
Let, r1 = 3 cm, h1 = 9 cm be the radius and height of the cone.
Also, r1 = 3 cm is the radius of the hemispherical cap.
Volume of one ice cream cone = (Volume of the cone + Volume of the hemispherical cap)
1 2
= pr12h1 + pr13
3 3
1 22 2 22
= × ×3×3×9 + × ×3×3×3
3 7 3 7
22 22
= × 9(3 + 2) = × 45
7 7
volume of the cylinder
Number of cones =
volume of one ice cream cone
294 10th Standard Mathematics
22
× 6 × 6 × 15
Number of ice cream cones needed = 7 = 12
22
× 45
7
Thus 12 ice cream cones are required to empty the cylindrical container.
Activity 5
The adjacent figure shows a cylindrical can with two balls. The can is just large enough
so that two balls will fit inside with the lid on. The radius of each tennis
ball is 3 cm. Calculate the following
(i) height of the cylinder.
(ii) radius of the cylinder.
(iii) volume of the cylinder.
(iv) volume of two balls.
(v) volume of the cylinder not occupied by the balls.
(vi) percentage of the volume occupied by the balls. Fig. 7.43
Exercise 7.4
Mensuration 295
Exercise 7.5
3. The height of a right circular cone whose radius is 5 cm and slant height is 13 cm will be
(1) 12 cm (2) 10 cm (3) 13 cm (4) 5 cm
4. If the radius of the base of a right circular cylinder is halved keeping the same height,
then the ratio of the volume of the cylinder thus obtained to the volume of original
cylinder is
(1) 1:2 (2) 1:4 (3) 1:6 (4) 1:8
1
5. The total surface area of a cylinder whose radius is of its height is
3
9ph 2
(1) sq.units (2) 24ph 2 sq.units
8
8ph 2 56ph 2
(3) sq.units (4) sq.units
9 9
6. In a hollow cylinder, the sum of the external and internal radii is 14 cm and the
width is 4 cm. If its height is 20 cm, the volume of the material in it is
(1) 5600p cm3 (2) 11200p cm3 (3) 56p cm3 (4) 3600p cm3
7. If the radius of the base of a cone is tripled and the height is doubled then the
volume is
(1) made 6 times (2) made 18 times (3) made 12 times (4) unchanged
8. The total surface area of a hemi-sphere is how much times the square of its radius.
(1) π (2) 4p (3) 3p (4) 2p
296 10th Standard Mathematics
9. A
solid sphere of radius x cm is melted and cast into a shape of a solid cone of same
radius. The height of the cone is
(1) 3x cm (2) x cm (3)4x cm (4)2x cm
10. A frustum of a right circular cone is of height 16cm with radii of its ends as 8cm and
20cm. Then, the volume of the frustum is
(1) 3328p cm3 (2) 3228p cm3 (3) 3240p cm3 (4) 3340p cm3
11. A shuttle cock used for playing badminton has the shape of the combination of
(1) a cylinder and a sphere (2) a hemisphere and a cone
(3) a sphere and a cone (4) frustum of a cone and a hemisphere
12. A spherical ball of radius r1 units is melted to make 8 new identical balls each of
radius r2 units. Then r1 : r2 is
(1) 2:1 (2) 1:2 (3) 4:1 (4) 1:4
13. The volume (in cm3) of the greatest sphere that can be cut off from a cylindrical log
of wood of base radius 1 cm and height 5 cm is
4 10 20
(1) p (2) p (3) 5p (4) p
3 3 3
14. The height and radius of the cone of which the frustum is a part are h1 units and r1
units respectively. Height of the frustum is h2 units and radius of the smaller base is
r2 units. If h2 : h1 = 1 : 2 then r2 : r1 is
(1) 1 : 3 (2) 1 : 2 (3) 2 : 1 (4) 3 : 1
15. The ratio of the volumes of a cylinder, a cone and a sphere, if each has the same
diameter and same height is
(1) 1:2:3 (2) 2:1:3 (3) 1:3:2 (4) 3:1:2
Unit Exercise - 7
1. T
he barrel of a fountain-pen cylindrical in shape, is 7 cm long and 5 mm in diameter.
A full barrel of ink in the pen will be used for writing 330 words on an average. How
many words can be written using a bottle of ink containing one fifth of a litre?
2. A
hemi-spherical tank of radius 1.75 m is full of water. It is connected with a pipe
which empties the tank at the rate of 7 litre per second. How much time will it take
to empty the tank completely?
3. F
ind the maximum volume of a cone that can be carved out of a solid hemisphere of
radius r units.
4. A
n oil funnel of tin sheet consists of a cylindrical portion 10 cm long attached to a
frustum of a cone. If the total height is 22 cm, the diameter of the cylindrical portion
be 8cm and the diameter of the top of the funnel be 18 cm, then find the area of the
tin sheet required to make the funnel.
Mensuration 297
5. Find the number of coins, 1.5 cm in diameter and 2 mm thick, to be melted to form
a right circular cylinder of height 10 cm and diameter 4.5 cm.
6. A hollow metallic cylinder whose external radius is 4.3 cm and internal radius is 1.1
cm and whole length is 4 cm is melted and recast into a solid cylinder of 12 cm long.
Find the diameter of solid cylinder.
7. The slant height of a frustum of a cone is 4 m and the perimeter of circular ends are
18 m and 16 m. Find the cost of painting its curved surface area at `100 per sq. m.
436p
8. A hemi-spherical hollow bowl has material of volume cubic cm. Its external
3
diameter is 14 cm. Find its thickness.
5 1
9. The volume of a cone is 1005 cu. cm. The area of its base is 201 sq. cm. Find the
slant height of the cone. 7 7
10. A metallic sheet in the form of a sector of a circle of radius 21 cm has central angle
of 216°. The sector is made into a cone by bringing the bounding radii together. Find
the volume of the cone formed.
Points to Remember
Curved surface Area /
Total surface Area Volume
Solid Figure Lateral surface Area
(in sq. units) (in cubic units)
(in sq. units)
Cuboid 2h (l + b ) 2 (lb + bh + lh ) l ´b ´ h
Cube 4a 2 6a 2 a3
Hemisphere r
2pr 2 3pr 2 2 3
pr
r 3
Hollow 2p (R + r ) h 2p(R + r ) (
p R2 − r 2 h)
cylinder
h
( R − r + h)
r
Hollow
R
r
(
2p R 2 + r 2 ) (
p 3R 2 + r 2 ) 2
(
p R3 − r 3 )
hemisphere 3
Frustum of r
p (R + r )l where p(R + r )l + pR 2 1
ph R 2 + r 2 + Rr
right circular h 3
l = h 2 + (R − r )
2 2
+pr
cone.
R
ICT CORNER
ICT 7.1
Step 1: Open the Browser type the URL Link given below (or) Scan the QR Code. GeoGebra work book named
“Mensuration _X” will open. Select the work sheet “Cone-Cylinder relation”
Step 2: In the given worksheet you can change the radius and height of the cone-Cylinder by moving the sliders on the left-
hand side. Move the vertical slider, to view cone filled in the cylinder and this proves 3 times cone equal to one cylinder of
same radius and same height.
Step 1 Step 2 Expected results
ICT 7.2
Step 1: Open the Browser type the URL Link given below (or) Scan the QR Code. GeoGebra work book named
“Mensuration _X” will open. Select the work sheet “Cylinder Hemispheres”
Step 2: In the given worksheet you can change the radius of the Hemisphere-Cylinder by moving the sliders on the left-
hand side. Move the slider Attach/Detach to see how combined solid is formed. You can rotate 3-D picture to see the faces.
Working is given on the left-hand side. Work out and verify your answer.
Step 1 Step 2 Expected results
Mensuration 299
STATISTICS AND
8 PROBABILITY
“Life is a School of Probability” - Walter Bagehot
Learning Outcomes
z To recall the measures of central tendency.
z To recall mean for ungrouped and grouped data.
z To understand the concept of dispersion.
z To understand and compute range, standard deviation, variance and
coefficient of variation.
z To understand random experiments, sample space and use of a tree
diagram.
z To define and describe different types of events of a random experiment.
z To understand addition theorem of probability and apply it in solving
some simple problems.
8.1 Introduction
‘STATISTICS’ is derived from the Latin word ‘status’ which means a political state.
Today, statistics has become an integral part of everyone’s life, unavoidable whether
making a plan for our future, doing a business, a marketing research or preparing economic
reports. It is also extensively used in opinion polls, doing advanced research. The study
of statistics is concerned with scientific methods for collecting, organising, summarising,
presenting, analysing data and making meaningful decisions. In earlier classes we have
studied about collection of data, presenting the data in tabular form, graphical form and
calculating the Measures of Central Tendency. Now, in this class, let us study about the
Measures of Dispersion.
Recall
Measures of Central Tendency
It is often convenient to have one number that represent the whole data. Such a
number is called a Measures of Central Tendency.
The Measures of Central Tendency usually will be Thinking Corner
near to the middle value of the data. For a given data there 1. Does the mean, median
exist several types of measures of central tendencies. and mode are same for a
given data?
The most common among them are
2. What is the difference
• Arithmetic Mean • Median • Mode between the arithmetic
mean and average?
Note
¾ Data : The numerical representation of facts is called data.
¾ Observation : Each entry in the data is called an observation.
¾ Variable : The quantities which are being considered in a survey are called
variables. Variables are generally denoted by xi, i=1,2,3,…,n.
¾ Frequencies : The number of times, a variable occurs in a given data is called the
frequency of that variable. Frequencies are generally denoted as
fi, i=1,2,3,…,n.
In this class we have to recall the Arithmetic Mean.
Arithmetic Mean
The Arithmetic Mean or Mean of the given values is Thinking Corner
sum of all the observations divided by the total number of The mean of n
observations. It is denoted by x (pronounced as x bar) observations is x , if first
Sum of all the observations term is increased by 1
x =
Number of observations second term is increased
Methods of finding Mean
by 2 and so on. What
will be the new mean?
Direct Method Direct Method Assumed Mean Method Step Deviation Method
n n
n
∑ fidi ∑ fd i i
n
∑x i
∑x f i i X = A+ i =1 X = A +C × i =1
n
X= i =1 n
X= i =1 n
∑f ∑f i
n ∑f i i =1
i
i =1
where di = xi–A
i =1
xi − A
where di =
c
We apply the respective formulae depending upon the information provided in the problem.
Statistics and Probability 301
Progress Check
Batsman B: 33, 50, 47, 38, 45, 40, 36, 48, 37, 26
25 + 20 + 45 + 93 + 8 + 14 + 32 + 87 + 72 + 4
Mean of Batsman A = = 40
10
33 + 50 + 47 + 38 + 45 + 40 + 36 + 48 + 37 + 26
Mean of Batsman B = = 40
10
The mean of both datas are same (40), but they differ significantly.
Batsman A Batsman B
100 100
90 90
80 80
70 70
Runs
Runs
60 60
50 50
40 40
30 30
20 20
10 10
0 1 2 3 4 5 6 7 8 9 10 0 1 2 3 4 5 6 7 8 9 10
No. of Matches No. of Matches
Fig. 8.1(a) Fig. 8.1(b)
From the above diagrams, we see that runs of batsman B are grouped around the
mean. But the runs of batsman A are scattered from 0 to 100, though they both have same
mean.
Thus, some additional statistical information may be required to determine how the
values are spread in data. For this, we shall discuss Measures of Dispersion.
Dispersion is a measure which gives an idea about the scatteredness of the values.
8.2.1 Range
The difference between the largest value and the smallest value is called Range.
Range R = L– S
Progress Check
L −S
Coefficient of range =
L +S The range of first 10 prime
where L - Largest value; S - Smallest value numbers is _______
Example 8.1 Find the range and coefficient of range of the following data: 25, 67, 48,
53, 18, 39, 44.
Solution Largest value L = 67; Smallest value S =18
Range R = L − S = 67 − 18 = 49
L −S
Coefficient of range =
L +S
67 − 18 49
Coefficient of range = = = 0.576
67 + 18 85
Note
¾¾ We note that (x i − x ) ≥ 0 for all observations x i , i = 1,2,3,…,n. If the deviations
2
from the mean (x i − x ) are small, then the squares of the deviations will be very small.
8.2.4 Variance
The mean of the squares of the deviations from the mean is called Variance.
It is denoted by s 2 (read as sigma square).
Variance
= Mean of squares of deviations Thinking Corner
(x − x )2 + (x 2 − x )2 + ... + (x n − x )2 Can variance be
= 1
n n negative?
∑ (x i − x )2
Variance s 2 = i =1
n
8.2.5 Standard Deviation
The positive square root of Variance is called Standard deviation. That is, standard
deviation is the positive square root of the mean of the squares of deviations of the given
values from their mean. It is denoted by s.
Standard deviation gives a clear idea about
how far the values are spreading or deviating from Karl Pearson was the
the mean. first person to use the word
n standard deviation. German
∑ (x i
− x )2 mathematician Gauss used the
Standard deviation s = i =1
word Mean error.
n
Grouped data
Ungrouped
(Both discrete
data
and continuous)
Σx i2 Σx i x 2
=
n
− 2x
n
+
n
× 1 + 1 + to n times ( )
Σx i2 x2 Σx i2 Σx i2
= − 2x × x + ×n = − 2x 2 + x 2 = −x2
n n n n
2
Σx i2 Σx i
Standard deviation, s = −
n n
Note
¾¾ While computing standard deviation, arranging data in ascending order is not mandatory.
¾¾ If the data values are given directly then to find standard deviation we can use the
2
Σx i2 Σx
formula s = − i
n n
¾¾ If the data values are not given directly but the squares of the deviations from the mean
of each observation is given then to find standard deviation we can use the
Σ (x i − x )
2
formula s = .
n
Example 8.4 The number of televisions sold in each day of a week are 13, 8, 4, 9, 7, 12, 10.
Find its standard deviation.
Solution x x2 Standard deviation Thinking Corner
i i
13 169 Σx i2 Σx
2
Can the standard deviation
s = − i be more than the variance?
8 64 n n
4 16
2
9 81 623 63 Progress Check
7 49 = −
12 144
7 7
10 100 = 89 − 81 = 8 If the variance is
Σx i = 63 Σx i = 623 Hence, s 2.83 0.49 then the standard
2
deviation is _____.
(ii) Mean method
Another convenient way of finding standard deviation is to use the following formula.
Σ(x i − x )2
Standard deviation (by mean method) s =
n
Σdi 2
If di = x i − x are the deviations, then s =
n
Example 8.5 The amount of rainfall in a particular season for 6 days are given as 17.8 cm,
19.2 cm, 16.3 cm, 12.5 cm, 12.8 cm and 11.4 cm. Find its standard deviation.
Solution Arranging the numbers in ascending order we get, 11.4, 12.5, 12.8, 16.3, 17.8,
19.2. Number of observations n = 6
11.4 + 12.5 + 12.8 + 16.3 + 17.8 + 19.2 90
Mean = = = 15
6 6
Statistics and Probability 305
di = x i − x Σdi 2
xi
= x − 15
di 2 Standard deviation s =
n
11.4 –3.6 12.96
51.22
12.5 –2.5 6.25 = = 8.53
12.8 –2.2 4.84 6
16.3 1.3 1.69 Hence, s 2.9
17.8 2.8 7.84
19.2 4.2 17.64
Σdi 2 = 51.22
(iii) Assumed Mean method
When the mean value is not an integer (since calculations are very tedious in decimal
form) then it is better to use the assumed mean method to find the standard deviation.
Let x 1, x 2 , x 3 , ..., x n be the given data values and let x be their mean.
Let di be the deviation of xi from the assumed mean A, which is usually the middle
value or near the middle value of the given data.
di = x i − A gives, x i = di + A ...(1)
Sdi = Σ(x i − A)
= Σx i − (A + A + A + to n times)
Sdi = Σx i − A × n
Sdi Σx i
= −A
n n
d = x − A (or) x = d + A ...(2)
Now, Standard deviation
Σ(x i − x )2 Σ(di + A − d − A)2
s = = (using (1) and (2))
n n
Σ(di − d )2 Σ(di 2 − 2di × d + d 2 )
= =
n n
Σdi 2 Σdi d2
= − 2d + (1 + 1 + 1 + to n times)
n n n
Σdi 2 d2
= − 2d × d + × n (since d is a constant)
n n
Σdi 2
= −d 2 Thinking Corner
n
2 For any collection of n values, can you
Σdi 2 Σdi
Standard deviation s = − find the value of
n n
(i) Σ(x i − x ) (ii) (Σx i ) − x
Example 8.6 The marks scored by 10 students in a class test are 25, 29, 30, 33, 35, 37, 38,
40, 44, 48. Find the standard deviation.
306 10th Standard Mathematics
Solution The mean of marks is 35.9 which is not an integer. Hence we take assumed
mean, A = 35, n = 10 .
d = x −A Standard deviation
i i
xi di 2
di = x i − 35 2
Σdi 2 Σd
25 –10 100 s = − i
n n
29 –6 36
30 –5 25 2
33 –2 4 453 9
= −
35 0 0 10 10
37 2 4
38 3 9 = 45.3 − 0.81
40 5 25 = 44.49
44 9 81
48 13 169 s 6.67
Σdi = 9 Σdi 2 = 453
(ii) Step deviation method
Let x 1, x 2 , x 3 ,... x n be the given data. Let A be the assumed mean.
Let c be the common divisor of x i - A .
xi − A
Let di =
c
Then x i = dic + A …(1)
Sx i = Σ (dic + A) = c Σdi + A × n
Sx i Σdi
=c +A
n n
x = cd + A …(2)
x i - x = cdi + A − cd − A = c(di − d ) (using (1) and (2))
Σ(x i − x )2 Σ(c(di − d ))2 c 2Σ(di − d )2
s = = =
n n n
2
Σdi2 Σd
s =c× − i
Note
n n
¾¾ We can use any of the above methods for finding the standard deviation
Activity 1
Find the standard deviation of the marks obtained by you in all five subjects in the quarterly
examination and in the midterm test separately. What do you observe from your results.
Example 8.7 The amount that the children have spent for purchasing some eatables in
one day trip of a school are 5, 10, 15, 20, 25, 30, 35, 40. Using step deviation method, find
the standard deviation of the amount they have spent.
Solution We note that all the observations are divisible by 5. Hence we can use the step
deviation method. Let the Assumed mean A = 20, n = 8.
x −A Standard deviation
di = x i − A
di = i
xi c di 2 2
di = x i − 20 c = 5 Σdi 2 Σdi
s = − × c
n n
5 –15 –3 9
10 –10 –2 4 2
15 –5 –1 1 44 4 11 1
= − × 5 = − ×5
20 0 0 0 8 8 2 4
25 5 1 1
30 10 2 4 = 5.5 − 0.25 × 5 = 2.29 × 5
35 15 3 9
40 20 4 16 s 11.45
Σdi = 4 2
Σdi = 44
Example 8.8 Find the standard deviation of the following data 7, 4, 8, 10, 11. Add 3 to
all the values then find the standard deviation for the new values.
When we add 3 to all the values, we get the new values as 7,10,11,13,14.
xi xi2 Standard deviation
2
7 9 Σx i2 Σx
s = − i
10 100 n n
11 121 2
635 55
13 169 = −
5 5
14 196
Σx i = 55 2
Σx i = 635
s = 6 2.45
From the above, we see that the standard deviation will not change when we add
some fixed constant to all the values.
Example 8.9 Find the standard deviation of the data 2, 3, 5, 7, 8. Multiply each data by 4.
Find the standard deviation of the new values.
308 10th Standard Mathematics
Solution Given, n = 5
xi xi2 Standard deviation
2
2 49 Σx i2 Σx
3 9 s= − i
n n
5 25
7 49 2
8 64 151 25
s= − = 30.2 − 25 = 5.2 2.28
Σx i = 25 Σx i2 = 151 5 5
When we multiply each data by 4, we get the new values as 8, 12, 20, 28, 32.
x x2 Standard deviation
i i
2
Σx i2 Σx
8 64 s= − i
12 144 n n
20 400 2
2416 100
28 784 = − = 483.2 − 400 = 83.2
5 5
32 1024
Σx i = 100 Σx i2 = 2416 s = 16 × 5.2 = 4 5.2 9.12
From the above, we see that when we multiply each data by 4 the standard deviation
also get multiplied by 4.
Example 8.10 Find the mean and variance of the first n natural numbers.
Sum of all the observations
Solution Mean x =
Number of observations
Σx i 1 + 2 + 3 + ... + n n (n + 1)
= = =
n n 2 ×n
n +1
Mean x =
2
Σx Σx 2 = 12 + 22 + 32 + ... + n 2
2
2
Σ x i
Variance s =
2 i
−
i
2 2
n n (Σx i ) = (1 + 2 + 3 + ... + n )
2
n (n + 1)(2n + 1) n (n + 1)
= −
6 ×n 2 ×n
2n 2 + 3n + 1 n 2 + 2n + 1
= −
6 4
2 2
4n + 6 n + 2 − 3 n − 6n − 3 n 2 − 1
Variance s 2 = = .
12 12
Calculation of Standard deviation for grouped data
(i) Mean method
Σfi (x i − x )2
Standard deviation s =
N ( fi are frequency values of the
Let, di = x i − x
corresponding data points xi )
Σfidi 2 n
s= , where N = ∑ fi
N i =1
Example 8.11 48 students were asked to write the total number of hours per week they
spent on watching television. With this information find the standard deviation of hours
spent for watching television.
x 6 7 8 9 10 11 12
f 3 6 9 13 8 5 4
Solution
xi fi x i fi di = x i − x di 2 fidi 2 Mean
6 3 18 –3 9 27 Σx i fi 432 (Since
7 6 42 –2 4 24 x = = =9 N = ∑ fi
N 48 )
8 9 72 –1 1 9
9 13 117 0 0 0 Standard deviation
10 8 80 1 1 8
11 5 55 2 4 20 Σfidi 2 124
s= = = 2.58
12 4 48 3 9 36 N 48
N = 48 Σx i fi = 432 Σdi = 0 2
Σfidi = 124 s 1.6
N = 29 6944
Σfidi = 4 Σfidi 2 = 240 s= ; s 2.87
29 × 29
Calculation of Standard deviation for continuous frequency distribution
(i) Mean method
Σf (x − x )
2
Standard deviation s = i i
where x i = Middle value of the i th class.
N
fi = Frequency of the i th class.
165
Correct mean x = = 11
15
2
Σx 2 Σx
Standard deviation s = −
n n
Σx 2
− (10)
2
Incorrect value of s = 5 =
15
Σx 2 Sx 2
25
= − 100 gives, = 125
15 15
Incorrect value of Sx 2 = 1875
Correct value of Sx 2 = 1875 − 82 + 232 = 2340
2340
− (11)
2
Correct standard deviation s =
15
s = 156 − 121 = 35 s 5.9
Exercise 8.1
11. In a study about viral fever, the number of people affected in a town were noted as
Age in years 0-10 10-20 20-30 30-40 40-50 50-60 60-70
Number of people affected 3 5 16 18 12 7 4
Find its standard deviation.
12. The measurements of the diameters (in cms) of the plates prepared in a factory are
given below. Find its standard deviation.
21-24 25-28 29-32 33-36 37-40 41-44
Diameter(cm)
15
Number of plates 18 20 16 8 7
13. The time taken by 50 students to complete a 100 meter race are given below. Find its
standard deviation.
Time taken(sec) 8.5-9.5 9.5-10.5 10.5-11.5 11.5-12.5 12.5-13.5
Number of students 6 8 17 10 9
14. For a group of 100 candidates the mean and standard deviation of their marks were
found to be 60 and 15 respectively. Later on it was found that the scores 45 and 72
were wrongly entered as 40 and 27. Find the correct mean and standard deviation.
15. The mean and variance of seven observations are 8 and 16 respectively. If five of
these are 2, 4, 10, 12 and 14, then find the remaining two observations.
8.3 Coefficient of Variation
Comparison of two data in terms of measures of central tendencies and dispersions
in some cases will not be meaningful, because the variables in the data may not have same
units of measurement.
For example consider the two data
Weight Price
Mean 8 kg ₹ 85
Standard deviation 1.5 kg ₹ 21.60
Here we cannot compare the standard deviations 1.5kg and ₹21.60. For comparing
two or more data for corresponding changes the relative measure of standard deviation,
called “Coefficient of variation” is used.
Coefficient of variation of a data is obtained by dividing the standard deviation by the
arithmetic mean. It is usually expressed in terms of percentage. This concept is suggested
by one of the most prominent Statistician Karl Pearson.
s1
Thus, coefficient of variation of first data (C.V1) = × 100%
x1
s2
and coefficient of variation of second data (C.V2) = × 100%
x2
The data with lesser coefficient of variation is more consistent or stable than the
other data. Consider the two data Then, we get
A 500 900 800 900 700 400 Mean Standard deviation
B 300 540 480 540 420 240 A 700 191.5
B 420 114.9
If we compare the mean and standard deviation of the two data, we think that the two
datas are entirely different. But mean and standard deviation of B are 60% of that of A.
Because of the smaller mean the smaller standard deviation led to the misinterpretation.
Statistics and Probability 313
s
To compare the dispersion of two data, coefficient of variation = × 100%
x
191.5
The coefficient of variation of A = × 100% = 27.4%
700
114.9
The coefficient of variation of B = × 100% = 27.4%
420
Thus the two data have equal coefficient of variation. Since the data have equal
coefficient of variation values, we can conclude that one data depends on the other. But
the data values of B are exactly 60% of the corresponding data values of A. So they are
very much related. Thus, we get a confusing situation.
To get clear picture of the given data, we can find their coefficient of variation. This
is why we need coefficient of variation.
Progress Check
Exercise 8.2
1. The standard deviation and mean of a data are 6.5 and 12.5 respectively. Find the
coefficient of variation.
2. The standard deviation and coefficient of variation of a data are 1.2 and 25.6
respectively. Find the value of mean.
3. If the mean and coefficient of variation of a data are 15 and 48 respectively, then find
the value of standard deviation.
4. If n = 5 , x = 6 , Σx 2 = 765 , then calculate the coefficient of variation.
5. Find the coefficient of variation of 24, 26, 33, 37, 29, 31.
6. The time taken (in minutes) to complete a homework by 8 students in a day are given
by 38, 40, 47, 44, 46, 43, 49, 53. Find the coefficient of variation.
7. The total marks scored by two students Sathya and Vidhya in 5 subjects are 460
and 480 with standard deviation 4.6 and 2.4 respectively. Who is more consistent in
performance?
8. The mean and standard deviation of marks obtained by 40 students of a class in three
subjects Mathematics, Science and Social Science are given below.
Subject Mean SD Which of the three subjects shows
Mathematics 56 12 highest variation and which shows
Science 65 14 lowest variation in marks?
Social Science 60 10
9. The temperature of two cities A and B in a winter season are given below.
Temperature of city A (in degree Celsius) 18 20 22 24 26
Temperature of city B (in degree Celsius) 11 14 15 17 18
Find which city is more consistent in temperature changes?
8.4 Probability
Few centuries ago, gambling and gaming were considered to be
fashionable and became widely popular among many men. As the
games became more complicated, players were interested in knowing
the chances of winning or losing a game from a given situation. In
1654, Chevalier de Mere, a French nobleman with a taste of gambling,
wrote a letter to one of the prominent mathematician of the time,
Blaise Pascal, seeking his advice about how much dividend he would
get for a gambling game played by paying money. Pascal worked this Blaise Pascal
problem mathematically but thought of sharing this problem and see how his good friend
and mathematician Pierre de Fermat could solve. Their subsequent correspondences on
the issue represented the birth of Probability Theory as a new branch of mathematics.
Random Experiment
A random experiment is an experiment in which
(i) The set of all possible outcomes are known (ii)Exact outcome is not known.
Example : 1. Tossing a coin. 2. Rolling a die. 3. Selecting a card from a pack of 52 cards.
Sample space
The set of all possible outcomes in a random experiment is called
a sample space. It is generally denoted by S.
Example : When we roll a die, the possible outcomes are the
face numbers 1,2,3,4,5,6 of the die. Therefore the sample space is
S = {1,2,3,4,5,6}
Fig. 8.2
316 10th Standard Mathematics
Sample point
Each element of a sample space is called a sample point.
8.4.1 Tree diagram
Tree diagram allow us to see visually all possible outcomes of an random
experiment. Each branch in a tree diagram represent a possible outcome.
Illustration
1
2 (i) When we throw a die, then from the tree diagram (Fig.8.3),
3 the sample space can be written as S = {1,2,3,4,5,6}
4
H
Fig. 8.3 5
H
6 T
(ii) When we toss two coins, then from the tree diagram (Fig.8.4), H
T
the sample space can be written as S={HH,HT,TH,TT} Fig. 8.4 T
Progress Check
Example 8.18 Express the sample space for rolling two dice using tree diagram.
Solution When we roll two dice, since each die contain 6 faces marked with 1,2,3,4,5,6
the tree diagram will look like
1 Hence, the sample space can be written as
2
1 3
4 S= {(1,1),(1,2),(1,3),(1,4),(1,5),(1,6)
5
6
1
2
2 3
4 (2,1),(2,2),(2,3),(2,4),(2,5),(2,6)
5
6
1
2
3 3
4 (3,1),(3,2),(3,3),(3,4),(3,5),(3,6)
5
6
1
2
4 3
4 (4,1),(4,2),(4,3),(4,4),(4,5),(4,6)
5
6
1
2
5 3
4 (5,1),(5,2),(5,3),(5,4),(5,5),(5,6)
5
6
1
2
6 3
4 (6,1),(6,2),(6,3),(6,4),(6,5),(6,6)}
5
6
Event : In a random experiment, each possible outcome is called an event. Thus,
an event will be a subset of the sample space.
Statistics and Probability 317
Note
n(E )
¾¾ P (E ) =
n(S )
n(S )
¾¾ P (S ) = = 1 . The probability of sure event is 1.
n(S )
n(f) 0
¾¾ P (f) = = = 0 . The probability of impossible event is 0.
n(s) n(s )
¾¾ Since E is a subset of S and f is a subset of any set,
f ÍE ÍS
P (f) £ P (E ) £ P (S)
0 ≤ P (E ) ≤ 1
Therefore, the probability value always lies from 0 to 1.
¾¾ The complement event of E is E .
m
Let P (E ) = (where m is the number of favourable outcomes of E and n is
n
the total number of possible outcomes).
Number of outcomes unfavourable to occurance of E
P (E ) =
Number of all possible outcomes
le
n −m m r ab
P (E ) = = 1− ou –m
n n f av n le
un rab
P (E ) = 1 − P(E) o u
fav m
¾¾ P(E) + P(E) =1
Progress Check
Which of the following values cannot be a probability of an event?
(a) –0.0001 (b) 0.5 (c) 1.001 (d) 1
1- 5 3 +1
(e) 20% (f) 0.253 (g) (h)
2 4
Example 8.19 A bag contains 5 blue balls and 4 green balls. A ball is drawn at random
from the bag. Find the probability that the ball drawn is (i) blue (ii) not blue.
Example 8.21 Two coins are tossed together. What is the probability of getting different
faces on the coins?
Solution When two coins are tossed together, the sample space is
S = {HH , HT ,TH ,TT } ; n(S ) = 4
Let A be the event of getting different faces on the coins.
A = {HT ,TH } ; n(A) = 2
n(A) 2 1
Probability of getting different faces on the coins is P (A) = = =
n(S ) 4 2
Example 8.22 From a well shuffled pack of 52 cards, one card is drawn at random.
Find the probability of getting (i) red card (ii) heart card (iii) red king (iv) face card
(v) number card
320 10th Standard Mathematics
(iv) Let D be the event of getting a face card. The face cards are Jack (J), Queen (Q),
and King (K).
n(D ) = 4 × 3 = 12
Probability of getting a face card is
n(D ) 12 3
P (D ) = = =
n(S ) 52 13
(v) Let E be the event of getting a number card. The number cards are 2, 3, 4, 5, 6,
7, 8, 9 and 10.
n(E ) = 4 × 9 = 36
Probability of getting a number card is
n(E ) 36 9
P (E ) = = =
n(S ) 52 13
Example 8.23 What is the probability that a leap year selected at random will contain 53
saturdays. (Hint: 366 = 52 × 7 + 2 )
Solution A leap year has 366 days. So it has 52 full weeks and 2 days. 52 Saturdays must
be in 52 full weeks.
The possible chances for the remaining two days will be the sample space.
Statistics and Probability 321
Activity 3 Activity 4
There are three routes R1, R2 and R3 Collect the details and find the probabilities of
from Madhu’s home to her place of (i) selecting a boy from your class.
work. There are four parking lots P1, (ii) selecting a girl from your class.
P2 , P3 , P4 and three entrances B1, B2 , B3 (iii) s electing a student from tenth standard
in your school.
into the office building. There are two
(iv) selecting a boy from tenth standard in
elevators E1 and E2 to her floor. Using
your school.
the tree diagram explain how many ways (v) selecting a girl from tenth standard in
can she reach her office? your school.
Example 8.25 A bag contains 6 green balls, some black and red balls. Number of black
balls is as twice as the number of red balls. Probability of getting a green ball is thrice the
probability of getting a red ball. Find (i) number of black balls (ii) total number of balls.
Solution Number of green balls is n(G ) = 6
Let number of red balls is n(R) = x
Therefore, number of black balls is n(B ) = 2x
Total number of balls n(S ) = 6 + x + 2x = 6 + 3x
It is given that, P (G ) = 3 × P (R)
6 x
= 3×
6 + 3x 6 + 3x
3x = 6 gives, x = 2
322 10th Standard Mathematics
9 3
(i) Let A be the event of resting in 7. n(A)=1
8 4
n(A) 1
P (A) = = 7 6
5
n(S ) 12
Fig. 8.6
(ii) Let B be the event that the arrow will come to rest in a prime number.
B = {2,3,5,7,11}; n(B ) = 5
n(B ) 5
P (B ) = =
n(S ) 12
(iii) Let C be the event that arrow will come to rest in a composite number.
C = {4,6,8,9,10,12}; n(C ) =6 Thinking Corner
n(C ) 6 1 What is the complement
P (C ) = = =
n(S ) 12 2 event of an impossible event?
Exercise 8.3
1. Write the sample space for tossing three coins using tree diagram.
2. W rite the sample space for selecting two balls from a bag containing 6 balls numbered
1 to 6 (using tree diagram).
3. If A is an event of a random experiment such that P(A) : P (A) =17:15 and n(S)=640
then find (i) P (A) (ii) n(A).
4. A coin is tossed thrice. What is the probability of getting two consecutive tails?
5. At a fete, cards bearing numbers 1 to 1000, one number on one card are put in a box.
Each player selects one card at random and that card is not replaced. If the selected
card has a perfect square number greater than 500, the player wins a prize. What is
the probability that (i) the first player wins a prize (ii) the second player wins a prize,
if the first has won?
6. A bag contains 12 blue balls and x red balls. If one ball is drawn at random (i) what is
the probability that it will be a red ball? (ii) If 8 more red balls are put in the bag, and if
the probability of drawing a red ball will be twice that of the probability in (i), then find x.
7. Two unbiased dice are rolled once. Find the probability of getting
(i) a doublet (equal numbers on both dice) (ii) the product as a prime number
(iii) the sum as a prime number (iv) the sum as 1
8. Three fair coins are tossed together. Find the probability of getting
(i) all heads (ii) atleast one tail
(iii) atmost one head (iv) atmost two tails
Statistics and Probability 323
9. Two dice are numbered 1,2,3,4,5,6 and 1,1,2,2,3,3 respectively. They are rolled and
the sum of the numbers on them is noted. Find the probability of getting each sum
from 2 to 9 separately.
10. A bag contains 5 red balls, 6 white balls, 7 green balls, 8 black balls. One ball is drawn
at random from the bag. Find the probability that the ball drawn is
(i) white (ii) black or red
(iii) not white (iv) neither white nor black
11. In a box there are 20 non-defective and some defective bulbs. If the probability that
3
a bulb selected at random from the box found to be defective is then, find the
8
number of defective bulbs.
12. The king and queen of diamonds, queen and jack of hearts, jack and king of spades are
removed from a deck of 52 playing cards and then well shuffled. Now one card is drawn
at random from the remaining cards. Determine the probability that the card is
(i) a clavor (ii) a queen of red card (iii) a king of black card 4 feet
13. Some boys are playing a game, in which the stone thrown by them
3 feet
landing in a circular region (given in the figure) is considered as 1 feet
A
AÇB AÈB
Fig. 8.7(a) Fig. 8.7(c)
Fig. 8.7(b)
Note
¾ A∩A = f ¾ A∪A =S
¾ If A, B are mutually exclusive events, then P (A ∪ B ) = P (A) + P (B )
¾ P (Union of mutually exclusive events) = ∑ ( Probability of events)
Thorem 1
If A and B are two events associated with a random experiment, then prove that
S
(i) P (A Ç B ) = P(only A) = P (A) − P (A ∩ B ) A B
(ii) P (A Ç B ) = P(only B) = P (B ) − P (A ∩ B )
Proof
(i) By Distributive property of sets,
1. (A ∩ B ) ∪ (A ∩ B ) = A ∩ (B ∪ B ) = A ∩ S = A AÇB
2. (A ∩ B ) ∩ (A ∩ B ) = A ∩ (B ∩ B ) = A ∩ f = f Fig. 8.8
Progress Check
P (A È B È C ) = P (A ∪ D )
= P (A) + P (D ) − P (A ∩ D )
= P (A) + P (B ∪ C ) − P[A ∩ (B ∪ C )]
only A AÇB only B
= P (A) + P (B) + P (C ) − P (B ∩ C ) − P[(A ∩ B ) ∪ (A ∩ C )] Fig. 8.10
= P (A) + P (B ) + P (C ) − P (B ∩ C ) − P (A ∩ B ) − P (A ∩ C ) + P[(A ∩ B ) ∩ (A ∩ C )]
P (A È B È C ) = P (A) + P (B ) + P (C ) − P (A ∩ B ) − P (B ∩ C )
−P (C ∩ A) + P (A ∩ B ∩ C )
Activity 5
The addition theorem of probability can be written easily using the following way.
P (A È B ) = S1 − S 2
P (A È B È C ) = S1 − S 2 + S 3
Where S1 ® Sum of probability of events taken one at a time.
S 2 ® Sum of probability of events taken two at a time.
S 3 ® Sum of probability of events taken three at a time.
P (A È B ) = P (A) + P (B ) −P (A ∩ B )
S1 S2
P (A È B È C ) =
P (A) + P (B ) + P (C ) −(P (A ∩ B ) + P (B ∩ C ) + P (A ∩ C )) +P (A ∩ B ∩ C )
S1 S2 S3
Find the probability of P (A È B È C È D ) using the above way. Can you find a
pattern for the number of terms in the formula?
Example 8.28 What is the probability of drawing either a king or a queen in a single draw
from a well shuffled pack of 52 cards?
Solution Total number of cards = 52
Number of king cards = 4 Thinking Corner
4
Probability of drawing a king card = P (A ∪ B ) + P (A ∩ B ) is .
52
Number of queen cards = 4
4
Probability of drawing a queen card =
52
Both the events of drawing a king and a queen are mutually exclusive
⇒ P (A ∪ B ) = P (A) + P (B )
4 4 2
Therefore, probability of drawing either a king or a queen = + =
52 52 13
Example 8.29 Two dice are rolled together. Find the probability of getting a doublet or
sum of faces as 4.
Solution When two dice are rolled together, there will be 6×6 = 36 outcomes. Let S be
the sample space. Then n(S ) = 36
Let A be the event of getting a doublet and B be the event of getting face sum 4.
Then A = {(1,1),(2,2),(3,3),(4,4),(5,5),(6,6)}
B = {(1,3),(2,2),(3,1)}
Therefore, A Ç B = {(2,2)}
Then, n(A) = 6 , n(B ) = 3 , n(A ∩ B ) = 1 .
n(A) 6
P (A) = =
n(S ) 36
n(B ) 3
P (B ) = =
n(S ) 36
n(A ∩ B ) 1
P (A Ç B ) = =
n(S ) 36
Therefore, P (getting a doublet or a total of 4) = P (A È B )
P (A È B ) = P (A) + P (B ) − P (A ∩ B )
6 3 1 8 2
= + − = =
36 36 36 36 9
2
Hence, the required probability is .
9
Statistics and Probability 327
1 1 1
Example 8.30 If A and B are two events such that P (A) = , P (B ) = and P(A and B)= ,
4 2 8
find (i) P (A or B) (ii) P(not A and not B).
Solution (i) P (A or B) = P (A È B )
= P (A) + P (B ) − P (A ∩ B )
1 1 1 5
P (A or B) = + − =
4 2 8 8
(ii) P (not A and not B) = P (A∩ B )
(
= P A∪B )
= 1 − P (A ∪ B )
5 3
P(not A and not B) = 1 − =
8 8
Example 8.31 A card is drawn from a pack of 52 cards. Find the probability of getting a
king or a heart or a red card.
Solution Total number of cards = 52; n(S ) =52 Suits of
playing
Spade Heart Clavor Diamond
cards
Let A be the event of getting a king card. n (A) =4 A A A A
2 2 2 2
n(A) 4
P (A) = = 3 3 3 3
n(S ) 52 4 4 4 4
5 5 5 5
6 6 6 6
n(B ) 13 7 7 7 7
P (B ) = = 8 8 8 8
n(S ) 52 9 9 9 9
Let C be the event of getting a red card. n (C ) =26 10 10 10 10
J J J J
P (C ) = n(C ) = 26 Q Q Q Q
n(S ) 52 K K K K
Set of 13 13 13 13
1 playing cards
P (A Ç B ) = P (getting heart king) = in each suit
52
13
P (B Ç C ) = P (getting red and heart)) =
52
2
P (A Ç C ) = P (getting red king) =
52
1
P (A Ç B Ç C ) = P (getting heart, king which is red) =
52
Therefore, required probability is
P (A È B È C ) = P (A) + P (B ) + P (C ) − P (A ∩ B ) − P (B ∩ C ) −P (C ∩ A) + P (A ∩ B ∩ C )
4 13 26 1 13 2 1 28 7
= + + − − − + = =
52 52 52 52 52 52 52 52 13
Example 8.32 In a class of 50 students, 28 opted for NCC, 30 opted for NSS and 18 opted
both NCC and NSS. One of the students is selected at random. Find the probability that
(i) Probability of the students opted for NCC but not NSS
28 18 1
P (A Ç B ) = P (A) − P (A ∩ B ) = − =
50 50 5
(ii) Probability of the students opted for NSS but not NCC.
30 18 6
P (A Ç B ) = P (B ) − P (A ∩ B ) = − =
50 50 25
(iii) Probability of the students opted for exactly one of them
= P[(A ∩ B ) ∪ (A ∩ B )]
1 6 11
= P (A ∩ B ) + P (A ∩ B ) = + =
5 25 25
(Note that (A Ç B ),(A Ç B ) are mutually exclusive events)
Example 8.33 A and B are two candidates seeking admission to IIT. The probability that
A getting selected is 0.5 and the probability that both A and B getting selected is 0.3.
Prove that the probability of B being selected is atmost 0.8.
Solution P (A) = 0.5 , P (A ∩ B ) = 0.3
We have P (A È B ) £ 1
P (A) + P (B) − P (A ∩ B ) £ 1
0.5 + P (B ) − 0.3 £ 1
P (B ) ≤ 1 − 0.2
P (B ) £ 0.8
Exercise 8.4
2 2 1
1. If P (A) =, P (B ) = , P (A ∪ B ) = then find P (A Ç B ) .
3 5 3
2. A and B are two events such that, P (A) = 0.42, P (B ) = 0.48 , and P (A ∩ B ) = 0.16 .
Find (i) P (not A) (ii) P (not B)
, , (iii) P (A or B)
,
Exercise 8.5
11. A page is selected at random from a book. The probability that the digit at units place
of the page number chosen is less than 7 is
3 7 3 7
(1) (2) (3) (4)
10 10 9 9
x
12. The probability of getting a job for a person is . If the probability of not getting the
3
2
job is then the value of x is
3
(1) 2 (2) 1 (3) 3 (4) 1.5
13. Kamalam went to play a lucky draw contest. 135 tickets of the lucky draw were sold.
1
If the probability of Kamalam winning is , then the number of tickets bought by
9
Kamalam is
(1) 5 (2) 10 (3) 15 (4) 20
14. If a letter is chosen at random from the English alphabets {a,b,...,z}, then the
probability that the letter chosen precedes x
12 1 23 3
(1) (2) (4)(3)
13 13 26 26
15. A purse contains 10 notes of ₹2000, 15 notes of ₹500, and 25 notes of ₹200. One note
is drawn at random. What is the probability that the note is either a ₹500 note or
₹200 note?
1 3 2 4
(1) (2) (3) (4)
5 10 3 5
Unit Exercise - 8
1. The mean of the following frequency distribution is 62.8 and the sum of all frequencies
is 50. Compute the missing frequencies f1 and f2 .
Class Interval 0-20 20-40 40-60 60-80 80-100 100-120
Frequency 5 f1 10 f2 7 8
2. The diameter of circles (in mm) drawn in a design are given below.
Diameters 33-36 37-40 41-44 45-48 49-52
Number of circles 15 17 21 22 25
Calculate the standard deviation.
3. The frequency distribution is given below.
x k 2k 3k 4k 5k 6k
f 2 1 1 1 1 1
In the table, k is a positive integer, has a varience of 160. Determine the value of k.
4. The standard deviation of some temperature data in degree celsius (oC) is 5. If the
data were converted into degree Farenheit (oF) then what is the variance?
2
5. If for a distribution, ∑ (x − 5) = 3, ∑ (x − 5) = 43, and total number of observations
is 18, find the mean and standard deviation.
6. P
rices of peanut packets in various places of two cities are given below. In which city,
prices were more stable?
Prices in city A 20 22 19 23 16
Prices in city B 10 20 18 12 15
7. I f the range and coefficient of range of the data are 20 and 0.2 respectively, then find
the largest and smallest values of the data.
332 10th Standard Mathematics
8. I f two dice are rolled, then find the probability of getting the product of face value 6
or the difference of face values 5.
9. In a two children family, find the probability that there is at least one girl in a family.
10. A bag contains 5 white and some black balls. If the probability of drawing a black ball
from the bag is twice the probability of drawing a white ball then find the number
of black balls.
11. The probability that a student will pass the final examination in both English
and Tamil is 0.5 and the probability of passing neither is 0.1. If the probability of
passing the English examination is 0.75, what is the probability of passing the Tamil
examination?
12. The King, Queen and Jack of the suit spade are removed from a deck of 52 cards. One
card is selected from the remaining cards. Find the probability of getting (i) a diamond
(ii) a queen (iii) a spade (iv) a heart card bearing the number 5.
Points to Remember
zz Range = L–S (L - Largest value, S - Smallest value)
n
L −S
∑ (x i
− x )2
zz Coefficient of range = ; Variance s 2 = i =1
L +S n
Σ (x i − x )
2
zz Standard deviation s =
n
zz Standard deviation (ungrouped data)
2
Σx i2 Σx Σdi 2
(i) Direct method s = − i (ii) Mean method s =
n n n
2
Σdi2 Σd
(iii) Assumed mean method s = − i
n n
2
Σdi2 Σdi
(iv) Step deviation method s = c × −
n n
n2 − 1
zz Standard deviation of first n natural numbers s =
12
zz Standard deviation (grouped data)
2
Σ fidi2 Σ fidi2 Σ f d
i i
(i) Mean method s = (ii)Assumed mean method s = −
N N N
2
Σ fidi2 Σ f d
i i
(iii) Step deviation method s = C × −
N N
s
zz Coefficient of variation C.V = × 100%
x
zz If the C.V. value is less, then the observations of corresponding data are consistent.
If the C.V. value is more then the observations of corresponding are inconsistent.
Statistics and Probability 333
zz In a random experiment, the set of all outcomes are known but exact outcome is
not known.
zz The set of all possible outcomes is called sample space.
ICT CORNER
ICT 8.1
Step 1: Open the Browser type the URL Link given below (or) Scan the QR Code. Chapter named
“Probability” will open. Select the work sheet “ Probability Addition law ”
Step 2: In the given worksheet you can change the question by clicking on “New Problem”. Move the slider to
see the steps.
Step 1 Step 2 Expected results
ICT 8.2
Step 1: Open the Browser type the URL Link given below (or) Scan the QR Code. Chapter named
“Probability” will open. Select the work sheet “ Addition law Mutually Exclusive”
Step 2: In the given worksheet you can change the question by clicking on “New Problem”. Click on the check
boxes to see the respective answer.
Step 1 Step 2 Expected results
ANSWERS
Exercise 1.1
1.(i) A × B = {(2, 1),(2, −4),(−2, 1),(−2, −4),(3, 1),(3, −4)}
A × A = {(2, 2),(2, −2),(2, 3),(−2, 2),(−2, −2),(−2, 3),(3, 2),(3, −2), (3, 3)}
B × A = {(1, 2),(1, −2),(1, 3),(−4, 2),(−4, −2),(−4, 3)}
(ii) A × B = {(p, p)(p, q )(q, p)(q, q )} ; A × A = {(p, p),(p, q ),(q, p),(q, q )} ;
B × A = {(p, p),(p, q ),(q, p),(q, q )}
(iii) A × B = { } ; A × A = {(m, m ),(m, n ),(n, m ),(n, n )} ; B × A = { }
2. A × B = {(1, 2),(1, 3),(1, 5),(1, 7),(2, 2),(2, 3),(2, 5),(2, 7),(3, 2), (3, 3),(3, 5),(3, 7)}
B × A = {(2, 1),(2, 2),(2, 3),(3, 1),(3, 2),(3, 3),(5, 1),(5, 2),(5, 3), (7, 1),(7, 2),(7, 3)}
3. A = {3, 4} B = {−2, 0, 3} 5. true
Exercise 1.2
1.(i) Not a relation (ii) Not a relation (iii) Relation (iv) Not a relation
2. {1, 2, 3, 4, 5, 6} , {1, 4, 9, 16, 25, 36} 3. {0,1,2,3,4,5}, {3, 4, 5, 6, 7, 8}
4. (i)(a) 2 1 (b) (c) {(2, 1),(4, 2)}
3 2
4 3
5 4
1 1
(ii)(a) 2 2 (b) (c) {(1, 4),(2, 5),(3, 6),(4, 7),(5, 8),(6, 9)}
3 3
4 4
5 5
6 6
7 7
8 8
9 9
ANSWERS 335
Exercise 1.3
1. {1, 2, 3, 4,...} , {1,2,3,4}, {2, 4, 6, 8,...} , yes. 2. yes
3.(i) 12 (ii) 4a 2 − 10a + 6 (iii) 0 (iv) x 2 − 7x + 12
4.(i) (a) 9 (b) 6 (c) 6 (d) 0
(ii) 9.5 (iii) (a) {x / 0 ≤ x ≤ 10, x ∈ R} (b) {x / 0 ≤ x ≤ 9, x ∈ R}
3 1
(iv) 5 5. 2 6.(i) -2 (ii) (iii) 3 (iv)
2 2
7. 4x 3 − 96x 2 + 576x 8. 1 9. 500t
10.(i) Yes (ii) 0.9,24.5 (iii) 60.5 inches (iv) 32 cms
Exercise 1.4
1.(i) Not a function (ii) function (iii) Not a function (iv) function
2.(i) {(2,0),(4,1),(6,2),(10,4),(12,5)}
(ii) x 2 4 6 10 12 (iv)
f(x) 0 1 2 4 5
A f B
(iii)
2 0
4 1
6 2
10 4
12 5
9
3.(i) A f B
1
2 (ii) x 1 2 3 4 5 (iii)
2
3 3 f(x) 2 2 2 3 4
4
5 4
Exercise 1.6
1 2 3 4 5 6 7 8 9 10 11 12 13 14 15
(3) (3) (1) (2) (3) (4) (3) (1) (3) (3) (1) (4) (3) (2) (4)
Unit exercise
1. 1,2 and -5 ,1 2. {-1, 0, 1} , {(-1, -1),(-1, 1),(0, -1),(0, 0),(1, -1),(1, 0),(1, 1)}
3.(i) 4 (ii) 2 (iii) a
4. {(9, 3),(10, 5),(11, 11),(12, 3),(13, 13),(14, 7),(15, 5),(16, 2), (17, 17)} , {2,3,5,11,13,17}
-5
5. {–1,0,1} 9.(i) (ii) 2(x + 1) 10.(i) R - {9}
6
(ii) R (iii) [2, ¥) (iv) R
Exercise 2.1
1. 2, 5, 8, 11, … 2. 25, 7 6.(i) 4 (ii) 51
(iii) 144 (iv) 6 7. 174 8. 2,-1 9. 6
Exercise 2.2
1. Even number 2. No value 3. 10101 4. 9, 3
5. 2,3,5,7 and 3,4,2,1 6. 2040, 34 7. 999720 8. 3647 9. 2520
Exercise 2.3
1.(i) 7 (ii) 5 (iii) 2 (iv) 7 (v) 2
2. 3 3. 2,8,14,… 4. 8, 19, 30, … 5. 11 a.m
6. 8 p.m 7. Friday 9. 2 10. 6 am, Monday
Exercise 2.4
4 5 6
1.(i) 216,648,1944 (ii) -7 , -11 , -15 (iii) , , 2.(i) -1 ,6,25,62
25 36 49
n -1
(ii) 2, -6 ,12, -20 (iii) -4 , 2, 12, 26 3.(i) n 2 + 1 (ii)
n
13 15 63 225
(iii) 5n - 2 4.(i) , (ii) -12 ,117 5. , 6. 1,1,3,7,17,41
3 4 11 31
Exercise 2.5
1.(i) A.P (ii) not an A.P (iii) A.P (iv) A.P
3 5 7
(v) not an A.P 2.(i) 5, 11, 17, … (ii) 7, 2, -3 , … (iii) , , , …
4 4 4
3.(i) -1 , 2 (ii) -3, -7 4. -83 5. 15
6. 93, 99 8. 4 9. 3,17,31 10. 78
11. 2,9,16 12. 5:7 13. −3° C, 0° C, 3° C, 6° C, 9° C 14. 31 years
Exercise 2.6
1.(i) 3240 (ii) 999 (iii) 721 2. 20 3. 1540
5. 612.5 6.50625 7. 168448 8.(i) ₹ 45750 (ii) ₹ 5750 9. 20 months
6
10.(i) 42 (ii) 2130 12. (24a − 13b)
a +b
Exercise 2.7
1.(i) G.P (ii) not a G.P (iii) G.P (iv) G.P (v) G.P
(vi) not a G.P (vii) G.P 2.(i) 6,18,54 (ii) 2 ,2, 2 2
ANSWERS 337
Exercise 3.5
3x 3z 3t 2 3x - 4y x 2 + xy + y 2
1.(i) (ii) p + 4 (iii) 2.(i) (ii)
5y 3 4 2x - 5 3(x + 2y )
b−4 3y 4(2t - 1) 4
3.(i) -5 (ii) (iii) (iv) 4. 5. x 2 + 4x + 4
b +2 x -3 3 9
Exercise 3.6
2
2x 2x + 2x − 7 2(x - 2) 1−x
1.(i) (ii) (iii) x 2 + xy + y 2 2.(i) (ii)
x -2 (x + 3)(x − 2) x -4 1+x
2x 3 + 1 3 (4x 2 − 1)
3. 2 2
4. 2 5. 7. 2 hrs 24 minutes 8. 30 kgs, 20 kgs
(x + 2) x − 2x + 4 2(4x 2 + 1)
Exercise 3.7
y 4z 6 7x + 2 11 (a + b)4 (x + y )4
1.(i) 2 ( ii) 4 (iii) 2.(i) 2x + 5
x2 4x − 1 9 (a − b)6
1 1
(ii) 1 + (iii) 3x − 4y + 5z (iv) (x − 2)(7x + 1)(4x − 1) (v) (4x + 3)(3x + 2)(x + 2)
x3 6
Exercise 3.8
1.(i) x − 6x + 3 (ii)
2
2x - 7x - 3
2
(iii) 4x 2 + 1 (iv) 11x 2 - 9x - 12
x y
2. −5+ 3.(i) 49, -42 (ii) 144, 264 4.(i) -12 , 4 (ii) 24, -32
y x
Exercise 3.9
1.(i) x 2 + 9x + 20 = 0 (ii) 3x 2 − 5x + 12 = 0 (iii) 2x 2 + 3x − 2 = 0
1 10 1 -4
(iv) x 2 + (2 − a 2 )x + (a + 5)2 = 0 2.(i) -3 , -28 (ii) -3 , 0 (iii) - , - (iv) ,
3 3 3 3
Exercise 3.10
1 9 -5 1 1
1.(i) - ,2 (ii) -2, (iii) -2 ,9 (iv) - 2, (v) , 2. 6
4 2 2 4 4
Exercise 3.11
2 2 1 3+ 3 3- 3
1.(i) , (ii) -1 , 3 2.(i) 2, (ii) ,
3 3 2 2 2
23 a + b a -b
(iii) -1 , (iv) , 3. 3.75 seconds
3 6 6
Exercise 3.12
1
1. 5, - 2. 1.5 m 3. 45 km/hr 4. 20 years, 10 years
5
5. Yes, 12 m, 16 m 6. 72 7. 28 m, 42 m 8. 2 m 9. 40, 60
Exercise 3.13
1.(i) Real and unequal (ii) Real and unequal (iii) Not real
1
(iv) Real and equal (v) Real and equal 2.(i) 2, 3 (ii) 1,
9
Exercise 3.14
2
(α + β ) − 2αβ α+β
1.(i) (ii) (iii) 9αβ − 3(α + β ) + 1
3αβ (αβ )2 ANSWERS 339
Exercise 3.19
1 2 3 4 5 6 7 8 9 10 11 12 13 14 15 16 17 18 19 20
(4) (1) (2) (1) (2) (3) (4) (2) (3) (3) (2) (1) (2) (4) (2) (2) (4) (2) (2) (1)
Unit exercise-3
1. 6,2,1 2. 42,78,30 3. 153 4. (ky + x )(k 2x 2 − y 2 ) 5 . x 2 + 2x + 1 6. (i) x a - 2
5 1
(ii) −x + 7. 8. 11 hrs, 22 hrs, 33 hrs 9. 17x 2 − 18x + 19 10. 3,63
2 2qr
11. 14 km/hr 12. 120 m,40 m 13. 14 minutes 14. 25 15.(i) x 2 − 6x + 11 = 0
9 750 1500 2250 8000 1600 24000
(ii) 3x − 2x + 1 = 0
2
16. 3, 17.(i) (ii)
4 3750 4250 750 40000 24000 8000
122 71
18. sin q 19. 8, 4 20.
−58 −34
Exercise 4.1
1.(i) Not similar (ii) Similar,2.5 2. 330 m 3. 42 m
15 36
5. , 6. 5.6 cm, 3.25 cm 7. 2.8 cm 9. 2 m
13 13
Exercise 4.2
1.(i) 6.43 cm (ii) 1 2. 60 cm 5. 4 cm, 4 cm
8. 2.5 cm, 3.5 cm 9.(i) Not a bisector (ii) Bisector 13. 2.1 cm
Exercise 4.3
1. 30 m 2. 1 mile 3. 21.74 m 4. 12 cm, 5 cm
5. 10 m, 24 m, 26 m 6. 0.8 m
Exercise 4.4
1. 7 cm 2. 2 cm 3. 7 cm, 5 cm, 3 cm 4. 30° 5. 130°
20
6. cm 7. 10 cm 8. 4.8 cm 10. 2 cm 11. 2 cm 14.8.7 cm 16.4 cm
3
Exercise 4.5
1 2 3 4 5 6 7 8 9 10 11 12 13 14 15
(3) (2) (4) (1) (4) (1) (2) (3) (1) (4) (2) (2) (2) (4) (1)
Unit exercise
12 10 4
2. cm, cm 5. 20 13 km 7. 10 m 8. shadow = × (distance) 10.14 units
5 3 11
Exercise 5.1
1.(i) 24 sq. units (ii) 11.5 sq. units 2.(i) collinear (ii) collinear
1
3.(i) 44 (ii) 13 4.(i) 0 (ii) or -1 5.(i) 35 sq. units (ii) 34 sq. units
2
6. -5 7. 2, -1 8.24 sq. units, area(DABC ) = 4 × area(∆PQR) 9. 38sq.units
10. 10 cans 11.(i) 3.75 sq. units (ii) 3 sq. units (iii) 13.88 sq. units
Exercise 5.2
1
1.(i) undefined (ii) 0 2.(i) 0° (ii) 45° 3.(i) (ii) -cot q
5 −3 −1
17
4. 3 6. 7 7. 8. 4 9.(i) yes ( ii) yes 11. 5, 2 14. 1, or 3,
2 2 2
Exercise 5.3
5
1.(i) 2y + 3 = 0 (ii) 2x − 5 = 0 2. 1, 45° ,
2
3 +3 3+3 3
3. x − 3y − 3 3 = 0 4 . , 5. -5 6. x − y − 16 = 0
2 −2
7.(i) 16x − 15y − 22 = 0 (ii) 4x − 9y + 19 = 0 8 . 15x − 11y + 46 = 0
9. x + 4y − 14 = 0 10. 5x + 4y − 3 = 0 11. (i)
(ii) 1 (iii) 7.5 seconds (iv) 10 seconds
12.(i) 3x − 2y − 12 = 0 (ii) 3x − 20y + 15 = 0 13.(i) 2, -3
(ii) -3, - 4 1 4.(i) 5x + 2y + 3 = 0 (ii) x + y + 4 = 0
ANSWERS 341
Exercise 5.4
1.(i) 0 (ii) undefined 2.(i) 0.7 (ii) undefined
3.(i) Parallel (ii) Perpendicular 4. 4 5. 3x + 4y + 7 = 0
6. 2x + 5y − 2 = 0 7. 2x + 5y + 6 = 0 , 5x + y − 48 = 0 8. 5x − 3y − 8 = 0
9. 13x + 5y − 18 = 0 1 0. 49x + 28y − 156 = 0 11. 31x + 15y + 30 = 0
12. 4x + 13y − 9 = 0
Exercise 5.5
1 2 3 4 5 6 7 8 9 10 11 12 13 14 15
(2) (1) (2) (3) (3) (4) (2) (2) (1) (3) (3) (1) (2) (1) (2)
Unit exercise
7 13
1. Rhombus 2. , 3. 0 sq.units 4. -5 6. 2x − 3y − 6 = 0, 3x − 2y + 6 = 0
2 2
7. 1340 litres 8. (-1, -4) 9 . 13x + 13y − 6 = 0 10. 119x + 102y − 125 = 0
Exercise 6.2
1. 30° 2. 24 m 3. 3.66 m 4. 1.5 m 5.(i) 7 m ( ii) 16.39 m
6. 10 m 7. 100 5 m 8. 0.14 mile (approx)
Exercise 6.3
1. 150 m 2. 50 m 3. 32.93 m 4. 2078.4 m 6. 0.5 m / s
Exercise 6.4
1. 35.52 m 2. 69.28 m, 160 m 4. 150 m, yes
5.(i) 264 m (ii) 198 m (iii) 114.31 m 6.(i) 2.91 km (ii) 6.93 km
Exercise 6.5
1 2 3 4 5 6 7 8 9 10 11 12 13 14 15
(2) (4) (2) (1) (2) (2) (1) (3) (2) (4) (2) (2) (4) (2) (1)
Unit exercise
5. 29.28 m/s 6. 1.97 seconds (approx) 7.(i) 24.58 km(approx)
(ii) 17.21 km (approx) (iii) 21.41 km (approx) (iv) 23.78 km (approx)
8. 200 m 9. 39.19 m
Exercise 7.1
1. 25 cm, 35 cm 2. 7 m, 35 m 3. 2992 sq.cm
4. CSA of the cone when rotated about PQ is larger. 5. 18.25 cm
6. 28 caps 7. 5 :9 8. 56.25% 9. ₹ 302.72 10. ₹ 1357.72
Exercise 7.2
1. 4.67 m 2. 1 cm 3. 652190 cm 3 4. 63 minutes (approx)
5. 100.58 6. 5:7 7. 64:343 9. 4186.29 cm 3 10. ₹ 418.36
Exercise 7.3
1. 1642.67 cm 3
2. 66 cm 3
3. 2.46 cm 3 4. 905.14 cm 3
5. 56.51 cm 3 6. 332.5 cm 2 7.(i) 4pr 2 sq. units
(ii) 4pr 2 sq. units (iii) 1:1 8. 73.39 cm 2
342 10th Standard Mathematics
Exercise 7.4
h
1. 36 cm 2. 2 hrs 3. 2
4. 6 cm 5. 281200 cm 3 6. 1.33 cm 7. 1 cm 8. 100%
3x
Exercise 7.5
1 2 3 4 5 6 7 8 9 10 11 12 13 14 15
(4) (1) (1) (2) (3) (2) (2) (3) (3) (1) (4) (1) (1) (2) (4)
Unit exercise
1
1. 48000 words 2. 27 minutes (approx) 3. pr 3 cu.units 4 . 782.57 sq.cm
3
5. 450 coins 6. 4.8 cm 7. ₹ 6800 8. 2 cm 9. 17 cm 10. 2794.18 cm 3
Exercise 8.1
1.(i) 62; 0.33 (ii) 47.8; 0.64 2. 50.2 3. 250 4. 2.34
5. 222.22, 14.91 6. 6.9 7. 6.05 8. 4.5 9. 1.44, 1.2 10. 7.76 11. 14.6
12. 6 13. 1.24 14. 60.5, 14.61 15. 6 and 8
Exercise 8.2
1. 52% 2. 4.69 3. 7.2 4. 180.28% 5. 14.4% 6. 10.07% 7. Vidhya 8. Science, Social 9. City A
Exercise 8.3
1. {HHH , HHT , HTH ,THH ,THT ,TTH ,TTT }
{(1, 1),(1, 2),(1, 3),(1, 4),(1, 5),(1, 6), (2, 1),(2, 2),(2, 3),(2, 4)(2, 4),(2, 5),(2, 6),
2. (3, 1),(3, 2),(3, 3),(3, 4),(3, 5),(3, 6), (44, 1),(4, 2),(4, 3),(4, 4),(4, 5),(4, 5),(4, 6),
(5, 1),(5, 2),(5, 3),(5, 4),(5, 5),(5, 6),(6, 1),(6, 2),(6, 3),(6, 4),(6, 5),(6, 6)}
15 3 9 8 1
3. (i) 4. 5. (i) (ii) 6. (i) (ii) x = 4
32 8 1000 999 4
1 1 7 1 7 1 7
7.(i) (ii) (iii) 8. (i) (ii) (iii) (iv)
6 6 36 8 8 2 8
2 4 6 6 6 6 4 2 3 1 10 6
9. , , , , , , , 10.(i) (ii) (iii) (iv)
36 36 36 36 36 36 36 36 13 2 13 13
13 1 157 1 5 5
11. 12 12.(i) (ii) 0 (iii) 13. 14. (i) (ii) (iii)
46 46 600 6 6 36
1 3 1
15. (i) (ii) (iii)
8 4 8
Exercise 8.4
11
1. 2. (i) 0.58 (ii) 0.52 (iii) 0.74 3. 0.1 4. 1.2 5. 0.2
15
5 1 13 73 17 11 11 11
6. 7. 8. 9. 10. 11. 1 12. , ,
9 13 18 280 40 48 24 16
Exercise 8.5
1 2 3 4 5 6 7 8 9 10 11 12 13 14 15
(3) (1) (3) (2) (3) (4) (2) (1) (1) (2) (2) (2) (3) (3) (4)
Unit exercise
1. 8,12 2. 5.55 3. 7 4. 81 5. 5.17, 1.53 6. City A 7. 60, 40
1 3 13 13 3 1
8. 9. 10. 10 11. 1 2. (i) (ii) (iii)
9 4 20 20 49 49
ANSWERS 343
MATHEMATICAL TERMS
Algorithm படிமுறை Decompose பிரித்தல்
Alternate segment ஒன்றுவிட்ட துண்டு Diagonal matrix மூலைவிட்ட அணி
Altitude குத்துயரம் Dimensions பரிமாணங்கள்
Angle bisector க�ோண இருசம வெட்டி Discriminant தன்மைக் காட்டி
Angle of depression இறக்கக் க�ோணம் Distributive property பங்கீட்டுப் பண்பு
Angle of elevation ஏற்றக் க�ோணம் Domain மதிப்பகம்
Arithmetic progression கூட்டுத்தொடர் வரிசை Equal matrices சம அணிகள்
Arrow diagram அம்புக்குறி படம் Equiangular சமக�ோணம்
Axis அச்சு Event நிகழ்ச்சி
Axis of symmetry சமச்சீர் அச்சு Frustum இடைக் கண்டம்
Basic proportionality அடிப்படை விகித சமம் Functions சார்புகள்
Bijection இருபுறச் சார்பு Geometric progression பெருக்குத்தொடர் வரிசை
Cartesian product கார்டீசியன் பெருக்கல் Geo-positioning system புவி நிலைப்படுத்தல் அமைப்பு
Circular motion வட்ட இயக்கம் Graphical form வரைபடமுறை
Clinometer சாய்வுமாணி Great circle மீப்பெரு வட்டம்
Co-domain துணை மதிப்பகம் Height and distance உயரங்களும் தூரங்களும்
Coefficient of range வீச்சுக் கெழு Hemisphere அரைக் க�ோளம்
Coefficient of variation மாறுபாட்டுக் கெழு Hollow உள்ளீடற்ற
Collinearity நேர்க் க�ோட்டமைவு Horizontal level கிடைமட்ட வரிசை
Column matrix நிரல் அணி Horizontal line test கிடைமட்டக் க�ோட்டுச்
ச�ோதனை
Combined solids இணைந்த திண்மங்கள் Hyperbola அதிபரவளையம்
Common difference ப�ொது வித்தியாசம் Identity function சமனிச் சார்பு
Common ratio ப�ொது விகிதம் Image நிழல் உரு
Completing square
method வர்க்கப் பூர்த்தி முறை Inclination சாய்வுக் க�ோணம்
Composition of functions சார்புகளின் இணக்கம் Inconsistent ஒருங்கமைவற்ற
Concurrency theorem ஒருங்கிசைவுத் தேற்றம் Injection ஒருபுறச் சார்பு
Concurrent ஒருங்கிசையும் Intercept வெட்டுத்துண்டு
Concyclic ஒரேபிரதியிலுள்ள Into function உள்நோக்கிய சார்பு
Congruence ஒருங்கிசைவு Kadhams (unit of distance) காதம்கள் (தூரத்தின் அலகு)
Consistent ஒருங்கமைவுடைய Latitude அட்சரேகை
Constant function மாறிலிச் சார்பு Lemma துணைத் தேற்றம்
Coordinate axes ஆயக்கூறு அச்சு Line of sight பார்வைக் க�ோடு
Counter-clock wise வலமிருந்து இடம் Linear equations நேரிய சமன்பாடுகள்
Curved surface area வளைபரப்பு Linear function நேரிய சார்பு
Median நடுக்கோடு
Sample space கூறுவெளி
Modular மட்டு
Scalar matrix திசையிலி அணி
• G. Jeyaraj
B.T. Assistant, GHSS, Avudaiyapuram,
Virudhunagar district This book has been printed on 80 GSM
Elegant Maplitho paper
• P. Viswanathan Printed by offset at :
B.T. Assistant, GHS, Thengiyanatham Kallakurichi district